D Link SR500ACA1 AC800 Selectable Dual Band VPN Business Router User Manual

D Link Corporation AC800 Selectable Dual Band VPN Business Router

User manual

Download: D Link SR500ACA1 AC800 Selectable Dual Band VPN Business Router User Manual
Mirror Download [FCC.gov]D Link SR500ACA1 AC800 Selectable Dual Band VPN Business Router User Manual
Document ID2623752
Application IDrMgj1kFPA+Hpc8RR/xbsjQ==
Document DescriptionUser manual
Short Term ConfidentialNo
Permanent ConfidentialNo
SupercedeNo
Document TypeUser Manual
Display FormatAdobe Acrobat PDF - pdf
Filesize303.15kB (3789405 bits)
Date Submitted2015-05-26 00:00:00
Date Available2015-05-27 00:00:00
Creation Date2017-10-02 03:19:29
Producing SoftwareGPL Ghostscript 9.18
Document Lastmod2017-10-02 03:19:29
Document Titleuntitled
Document CreatorAdobe InDesign CC 2014 (Windows)

Wireless AC Services Router
User Manual
DSR-150/150N/250/250N/500/500N/1000/1000N/500AC/1000AC
Version 3.02 | May 14, 2015
Preface
Preface
The information in this document is subject to change without notice. The manufacturer makes no representations
or warranties with respect to the contents hereof and speciically disclaim any implied warranties of merchantability
or itness for any particular purpose. The manufacturer reserves the right to revise this publication and to make
changes from time to time in the content hereof without obligation of the manufacturer to notify any person of
such revision or changes.
Manual Revisions
Revision
Date
2.00
July 31, 2014
2.01
November 17, 2014
2.02
January 28, 2015
3.02
May 06, 2015
Description
• DSR Products with irmware version 2.00
• add License Update section
• DSR Products with irmware version 2.02
• applies to new DSR series models, DSR-500AC & DSR-1000AC
Trademarks/Copyright Notice
D-Link and the D-Link logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of D-Link Corporation or its subsidiaries in
the United States or other countries. All other company or product names mentioned herein are trademarks or
registered trademarks of their respective companies.
Š 2015 D-Link Corporation, All Rights Reserved
This publication, including all photographs, illustrations and software, is protected under international copyright
laws, with all rights reserved. Neither this manual, nor any of the material contained herein, may be reproduced
without written consent of the author.
Limitations of Liability
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES SHALL D-LINK OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR DAMAGES OF ANY CHARACTER
(E.G. DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFIT, SOFTWARE RESTORATION, WORK STOPPAGE, LOSS OF SAVED DATA OR
ANY OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES) RESULTING FROM THE APPLICATION OR IMPROPER USE OF
THE D-LINK PRODUCT OR FAILURE OF THE PRODUCT, EVEN IF D-LINK IS INFORMED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGES. FURTHERMORE, DLINK WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR THIRD-PARTY CLAIMS AGAINST CUSTOMER FOR
LOSSES OR DAMAGES. D-LINK WILL IN NO EVENT BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES IN EXCESS OF THE AMOUNT
D-LINK RECEIVED FROM THE END-USER FOR THE PRODUCT.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Preface
Safety Instructions
Use the following safety guidelines to ensure your own personal safety and to help protect your system from
potential damage.
Safety Cautions
To reduce the risk of bodily injury, electrical shock, ire, and damage to the equipment, observe the following
precautions:
• Observe and follow service markings.
• Do not service any product except as explained in your system documentation.
• Opening or removing covers that are marked with the triangular symbol with a lightning bolt
may expose you to electrical shock.
• Only a trained service technician should service components inside these compartments.
• If any of the following conditions occur, unplug the product from the electrical outlet and replace the
part or contact your trained service provider:
• The power cable, extension cable, or plug is damaged.
• An object has fallen into the product.
• The product has been exposed to water.
• The product has been dropped or damaged.
• The product does not operate correctly when you follow the operating instructions.
• Keep your system away from radiators and heat sources. Also, do not block cooling vents.
• Do not spill food or liquids on your system components, and never operate the product in a wet
environment. If the system gets wet, see the appropriate section in your troubleshooting guide or
contact your trained service provider.
• Do not push any objects into the openings of your system. Doing so can cause ire or electric shock by
shorting out interior components.
• Use the product only with approved equipment.
• Allow the product to cool before removing covers or touching internal components.
• Operate the product only from the type of external power source indicated on the electrical ratings
label. If you are not sure of the type of power source required, consult your service provider or local
power company.
• Also, be sure that attached devices are electrically rated to operate with the power available in your
location.
• Use only approved power cable(s). If you have not been provided with a power cable for your system or
for any AC powered option intended for your system, purchase a power cable that is approved for use
in your country. The power cable must be rated for the product and for the voltage and current marked
on the product’s electrical ratings label. The voltage and current rating of the cable should be greater
than the ratings marked on the product.
• To help prevent electric shock, plug the system and peripheral power cables into properly grounded
electrical outlets.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ii
Preface
• These cables are equipped with three-prong plugs to help ensure proper grounding. Do not use
adapter plugs or remove the grounding prong from a cable. If you must use an extension cable, use a
3-wire cable with properly grounded plugs.
• Observe extension cable and power strip ratings. Make sure that the total ampere rating of all products
plugged into the extension cable or power strip does not exceed 80 percent of the ampere ratings limit
for the extension cable or power strip.
• To help protect your system from sudden, transient increases and decreases in electrical power, use a
surge suppressor, line conditioner, or uninterruptible power supply (UPS).
• Position system cables and power cables carefully; route cables so that they cannot be stepped on or
tripped over. Be sure that nothing rests on any cables.
• Do not modify power cables or plugs. Consult a licensed electrician or your power company for site
modiications.
• Always follow your local/national wiring rules.
• When connecting or disconnecting power to hot-pluggable power supplies, if ofered with your system,
observe the following guidelines:
• Install the power supply before connecting the power cable to the power supply.
• Unplug the power cable before removing the power supply.
• If the system has multiple sources of power, disconnect power from the system by unplugging all
power cables from the power supplies.
• Move products with care; ensure that all casters and/or stabilizers are irmly connected to the system.
Avoid sudden stops and uneven surfaces.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
iii
Preface
Protecting Against Electrostatic Discharge
Static electricity can harm delicate components inside your system. To prevent static damage, discharge static
electricity from your body before you touch any of the electronic components, such as the microprocessor. You can
do so by periodically touching an unpainted metal surface on the chassis.
You can also take the following steps to prevent damage from electrostatic discharge (ESD):
1. When unpacking a static-sensitive component from its shipping carton, do not remove the
component from the antistatic packing material until you are ready to install the component
in your system. Just before unwrapping the antistatic packaging, be sure to discharge static
electricity from your body.
2. When transporting a sensitive component, irst place it in an antistatic container or package.
3. Handle all sensitive components in a static-safe area. If possible, use antistatic loor pads,
workbench pads and an antistatic grounding strap.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
iv
Power Usage
This device is an Energy Related Product (ErP) with High Network Availability (HiNA), and
automatically switches to a power-saving Network Standby mode within 1 minute of no packets
being transmitted. It can also be turned of through a power switch to save energy when it is
not needed.
DSR-250N
Network Standby:7.8336 watts
Switched Of: 0.1301 watts
DSR-250
Network Standby: 7.8588 watts
Switched Of: 0.1290 watts
DSR-150N
Network Standby: 8.2317 watts
Switched Of: 0.1283 watts
DSR-150
Network Standby: 6.9133 watts
Switched Of: 0.12661 watts
DSR-1000N
Network Standby: 10.969 watts
Switched Of: 0.0 watts
DSR-1000
Network Standby: 10.912 watts
Switched Of: 0.0 watts
DSR-500N
Network Standby: 11.487 watts
Switched Of: 0.0 watts
DSR-500
Network Standby: 9.744 watts
Switched Of: 0.0 watts
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Preface ........................................................................................................................................................... i
Manual Revisions........................................................................................................................................................................i
Trademarks/Copyright Notice ...............................................................................................................................................i
Limitations of Liability ..............................................................................................................................................................i
Safety Instructions ....................................................................................................................................................................ii
Safety Cautions .................................................................................................................................................................ii
Protecting Against Electrostatic Discharge .......................................................................................................... iv
Power Usage ...............................................................................................................................................................................v
Introduction ................................................................................................................................................. 1
Installation ................................................................................................................................................... 3
Before you Begin ...................................................................................................................................................................... 3
Connect to your Network ...................................................................................................................................................... 3
Basic Coniguration ..................................................................................................................................... 4
#1 Log in to the Web UI .......................................................................................................................................................... 5
#2 Change LAN IP Address.................................................................................................................................................... 6
#3 Conigure DHCP Server .................................................................................................................................................... 7
#4 Set Time and Date .............................................................................................................................................................. 8
#5 Internet Connection Setup ............................................................................................................................................. 9
#6 Wireless Network Setup .................................................................................................................................................12
#7 Create Users........................................................................................................................................................................13
#8 Security/VPN Wizard .......................................................................................................................................................14
#9 Dynamic DNS Wizard ......................................................................................................................................................16
LAN Coniguration ..................................................................................................................................... 17
LAN Settings.............................................................................................................................................................................18
DHCP Server ....................................................................................................................................................................19
DHCP Relay ......................................................................................................................................................................20
DHCP Reserved IPs .......................................................................................................................................................21
IGMP Setup ...............................................................................................................................................................................22
UPnP Setup...............................................................................................................................................................................23
Jumbo Frames .........................................................................................................................................................................24
VLAN ...........................................................................................................................................................................................25
VLAN Settings .................................................................................................................................................................25
Captive Portal ..........................................................................................................................................................27
Port/Wireless VLAN .......................................................................................................................................................28
Connect to the Internet ............................................................................................................................. 30
Dynamic IP.......................................................................................................................................................................30
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
vi
Table of Contents
Static IP .............................................................................................................................................................................31
PPPoE.................................................................................................................................................................................32
PPTP ...................................................................................................................................................................................33
L2TP....................................................................................................................................................................................34
Japanese PPPoE .............................................................................................................................................................35
Russian PPPoE ................................................................................................................................................................36
Russian PPTP ...................................................................................................................................................................37
Russian L2TP ...................................................................................................................................................................38
WAN2 Settings.........................................................................................................................................................................39
WAN ...................................................................................................................................................................................39
DMZ....................................................................................................................................................................................40
WAN3 (3G Internet) ...............................................................................................................................................................41
WAN Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................42
Single WAN Port.............................................................................................................................................................42
Auto-Rollover using WAN IP ......................................................................................................................................43
Load Balancing...............................................................................................................................................................44
Round Robin ............................................................................................................................................................45
Spillover .....................................................................................................................................................................46
Routing Mode.................................................................................................................................................................47
NAT or Classical .......................................................................................................................................................47
Transparent ..............................................................................................................................................................48
Bridge .........................................................................................................................................................................49
IP Aliasing.........................................................................................................................................................................50
DMZ Settings ..................................................................................................................................................................51
DMZ LAN DHCP Reserved IPs ............................................................................................................................52
Dynamic DNS Settings ................................................................................................................................................53
Traic Management .....................................................................................................................................................54
Bandwidth Proiles.................................................................................................................................................54
Traic Shaping.........................................................................................................................................................56
Routing ......................................................................................................................................................................................57
Static Routes ...................................................................................................................................................................57
RIP .......................................................................................................................................................................................59
OSPF...................................................................................................................................................................................60
Protocol Binding ............................................................................................................................................................62
IPv6 ..............................................................................................................................................................................................63
IP Mode .............................................................................................................................................................................63
WAN Settings ..................................................................................................................................................................64
Dynamic IP ................................................................................................................................................................64
Static IP.......................................................................................................................................................................65
PPPoE ..........................................................................................................................................................................66
Static Routing .................................................................................................................................................................67
OSPFv3 ..............................................................................................................................................................................69
6 to 4 Tunneling .............................................................................................................................................................71
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
vii
Table of Contents
ISATAP................................................................................................................................................................................72
LAN Settings ...................................................................................................................................................................73
DHCPv6 Server ........................................................................................................................................................73
IPv6 Address Pools .................................................................................................................................................75
IPv6 Preix Length ..................................................................................................................................................76
Router Advertisement ..........................................................................................................................................77
Advertisement Preixes ........................................................................................................................................78
IPv6 Tunnels Status ................................................................................................................................................79
Wireless Settings ....................................................................................................................................... 80
Access Points............................................................................................................................................................................80
Proiles ........................................................................................................................................................................................82
Radio Settings .........................................................................................................................................................................84
802.11AC Coniguration ......................................................................................................................................85
WMM Settings .........................................................................................................................................................................86
WDS .............................................................................................................................................................................................87
Advanced Settings .................................................................................................................................................................88
WPS .............................................................................................................................................................................................89
VPN ............................................................................................................................................................. 91
IPSec VPN ..................................................................................................................................................................................92
Policies ..............................................................................................................................................................................92
Tunnel Mode ...................................................................................................................................................................96
Split DNS Names............................................................................................................................................................97
DHCP Range ....................................................................................................................................................................98
Certiicates .......................................................................................................................................................................99
Trusted Certiicates ................................................................................................................................................99
Active Self Certiicates ........................................................................................................................................100
Self Certiicate Requests ....................................................................................................................................101
Easy VPN Setup ............................................................................................................................................................102
PPTP VPN .................................................................................................................................................................................103
Server ..............................................................................................................................................................................103
Client................................................................................................................................................................................104
PPTP Active Users List .........................................................................................................................................105
L2TP VPN .................................................................................................................................................................................106
Server ..............................................................................................................................................................................106
Client................................................................................................................................................................................107
L2TP Active Users List .........................................................................................................................................108
SSL VPN ....................................................................................................................................................................................109
Server Policies ..............................................................................................................................................................109
Portal Layouts ...............................................................................................................................................................111
Resources .......................................................................................................................................................................113
Add New Resource...............................................................................................................................................113
Port Forwarding ....................................................................................................................................................115
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
viii
Table of Contents
Client................................................................................................................................................................................116
Client Routes.................................................................................................................................................................117
Open VPN ................................................................................................................................................................................118
Settings ...........................................................................................................................................................................118
Server........................................................................................................................................................................118
Client.........................................................................................................................................................................119
Access Server Client ............................................................................................................................................120
Local Networks.............................................................................................................................................................121
Remote Networks .......................................................................................................................................................122
Authentication .............................................................................................................................................................123
GRE ............................................................................................................................................................................................124
Security .................................................................................................................................................... 126
Groups ......................................................................................................................................................................................126
Login Policies ................................................................................................................................................................127
Browser Policies ...........................................................................................................................................................128
IP Policies........................................................................................................................................................................129
Users .........................................................................................................................................................................................130
User Management ......................................................................................................................................................130
Import User Database ...............................................................................................................................................131
Create a User Database (CSV File) .........................................................................................................................132
External Authentication Servers .....................................................................................................................................133
RADIUS Server ..............................................................................................................................................................133
POP3 Server...................................................................................................................................................................134
POP3 Trusted Server...................................................................................................................................................135
LDAP Server ..................................................................................................................................................................136
AD Server .......................................................................................................................................................................137
NT Domain Server .......................................................................................................................................................139
Login Proiles .........................................................................................................................................................................140
Web Content Filtering ........................................................................................................................................................143
Static Filtering ..............................................................................................................................................................143
Approved URLs ............................................................................................................................................................144
Blocked Keywords.......................................................................................................................................................145
Dynamic Filtering ........................................................................................................................................................146
Firewall .....................................................................................................................................................................................147
Firewall Rules ................................................................................................................................................................147
Schedules .......................................................................................................................................................................149
Custom Services ..........................................................................................................................................................150
ALGs .................................................................................................................................................................................151
SMTP ALGs ..............................................................................................................................................................152
Approved Mail IDs................................................................................................................................................153
Blocked Mail IDs....................................................................................................................................................154
Mail Filtering ..........................................................................................................................................................155
VPN Passthrough .........................................................................................................................................................156
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ix
Table of Contents
Dynamic Port Forwarding ........................................................................................................................................157
Application Rules .................................................................................................................................................157
Attack Checks ...............................................................................................................................................................159
IntelÂŽ AMT ......................................................................................................................................................................160
IPS .....................................................................................................................................................................................161
Maintenance ............................................................................................................................................ 162
System Settings ....................................................................................................................................................................162
Date and Time .......................................................................................................................................................................163
Session Settings ....................................................................................................................................................................164
License Updates....................................................................................................................................................................165
USB Share Ports.....................................................................................................................................................................166
SMS Service ............................................................................................................................................................................167
Inbox ................................................................................................................................................................................167
Create SMS.....................................................................................................................................................................168
Package Manager .................................................................................................................................................................169
Set Language .........................................................................................................................................................................171
Web GUI Management .......................................................................................................................................................172
Remote Management.........................................................................................................................................................173
SNMP ........................................................................................................................................................................................174
SNMP User List .............................................................................................................................................................174
SNMP Trap List..............................................................................................................................................................175
Access Control ..............................................................................................................................................................176
SNMP System Info .......................................................................................................................................................177
Diagnostics .............................................................................................................................................................................178
Ping an IP Address/Domain Name........................................................................................................................178
Using Traceroute .........................................................................................................................................................179
Performing DNS Lookups.........................................................................................................................................180
Capture Packets ...........................................................................................................................................................181
System Check ...............................................................................................................................................................182
Power Saving ................................................................................................................................................................183
Firmware Upgrade ...............................................................................................................................................................184
Check Update ...............................................................................................................................................................184
Using PC .........................................................................................................................................................................185
Using USB.......................................................................................................................................................................186
Coniguration Files......................................................................................................................................................187
Backup......................................................................................................................................................................187
Restore .....................................................................................................................................................................188
Coniguration Settings .......................................................................................................................................189
Soft Reboot ...................................................................................................................................................................190
Reset to Factory Default Settings ..........................................................................................................................191
Log Settings ...........................................................................................................................................................................192
Deining What to Log.................................................................................................................................................192
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Routing Logs .................................................................................................................................................................194
System Logs ..................................................................................................................................................................195
Remote Logs .................................................................................................................................................................196
Syslog Server ................................................................................................................................................................198
Event Logs .....................................................................................................................................................................199
IPv6 Logs ........................................................................................................................................................................200
Status and Statistics ................................................................................................................................ 201
Dashboard ..............................................................................................................................................................................201
Manage Dashboard ....................................................................................................................................................202
System ......................................................................................................................................................................................203
LAN Info ...................................................................................................................................................................................204
WAN1 ........................................................................................................................................................................................205
WAN2 ........................................................................................................................................................................................206
WAN3 ........................................................................................................................................................................................207
Wireless ....................................................................................................................................................................................208
All Logs.....................................................................................................................................................................................209
Current Logs..................................................................................................................................................................209
Firewall Logs .................................................................................................................................................................210
IPSec VPN Logs .............................................................................................................................................................211
SSL VPN Logs ................................................................................................................................................................212
USB Status ...............................................................................................................................................................................213
Network Information ..........................................................................................................................................................214
DHCP Leased Clients ..................................................................................................................................................214
Active Sessions.............................................................................................................................................................215
Active VPNs....................................................................................................................................................................216
Interface Statistics.......................................................................................................................................................217
View Wireless Clients..................................................................................................................................................218
Device Stats ...................................................................................................................................................................219
Wireless Statistics ........................................................................................................................................................220
View LAN Clients .........................................................................................................................................................221
Troubleshooting ...................................................................................................................................... 222
Internet Connection ............................................................................................................................................................222
Date and time ........................................................................................................................................................................224
Pinging to Test LAN Connectivity ...................................................................................................................................225
Testing the LAN path from your PC to your router ........................................................................................225
Testing the LAN path from your PC to a remote device................................................................................226
Restoring factory-default coniguration settings .....................................................................................................227
Appendix A - Glossary ............................................................................................................................. 228
Appendix B - Factory Default Settings................................................................................................... 230
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
xi
Appendix C - Standard Services for Port Forwarding & Firewall Coniguration ................................ 231
Appendix D - Log Output Reference ...................................................................................................... 232
Appendix E - RJ-45 Pin-outs ................................................................................................................... 295
Appendix F - New Wi Fi Frequency table ( New appendix section ) .................................................... 296
Appendix G - Product Statement ........................................................................................................... 299
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
xii
Section 1 - Introduction
Introduction
D-Link Services Routers ofer a secure, high performance networking solution to address the growing needs
of small and medium businesses. Integrated high-speed IEEE 802.11n/ac and 3G wireless technologies ofer
comparable performance to traditional wired networks, but with fewer limitations. Optimal network security is
provided via features such as virtual private network (VPN) tunnels, IP Security (IPsec), Point-to-Point Tunneling
Protocol (PPTP), Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol (L2TP), and Secure Sockets Layer (SSL). Empower your road warriors
with clientless remote access anywhere and anytime using SSL VPN tunnels.
With the D-Link Services Router you are able to experience a diverse set of beneits:
• Comprehensive Management Capabilities
The DSR-500, DSR-500N, DSR-1000, DSR-1000N, DSR-500AC, and DSR-1000AC include dualWAN Gigabit Ethernet which provides policy-based service management ensuring maximum
productivity for your business operations. The failover feature maintains data traic without
disconnecting when a landline connection is lost. The Outbound Load Balancing feature
adjusts outgoing traic across two WAN interfaces and optimizes the system performance
resulting in high availability. The solution supports coniguring a port as a dedicated DMZ port
allowing you to isolate servers from your LAN.
Note: DSR-150/150N/250/250N product have a single WAN interface, and thus it does not support
Auto Failover and Load Balancing scenarios.
• Superior Wireless Performance
Designed to deliver superior wireless performance, the DSR-500N and DSR-1000N include
802.11 a/b/g/n support, allowing for operation on either the 2.4 GHz or 5 GHz radio bands.
Multiple In Multiple Out (MIMO) technology allows the DSR-500N and DSR-1000N to provide
high data rates with minimal “dead spots” throughout the wireless coverage area.
Next generation wireless performance is available on the DSR-500AC and DSR-1000AC, which
introduce 802.11AC support to the family. Available on the 5 GHz band, the combination of
wider RF bandwidths and up to 8 MIMO streams take data rates available to supporting AC
clients to the next level.
Note: DSR-150N, DSR-250N and DSR-500N support the 2.4GHz radio band only.
• Flexible Deployment Options
The DSR series supports Third Generation (3G) Networks via an extendable USB 3G dongle. This
3G network capability ofers an additional secure data connection for networks that provide
critical services. The product can be conigured to automatically switch to a 3G network
whenever a physical link is lost.
• Robust VPN features
A fully featured virtual private network (VPN) provides your mobile workers and branch oices
with a secure link to your network. The DSR products are capable of simultaneously managing
5, 5, 10, 20 Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) VPN tunnels respectively, empowering your mobile
users by providing remote access to a central corporate database. Site-to-site VPN tunnels
use IP Security (IPsec) Protocol, Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP), or Layer 2 Tunneling
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 1 - Introduction
Protocol (L2TP) to facilitate branch oice connectivity through encrypted virtual links. The
DSR-150/150N, DSR-250/250N, DSR-500/500N and DSR-1000/1000N support 10, 25, 35 and
100 simultaneous IPsec VPN tunnels respectively. The DSR-500AC and DSR-1000AC support 35
and 100 simultaneous IPsec VPN tunnels respectively.
• Eicient D-Link Green Technology
As a concerned member of the global community, D-Link is devoted to providing eco-friendly
products. D-Link Green Wi-Fi and D-Link Green Ethernet save power and prevent waste. The
D-Link Green WLAN scheduler reduces wireless power automatically during of-peak hours.
Likewise the D-Link Green Ethernet program adjusts power usage based on the detected cable
length and link status. In addition, compliance with RoHS (Restriction of Hazardous Substances)
and WEEE (Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment) directives make D-Link Green certiied
devices the environmentally responsible choice.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 2 - Installation
Installation
This section provides information and steps on how to connect your DSR router to your network.
Before you Begin
Observe the following precautions to help prevent shutdowns, equipment failures, and injuries:
• Ensure that the room in which you operate the device has adequate air circulation and that the
room temperature does NOT exceed 40˚C (104˚F).
• Allow 1 meter (3 feet) of clear space to the front and back of the device.
• Do NOT place the device in an equipment rack frame that blocks the air vents on the sides of the
chassis. Ensure that enclosed racks have fans and louvered sides.
• Before installation, please correct these hazardous conditions: moist or wet loors, leaks,
ungrounded or frayed power cables, or missing safety grounds.
Connect to your Network
This section provides basic information about physically connecting the DSR-250 to a network.
1. Connect an Ethernet cable from the port labeled WAN to the external router or modem. The
port WAN is pre-allocated to the WAN network segment.
2. Connect an Ethernet cable from one of the LAN ports to a switch or a computer in the LAN
network segment.
3. Connect an RJ45-to-DB9 cable from the console port for CLI (Command Line Interface)
management access (optional).
Note: Refer to the Quick Installation Guide included with your router for more information on
network connectivity, port, and LED information.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
Basic Coniguration
After you install the router, perform the basic coniguration instructions described in this section which includes:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
“#1 Log in to the Web UI” on page 5
“#2 Change LAN IP Address” on page 6
“#3 Conigure DHCP Server” on page 7
“#4 Set Time and Date” on page 8
“#5 Internet Connection Setup” on page 9
“#6 Wireless Network Setup” on page 12
“#7 Create Users” on page 13
“#8 Security/VPN Wizard” on page 14
“#9 Dynamic DNS Wizard” on page 16
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#1 Log in to the Web UI
The LAN connection may be through the wired Ethernet ports available on the router, or once the initial setup
is complete, the DSR may also be managed through its wireless interface. Access the router’s Web user interface
(Web UI) for management by using any web browser, such as Internet Explorer, Firefox, Chrome, or Safari.
Note: The workstation from which you manage the router must be in the same subnet as the router (192.169.10.0/24).
To access the device with the Web UI:
1. Connect your workstation to an available LAN port on the router.
2. Ensure your workstation has DHCP enabled or is assigned a static IP address within the
192.168.10.0/24 subnet.
Note: Disable pop-up blocking software or add the management IP address http://192.168.10.1 to
your pop-up blocker’s allow list.
3. Launch a browser, enter the IP address for the LAN interface (default = http://192.168.10.1), and
then press Enter.
4. Enter your username (default = admin) and your password (default = admin), then click Login.
5. The web management interface opens with the Status > Dashboard page. This page displays
general, LAN, and WLAN status information. You can return to this page at any time by clicking
Status > Dashboard.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#2 Change LAN IP Address
To change the LAN IP address of the router, follow the steps below:
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Network > LAN > LAN Settings. The LAN Settings page will appear.
3. Under IP Address Setup, enter a new IP address for the router.
4. Enter a new subnet mask if needed.
5. Click Save at the bottom of the page.
Note: If you change the IP address and click Save, the Web UI will not respond. Open a new connection to the new IP
address and log in again. Be sure the LAN host (the machine used to manage the router) has obtained an IP address
from newly assigned pool (or has a static IP address in the router’s LAN subnet) before accessing the router via changed
IP address.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#3 Conigure DHCP Server
To change the DHCP settings of the router, follow the steps below:
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Network > LAN > LAN Settings. The LAN Settings page will appear.
3. From the DHCP Mode drop-down menu under DHCP Setup, select None (disable), DHCP Server
(enable), or DHCP Relay.
Note: DHCP Relay will allow DHCP clients on the LAN to receive IP address leases and corresponding
information from a DHCP server on a diferent subnet. When LAN clients make a DHCP request it will be
passed along to the server accessible via the Relay Gateway IP address you enter.
4. If enabled, ill in the following ields:
Field
Starting IP Address
Ending IP Address
Default Gateway
Domain Name
Lease Time
Conigure DNS/WINS
Description
Enter the starting IP address in the DHCP address pool. Any new DHCP client joining the LAN is assigned an IP address within the starting and ending IP address range. Starting and ending IP addresses should be in the
same IP address subnet as the wireless controller’s LAN IP address.
Enter the ending IP address in the DHCP address pool.
By default this setting is router’s LAN IP address. It can be customized to any
valid IP within the LAN subnet, in the event that the network’s gateway is not
this router. The DHCP server will give the conigured IP address as the Default
Gateway to its DHCP clients.
Enter a domain name.
Enter the time, in hours, for which IP addresses are leased to clients.
Toggle to On and enter DNS and/or WINS server IP address(es).
5. Click Save at the bottom of the page.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#4 Set Time and Date
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Wizard in the upper-right side of the page. If you want to manually conigure your date/time
settings, refer to “Date and Time” on page 163.
3. Click Run in the Date and Time Wizard box.
4. Click the continent from the map and then next to City, select your time zone from the drop-down
menu. Toggle Daylight Saving to ON if it applies to you and then click Next.
5. Toggle NTP server to ON to use a time server or toggle to OFF to manually enter the time and date.
6. If you selected ON, select either Default or Custom from the drop-down menu. If you selected Custom,
enter a primary and secondary NTP server address.
7. Enter the time to synchronize with the NTP server and click Save.
8. A summary page will appear. Verify your settings and then click Finish.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#5 Internet Connection Setup
This router has two WAN ports that can be used to establish a connection to the internet. It is assumed that you
have arranged for internet service with your Internet Service Provider (ISP). Please contact your ISP or network
administrator for the coniguration information that will be required to setup the router. Supported Internet
connection types include Dynamic, Static, PPPoE, PPTP, L2TP, Japanese PPPoE, and Russian PPPoE/PPTP/L2TP.
To conigure your router to connect to the Internet, follow the steps below:
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Wizard in the upper-right side of the page. If you want to manually conigure your Internet
settings, refer to “Connect to the Internet” on page 30.
3. Click Run in the Internet Connection Wizard box.
4. Toggle On next to either DHCP or Static IP Address and click Next. If your connection type is not listed,
refer to “Connect to the Internet” on page 30.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
a. If you selected DHCP, complete the ields below:
Field
MAC Address Source
Host Name
DNS Server Source
Description
This MAC address will be recognized by your ISP. Select from the following three
options:
• Use Default Address - Uses the default MAC address of the router.
• Clone your PC’s MAC Address - Select to use the MAC address of the computer
you are currently connecting with.
• Use this MAC Address - Select to manually enter a MAC address and enter the
address in the box.
Enter a host name if required by your ISP.
Select from the following two options:
• Get Dynamically from ISP - Select to use the DNS servers assigned by your ISP.
• Use these DNS Servers - Select to manually enter a primary and secondary DNS
server address(es).
Skip to Step 5 on the bottom of the next page.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
10
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
b. If you selected Static, complete the ields below:
Field
IP Address
Gateway IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
Description
Enter the IP address assigned by your ISP.
Enter the gateway IP address assigned by your ISP.
Enter the subnet mask assigned by your ISP.
Enter the primary DNS server IP address assigned by your ISP.
Enter the secondary DNS server IP address assigned by your ISP.
5. Click Save. The router will reboot and attempt to connect to your ISP. Please allow one to two minutes
to connect.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
11
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#6 Wireless Network Setup
This wizard provides a step-by-step guide to create and secure a new access point on the router. The network
name (SSID) is the AP identiier that will be detected by supported clients. The Wizard uses a TKIP+AES cipher for
WPA / WPA2 security; depending on support on the client side, devices associate with this AP using either WPA
or WPA2 security with the same pre -shared key.
The wizard has the option to automatically generate a network key for the AP. This key is the pre-shared key
for WPA or WPA2 type security. Supported clients that have been given this PSK can associate with this AP. The
default (auto-assigned) PSK is “passphrase”.
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Wizard in the upper-right side of the page.
3. Click Run in the Wireless Wizard box.
4. The wizard screen will appear.
5. Enter a SSID, which is the name of your wireless network.
6. Next to Network Key Type, select Manual.
7. Enter a password for the wireless network. Wireless devices connecting to this network must enter this
password to connect. The password is case-sensitive.
8. Click Save.
9. A window will appear with a summary of your settings. Click Finish.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
12
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#7 Create Users
The Users Wizard allows you to create user account that you can assign to groups. Refer to “Users” on page 130 for
more information. You may want to create Groups before users so you may assign them to groups as you create
them. To create groups, refer to “Groups” on page 126.
To create new users, follow the steps below:
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Wizard in the upper-right side of the page.
3. Click Run in the Users Wizard box.
4. The wizard screen will appear.
5. Enter a unique user name.
6. Select the group type from the drop-down menu. For more information on groups, refer to “Groups”
on page 126.
7. Enter a password for the user.
8. Enter the password again for conirmation.
9. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
13
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#8 Security/VPN Wizard
The Security Wizard allows you to enable VPN passthrough and create a VPN.
Follow the steps below:
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Wizard in the upper-right side of the page.
3. Click Run in the Security Wizard box.
4. The wizard screen will appear.
5. Select the default outbound policy from the drop-down menu.
6. Toggle which type(s) of VPN you want allowed to pass through the router to ON and click Next.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
14
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
7. You can quickly create both IKE and VPN policies. Once the IKE or VPN policy is created, you can modify
it as required.
8. From the Select VPN Type drop-down menu, select either Site to Site or Remote Access.
9. Next to Connection Name, enter a name for this VPN connection.
10. Next to IP Protocol Version, select either IPv4 or IPv6.
11. Next to IKE Version, select the version of IKE.
12. Next to Pre-Shared Key, enter the pre-shared key used.
13. Next to Local Gateway, select which WAN port used for the local gateway.
14. Next to Remote Gateway Type and Local Gateway Type, select either IP Address or FQDN.
15. Enter the Remote and Local WAN IP Address or FQDN and click Next.
16. Enter the remote network IP address and subnet mask.
17. Enter the local network IP address and subnet mask.
18. Click Save.
Note: The IP address range used on the remote LAN must be diferent from the IP address range used on the local LAN.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
15
Section 3 - Basic Coniguration
#9 Dynamic DNS Wizard
Dynamic DNS (DDNS) is an Internet service that allows routers with varying public IP addresses to be located
using Internet domain names. To use DDNS, you must setup an account with a DDNS provider such as DynDNS.
org, D-Link DDNS, or Oray.net. Refer to “Dynamic DNS Settings” on page 53 for more information.
Follow the steps below:
1. Log in to the router.
2. Click Wizard in the upper-right side of the page.
3. Click Run in the Dynamic DNS Wizard box.
4. The wizard screen will appear.
5. Next to Dynamic DNS, select WAN1 or WAN2.
6. Select the DNS Server Type from the drop-down menu.
7. Depending on your service, enter your DDNS user name, password, and domain name.
8. Toggle Allow Wildcards to ON if required by your DDNS service.
9. Toggle Update Periodically to ON to auto update every 30 days.
10. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
16
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
LAN Coniguration
By default, the router functions as a Dynamic Host Coniguration Protocol (DHCP) server to the hosts on the LAN
and WLAN network. With DHCP, PCs and other LAN devices can be assigned IP addresses as well as addresses
for DNS servers, Windows Internet Name Service (WINS) servers, and the default gateway. With DHCP server
enabled the router’s IP address serves as the gateway address for LAN and WLAN clients. The PCs in the LAN are
assigned IP addresses from a pool of addresses speciied in this procedure. Each pool address is tested before it
is assigned to avoid duplicate addresses on the LAN.
For most applications, the default DHCP and TCP/IP settings are satisfactory. If you want another PC on your
network to be the DHCP server or if you are manually coniguring the network settings of all of your PCs, set the
DHCP mode to ‘none’. DHCP relay can be used to forward DHCP lease information from another DHCP server on
the network. This is particularly useful for wireless clients.
Instead of using a DNS server, you can use a Windows Internet Naming Service (WINS) server. A WINS server is the
equivalent of a DNS server but uses the NetBIOS protocol to resolve host names. The router includes the WINS
server IP address in the DHCP coniguration when acknowledging a DHCP request from a DHCP client.
You can also enable DNS proxy for the LAN. When this is enabled the router then as a proxy for all DNS requests
and communicates with the ISP’s DNS servers. When disabled all DHCP clients receive the DNS IP addresses of
the ISP.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
17
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
LAN Settings
Path: Network > LAN > LAN Settings
To conigure the LAN settings on the router:
1. Click Network > LAN > LAN Settings.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
IP Address
Subnet Mask
DHCP Mode
Description
Enter an new IP address for the router. Default is 192.168.10.1.
Enter the subnet mask for your network. Default is 255.255.255.0.
Select one of the following modes:
• None - Turns of DHCP.
• DHCP Server (default) - The router will act as the DHCP server on your network.
• DHCP Relay - DHCP clients on your network will receive IP address leases from a DHCP
server on a diferent subnet.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
18
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
DHCP Server
1. Select DHCP Server from the drop-down menu.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
DHCP Mode
Description
Select DHCP Server from the drop-down menu.
Enter the starting IP address in the DHCP address pool. Any new DHCP client joining the LAN is
Starting IP Address assigned an IP address within the starting and ending IP address range. Starting and ending IP
addresses must be in the same IP address subnet as the router’s LAN IP address.
Ending IP Address
Enter the ending IP address in the DHCP address pool.
Enter the default gateway IP address you want to assign to your DHCP clients. This IP is usually
Default Gateway
the router’s LAN IP address (default is 192.168.10.1).
Domain Name
Enter a domain name.
Lease Time
Enter the time, in hours, for which IP addresses are leased to clients.
Toggle to On to manually enter DNS and/or WINS server IP address(es). If set to Of, your router’s
Conigure DNS/WINS LAN IP address will be assigned the DNS server to your clients and the router will get the DNS
information from your ISP.
Save
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
19
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
DHCP Relay
1. Select DHCP Relay from the drop-down menu.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
DHCP Mode
Domain Name
Gateway
Save
Description
Select DHCP Relay from the drop-down menu.
Enter the domain name of your network.
Enter the relay gateway IP address.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
20
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
DHCP Reserved IPs
Path: Network > LAN > LAN DHCP Reserved IPs
The router’s DHCP server can assign IP settings to your clients on your network by adding a client’s MAC address
and the IP address to be assigned. Whenever the router receives a request from a client, the MAC address of that
client is compared with the MAC address list present in the database. If an IP address is already assigned to that
computer or device in the database, the customized IP address is conigured otherwise an IP address is assigned
to the client automatically from the DHCP pool.
To create DHCP reservations:
1. Click Network > LAN > LAN DHCP Reserved IPs.
2. Click Add New DHCP Reserved IP.
3. Enter the following information and click Save.
Field
Host Name
IP Address
Description
Enter a host name for this device. Do not use spaces.
Enter the IP address you want to assign to this device. Note that this IP address must be in the
same range as the starting/ending IP address under DHCP Settings.
Enter the MAC address of this device (xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx format). This is not case-sensitive.
MAC Address
Associate with IP/MAC
Toggle ON to associate this device’s information with IP/MAC binding.
Binding
Save
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
21
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
IGMP Setup
Path: Network > LAN > IGMP Setup
IGMP snooping (IGMP Proxy) allows the router to ‘listen’ in on IGMP network traic through the router. This then
allows the router to ilter multicast traic and direct it only to hosts that need this stream. This is helpful when
there is a lot of multicast traic on the network where all LAN hosts do not need to receive this multicast traic.
To enable IGMP Proxy:
1. Click Network > LAN > IGMP Setup.
2. Toggle IGMP Proxy to On.
3. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
22
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
UPnP Setup
Path: Network > LAN > UPnP
Universal Plug and Play (UPnP) is a feature that allows the router to discover devices on the network that can
communicate with the router and allow for auto-coniguration. If a network device is detected by UPnP, the
router can open internal or external ports for the traic protocol required by that network device. If disabled, the
router will not allow for automatic device coniguration and you may have to manually open/forward ports to
allow applications to work.
To conigure the UPnP settings:
1. Click Network > LAN > UPnP.
2. Toggle Activate UPnP to On.
3. Select a VLAN from the LAN Segment drop-down menu.
4. Enter a value for Advertisement Period. This is the frequency that the router broadcasts UPnP information
over the network. A large value will minimize network traic but cause delays in identifying new UPnP
devices to the network.
5. Enter a value for Advertisement Time to Live. This is the number of steps a packet is allowed to propagate
before being discarded. Small values will limit the UPnP broadcast range. A default of 4 is typical for
networks with a few number of switches.
6. Click Save.
7. Your entry will be displayed in the UPnP Port Map List. To edit or delete, right-click an entry and select
the action from the menu. Repeat steps 2-6 to add multiple entries.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
23
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
Jumbo Frames
Path: Network > LAN > Jumbo Frames
Jumbo frames are Ethernet frames with more than 1500 bytes of payload. When this option is enabled, the LAN
devices can exchange information at Jumbo frames rate.
To enable jumbo frames:
1. Click Network > LAN > Jumbo Frames.
2. Toggle Activate Jumbo Frames to On.
3. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
24
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
VLAN
The router supports virtual network isolation on the LAN with the use of VLANs. LAN devices can be conigured
to communicate in a sub network deined by VLAN identiiers. LAN ports can be assigned unique VLAN IDs so
that traic to and from that physical port can be isolated from the general LAN.
VLAN iltering is particularly useful to limit broadcast packets of a device in a large network VLAN support is
enabled by default in the router. In the VLAN Coniguration page, enable VLAN support on the router and then
proceed to the next section to deine the virtual network.
VLAN Settings
Path: Network > VLAN > VLAN Settings
The VLAN List page displays a list of conigured VLANs by name and VLAN ID. A VLAN membership can be created
by clicking the Add New VLAN button below the list.
A VLAN membership entry consists of a VLAN identiier and the numerical VLAN ID which is assigned to the VLAN
membership. The VLAN ID value can be any number from 2 to 4091. VLAN ID 1 is reserved for the default VLAN,
which is used for untagged frames received on the interface.
To create a new VLAN:
1. Click Network > LAN > VLAN Settings.
2. Click Add New VLAN at the bottom.
3. Enter the following required information from the table on the next page.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
25
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
Field
VLAN ID
Name
Captive Portal
Activate InterVLAN
Routing
IP Address
Subnet Mask
DHCP Mode
Enable DNS Proxy
Save
Description
Enter a number between 2 and 4053.
Enter a name for your VLAN.
Toggle ON to enable Captive Portal (refer to the next page for more information).
Toggle ON to allow routing between multiple VLANs or OFF to deny communication between
VLANs.
Enter the IP address for the VLAN.
Enter the subnet mask for the VLAN.
Select one of the following modes:
• None - Turns of DHCP for your VLAN.
• DHCP Server (default) - The router will act as the DHCP server for your VLAN.
• DHCP Relay - DHCP clients on your VLAN will receive IP address leases from a DHCP server
on a diferent subnet.
Toggle ON to enable the router to act as a proxy for all DNS requests and communicate with the
ISP’s DNS servers.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
26
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
Captive Portal
Note: The DSR-150/150N/250/250N routers do not have support for the Captive Portal feature. Captive Portal is
available for LAN users only and not for DMZ hosts.
Captive Portals can be enabled on a per-VLAN basis. Hosts of a particular VLAN can be directed to authenticate
via the Captive Portal, which may be a customized portal with unique instructions and branding as compared to
another VLAN. The most critical aspect of this coniguration page is choosing the authentication server. All users
(VLAN hosts) that want to gain internet access via the selected Captive Portal will be authenticated through the
selected server.
To enable Creative Portal to a speciic VLAN:
1. Click Network > LAN > VLAN Settings.
2. Click Add New VLAN at the bottom or right-click an existing VLAN and select Edit.
3. Toggle Captive Portal to ON.
4. Next to Authentication Server, select an authentication server from the drop-down menu.
5. Next to Login Proile Name, select a proile from the drop-down or click Create a Proile to create a new
one.
6. Select either HTTP or HTTPS for the redirect type.
7. If you want users to enter a CAPTCHA challenge at login, toggle to ON.
8. If you would like communication between VLANs, toggle Activate InterVLAN Routing to ON.
9. Make any other changes/selections and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
27
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
Port/Wireless VLAN
Path: Network > VLAN Settings > Port VLAN
In order to tag all traic through a speciic LAN port with a VLAN ID, you can associate a VLAN to a physical port
and wireless segment.
VLAN membership properties for the LAN and wireless LAN are listed on this page. The VLAN Port table displays
the port identiier, the mode setting for that port and VLAN membership information. The coniguration page is
accessed by selecting one of the four physical ports or a conigured access point and clicking Edit.
To edit, right-click on the port and select Edit. The edit page ofers the following coniguration options:
• Mode: The mode of this VLAN can be General, Access (default), or Trunk. Refer to the next page for
more information on the diferent modes.
• Select PVID for the port when General mode is selected.
• Conigured VLAN memberships will be displayed on the VLAN Membership Coniguration for the
port. By selecting one more VLAN membership options for a General or Trunk port, traic can be
routed between the selected VLAN membership IDs.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
28
Section 4 - LAN Coniguration
In Access mode the port is a member of a single VLAN
(and only one). All data going into and out of the port is
untagged. Traic through a port in access mode looks
like any other Ethernet frame.
In General mode the port is a member of a user selectable
set of VLANs. The port sends and receives data that is
tagged or untagged with a VLAN ID. If the data into the
port is untagged, it is assigned the deined PVID.
For example, if Port 3 is a General port with PVID 3, then
the untagged data into Port 3 will be assigned PVID 3. All
tagged data sent out of the port with the same PVID will
be untagged. This is mode is typically used with IP Phones
that have dual Ethernet ports. Data coming from phone
to the switch port on the router will be tagged. Data
passing through the phone from a connected device will
be untagged.
Note: The DSR-150/150N do not support General mode due
to hardware limitations.
In Trunk mode the port is a member of a user
selectable set of VLANs. All data going into and out
of the port is tagged. Untagged coming into the port
is not forwarded, except for the default VLAN with
PVID=1, which is untagged. Trunk ports multiplex
traic for multiple VLANs over the same physical link.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
29
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Connect to the Internet
This router has two WAN ports that can be used to establish a connection to the internet. It is assumed that you
have arranged for internet service with your Internet Service Provider (ISP). Please contact your ISP or network
administrator for the coniguration information that will be required to setup the router.
Dynamic IP
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select Dynamic IP (DHCP) to obtain IP address information automatically from your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Host Name
Description
Enter a host name if required by your ISP.
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS
DNS Server Source
servers
Primary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Secondary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your
MAC Address Source modem/ISP, Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently
using to associate with your modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
MAC Address
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
MTU Size
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Custom MTU
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
Port Speed
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Save
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
30
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Static IP
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select Static IP to manually enter the Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
Gateway IP Address
Description
Enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
Enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
Enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS
DNS Server Source
servers.
Primary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Secondary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your
MAC Address Source modem/ISP, Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently
using to associate with your modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
MAC Address
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
MTU Size
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Custom MTU
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
Port Speed
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Save
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
31
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
PPPoE
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select PPPoE to enter the PPPoE Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Address Mode
User Name
Password
Service
Authentication Type
Description
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP).
Enter your PPPoE user name.
Enter your PPPoE password.
Enter if your ISP requires it.
Select the authentication type from the drop-down menu.
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will
Reconnect Mode
have the router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select
Always On to have the router stay connected to the Internet.
IP Address
If you selected Static IP, enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
IP Subnet Mask
If you selected Static IP, enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
Gateway IP Address If you selected Static IP, enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS
DNS Server Source
servers.
Primary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Secondary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your
MAC Address Source modem/ISP, Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently
using to associate with your modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
MAC Address
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
MTU Size
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Custom MTU
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
Port Speed
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Save
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
32
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
PPTP
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select PPTP to enter the PPTP Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Address Mode
Server Address
User Name
Password
MPPE Encryption
Split Tunnel
Reconnect Mode
IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
Gateway IP Address
DNS Server Source
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
MAC Address Source
MAC Address
MTU Size
Custom MTU
Port Speed
Save
Description
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP).
Enter your PPTP server address.
Enter your PPTP user name.
Enter your PPTP password.
Toggle to ON and select the level of MPPE encryption.
Toggle to ON to use split tunnelling. This will allow you to connect to a VPN and Internet using the same
physical connection.
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will have the
router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select Always On to have the
router stay connected to the Internet.
If you selected Static IP, enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS servers.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your modem/ISP,
Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently using to associate with your
modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
33
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
L2TP
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select L2TP to enter the L2TP Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Address Mode
Server Address
User Name
Password
Secret
Split Tunnel
Reconnect Mode
IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
Gateway IP Address
DNS Server Source
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
MAC Address Source
MAC Address
MTU Size
Custom MTU
Port Speed
Save
Description
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP).
Enter your PPTP server address.
Enter your PPTP user name.
Enter your PPTP password.
Enter a shared secret if required.
Toggle to ON to use split tunnelling. This will allow you to connect to a VPN and Internet using the same
physical connection.
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will have the
router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select Always On to have the
router stay connected to the Internet.
If you selected Static IP, enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS servers.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your modem/ISP,
Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently using to associate with your
modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
34
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Japanese PPPoE
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select Japanese PPPoE to enter the PPPoE Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Address Mode
User Name
Password
Service
Authentication Type
Description
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP).
Enter your PPPoE user name.
Enter your PPPoE password.
Enter if your ISP requires it.
Select the authentication type from the drop-down menu.
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will
Reconnect Mode
have the router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select
Always On to have the router stay connected to the Internet.
IP Address
If you selected Static IP, enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
IP Subnet Mask
If you selected Static IP, enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
Gateway IP Address If you selected Static IP, enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
Primary PPPoE DNS Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS
Servers
servers.
Primary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Secondary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Secondary PPPoE
You may create a secondary PPPoE proile.
Proile
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your
MAC Address Source modem/ISP, Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently
using to associate with your modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
MAC Address
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
Port Speed
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Save
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
35
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Russian PPPoE
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select Russian PPPoE to enter the PPPoE Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Address Mode
User Name
Password
Service
Authentication Type
Description
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP).
Enter your PPPoE user name.
Enter your PPPoE password.
Enter if your ISP requires it.
Select the authentication type from the drop-down menu.
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will have
Reconnect Mode
the router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select Always On
to have the router stay connected to the Internet.
IP Address
If you selected Static IP, enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
IP Subnet Mask
If you selected Static IP, enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
Gateway IP Address If you selected Static IP, enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
DNS Server Source
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS servers.
Primary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Secondary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your
MAC Address Source modem/ISP, Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently using
to associate with your modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
MAC Address
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP). If you select Static IP, enter the IP
WAN2 Physical Setting
settings supplied by your ISP.
WAN2 Physical DNS Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS servers.
Port Speed
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Save
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
36
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Russian PPTP
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select Russian PPTP to enter the PPTP Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Address Mode
Server Address
User Name
Password
MPPE Encryption
Split Tunnel
Reconnect Mode
IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
Gateway IP Address
DNS Server Source
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
MAC Address Source
MAC Address
MTU Size
Custom MTU
Port Speed
Save
Description
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP).
Enter your PPTP server address.
Enter your PPTP user name.
Enter your PPTP password.
Toggle to ON and select the level of MPPE encryption.
Toggle to ON to use split tunnelling. This will allow you to connect to a VPN and Internet using the same
physical connection.
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will have the
router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select Always On to have the
router stay connected to the Internet.
If you selected Static IP, enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS servers.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your modem/ISP,
Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently using to associate with your
modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
37
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Russian L2TP
Path: Network > Internet > WAN1 Settings
Select Russian L2TP to enter the L2TP Internet settings supplied by your Internet Service Provider.
Field
Address Mode
Server Address
User Name
Password
Secret
Split Tunnel
Reconnect Mode
IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
Gateway IP Address
DNS Server Source
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
MAC Address Source
MAC Address
MTU Size
Custom MTU
Port Speed
Save
Description
Select Dynamic IP or Static IP (IP settings supplied by your ISP).
Enter your PPTP server address.
Enter your PPTP user name.
Enter your PPTP password.
Enter a shared secret if required.
Toggle to ON to use split tunnelling. This will allow you to connect to a VPN and Internet using the same
physical connection.
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will have the
router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select Always On to have the
router stay connected to the Internet.
If you selected Static IP, enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the subnet mask supplied by your ISP.
If you selected Static IP, enter the gateway IP address supplied by your ISP.
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS servers.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Select Use Default MAC to use the MAC address from the WAN1 port to associate with your modem/ISP,
Clone your PC’s MAC to use the MAC address of the computer you are currently using to associate with your
modem/ISP, or Use this MAC to manually enter a MAC address.
If you selected Use this MAC, enter the MAC address you want to associate with your ISP.
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
Select a value from the drop-down menu. The default value is Auto-Sense.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
38
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
WAN2 Settings
Path: Network > Internet > WAN2 Settings
Select WAN and select the Internet connection type. Please refer to the previous pages (41-49) for more
information. If you want to set WAN2 port to DMZ, skip to the next page.
WAN
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
39
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
DMZ
This router supports one of the physical ports to be conigured as a secondary WAN Ethernet port or a dedicated
DMZ port. A DMZ is a sub network that is open to the public but behind the irewall. The DMZ adds an additional
layer of security to the LAN, as speciic services/ports that are exposed to the internet on the DMZ do not have
to be exposed on the LAN. It is recommended that hosts that must be exposed to the internet (such as web or
email servers) be placed in the DMZ network.
Firewall rules can be allowed to permit access speciic services/ports to the DMZ from both the LAN or WAN. In
the event of an attack to any of the DMZ nodes, the LAN is not necessarily vulnerable as well.
DMZ coniguration is identical to the LAN coniguration. There are no restrictions on the IP address or subnet
assigned to the DMZ port, other than the fact that it cannot be identical to the IP address given to the LAN
interface of this gateway.
Note: DSR-500/1000/500N/1000N/500AC/1000AC, in order to conigure a DMZ port, the router’s conigurable port
must be set to DMZ in the Network > Internet > DMZ Settings page.
Note: For DSR-150N and DSR-250N, enabling DMZ will result in port 8 of the LAN switch being used for a dedicated
DMZ port. The other 7 LAN ports remain unchanged.
1. Click Network > Internet > WAN2 / DMZ Settings.
2. Select DMZ and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
40
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
WAN3 (3G Internet)
Path: Network > Internet > WAN3 Settings
This router supports the use of 3G Internet access. Cellular 3G internet access is available on WAN3 via a 3G USB
modem for DSR series. The cellular ISP that provides the 3G data plan will provide the authentication requirements
to establish a connection. The dial Number and APN are speciic to the cellular carriers. Once the connection type
settings are conigured and saved, navigate to the WAN status page (Setup > Internet Settings > WAN3 Status)
and Enable the WAN3 link to establish the 3G connection.
Field
Description
Some ISPs may require you to pay for usage time. Select On Demand if this is the case. This will have the
Reconnect Mode
router connect to the Internet only when you initiate an Internet connection. Select Always On to have the
router stay connected to the Internet.
Maximum Idle Time
Enter the idle time in minutes before the router disconnects from the Internet (On Demand only).
User Name
Enter your 3G account user name.
Password
Enter your 3G account password.
Dial-in Number
Enter the phone number to access your Internet.
Authentication Protocol Select one of following protocols from the drop-down menu: None, PAP or CHAP.
APN Required
Toggle to ON if your ISP requires APN to connect.
APN
Enter the APN (Access Point Name) provided by the ISP.
DNS Server Source
Select either Get Dynamically from ISP or Use These DNS Servers to manually enter DNS servers.
Primary DNS Server
If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Secondary DNS Server If you selected “Use These DNS Servers”, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
MTU Size
Select to use the default MTU value (1500) or select Custom to enter your own value.
Custom MTU
Enter a MTU value to optimize performance with your ISP.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
41
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Path: Network > Internet > WAN Mode
WAN Mode
This router supports multiple WAN links. This allows you to take advantage of failover and load balancing
features to ensure certain internet dependent services are prioritized in the event of unstable WAN connectivity
on one of the ports.
To use Auto Failover or Load Balancing, WAN link failure detection must be conigured. This involves accessing
DNS servers on the internet or ping to an internet address (user deined). If required, you can conigure the
number of retry attempts when the link seems to be disconnected or the threshold of failures that determines
if a WAN port is down.
Single WAN Port
If you do not want to use Auto Failover or Load Balancing, select Single WAN Port from the WAN Mode drop-down
menu and select the WAN port you want to set. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
42
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Auto-Rollover using WAN IP
In this mode one of your WAN ports is assigned as the primary internet link for all internet traic and the
secondary WAN port is used for redundancy in case the primary link goes down for any reason. Both WAN ports
(primary and secondary) must be conigured to connect to the respective ISP’s before enabling this feature. The
secondary WAN port will remain unconnected until a failure is detected on the primary link (either port can be
assigned as the primary). In the event of a failure on the primary port, all internet traic will be rolled over to
the backup port. When conigured in Auto-Failover mode, the link status of the primary WAN port is checked at
regular intervals as deined by the failure detection settings.
1. Click Network > Internet > WAN Mode.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Description
WAN Mode
Select Auto-Rollover Using WAN IP from the drop-down menu.
Use Primary WAN Port Select which WAN port is the primary.
Use Secondary WAN Port Select which port to use if the primary port fails.
• DNS lookup using WAN DNS Servers: DNS Lookup of the DNS Servers of the primary link is used to
detect primary WAN connectivity.
• DNS lookup using DNS Servers: DNS Lookup of the custom DNS Servers can be speciied to check the
connectivity of the primary link.
• Ping these IP addresses: These IP’s will be pinged at regular intervals to check the connectivity of the
WAN Health Check
primary link.
• Retry Interval is: The number tells the router how often it should run the above conigured failure
detection method.
• Failover after: This sets the number of retries after which failover is initiated.
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3
Enter the DNS server or IP address to ping.
Retry Interval
Enter the time in seconds to initiate the WAN health check. Default is every 30 seconds.
Failover After
Enter the number of failures before the router will enable the failover process.
Note: The DSR series routers support 3G USB Modem as a failover link when the internet access is lost.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
43
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Load Balancing
Path: Network > Internet > WAN Mode
This feature allows you to use multiple WAN links (and presumably multiple ISP’s) simultaneously. After
coniguring more than one WAN port, the load balancing option is available to carry traic over more than one
link. Protocol bindings are used to segregate and assign services over one WAN port in order to manage internet
low. The conigured failure detection method is used at regular intervals on all conigured WAN ports when in
Load Balancing mode.
This router currently supports three algorithms for Load Balancing:
Round Robin: This algorithm is particularly useful when the connection speed of one WAN port greatly
difers from another. In this case you can deine protocol bindings to route low-latency services (such
as VOIP) over the higher -speed link and let low-volume background traic (such as SMTP) go over the
lower speed link. Protocol binding is explained in next section.
Spillover: If Spillover method is selected, the primary WAN acts as a dedicated link until a deined
bandwidth threshold are reached. After this, the secondary WAN will be used for new connections.
Inbound connections on the secondary WAN are permitted with this mode, as the spillover logic governs
outbound connections moving from the primary to secondary WAN. You can conigure spillover mode
by using following options:
• Load Tolerance: It is the percentage of bandwidth after which the router switches to
secondary WAN.
• Max Bandwidth: This sets the maximum bandwidth tolerable by the primary WAN for
outbound traic.
If the link bandwidth of outbound traic goes above the load tolerance value of max bandwidth, the
router will spillover the next connections to secondary WAN.
For example, if the maximum bandwidth of primary WAN is 1Kbps and the load tolerance is set to 70. Now
every time a new connection is established the bandwidth increases. After a certain number of connections say
bandwidth reached 70% of 1Kbps, the new outbound connections will be spilled over to secondary WAN. The
maximum value of load tolerance is 80% and the minimum is 20%.
Note: The DSR-1000, DSR-1000N, DSR-500, and DSR-500N routers support the traic load balancing between physical
WAN port and a 3G USB Modem.
Load balancing is particularly useful when the connection speed of one WAN port greatly difers from another.
In this case you can deine protocol bindings to route low-latency services (such as VOIP) over the higher-speed
link and let low-volume background traic (such as SMTP) go over the lower speed link.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
44
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Round Robin
1. Click Network > Internet > WAN Mode.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
WAN Mode
Load Balance
WAN Health Check
Save
Description
Select Load Balancing from the drop-down menu.
Select Round Robin.
• DNS lookup using WAN DNS Servers: DNS Lookup of the DNS Servers of the primary link is used to
detect primary WAN connectivity.
• DNS lookup using DNS Servers: DNS Lookup of the custom DNS Servers can be speciied to check the
connectivity of the primary link.
• Ping these IP addresses: These IP’s will be pinged at regular intervals to check the connectivity of the
primary link.
• Retry Interval is: The number tells the router how often it should run the above conigured failure
detection method.
• Failover after: This sets the number of retries after which failover is initiated.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
45
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Spillover
1. Click Network > Internet > WAN Mode.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
WAN Mode
Load Balance
WAN Health Check
Retry Interval is
Failover After
Load Tolerance
Max Bandwidth
Save
Description
Select Load Balancing from the drop-down menu.
Select Spillover Mode.
• DNS lookup using WAN DNS Servers: DNS Lookup of the DNS Servers of the primary link is used to
detect primary WAN connectivity.
• DNS lookup using DNS Servers: DNS Lookup of the custom DNS Servers can be speciied to check the
connectivity of the primary link.
• Ping these IP addresses: These IP’s will be pinged at regular intervals to check the connectivity of the
primary link.
• Retry Interval is: The number tells the router how often it should run the above conigured failure
detection method.
• Failover after: This sets the number of retries after which failover is initiated.
Enter the time in seconds to initiate the WAN health check. Default is every 30 seconds.
Enter the number of failures before the router will enable the failover process.
Enter the percentage of bandwidth after which the router switches to the secondary WAN.
This sets the maximum bandwidth tolerable by the primary WAN for outbound traic.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
46
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Routing Mode
Routing between the LAN and WAN will impact the way this router handles traic that is received on any of
its physical interfaces. The routing mode of the gateway is core to the behavior of the traic low between the
secure LAN and the internet.
NAT or Classical
Path: Network > Internet > Routing Mode
With classical routing, devices on the LAN can be directly accessed from the internet with their public IP addresses
(assuming appropriate irewall settings are conigured). If your ISP has assigned an IP address for each of the
computers/devices that you use, select Classical.
NAT is a technique which allows several computers and devices on your local network to share an Internet
connection. The computers on the LAN use a “private” IP address range while the WAN port on the router is
conigured with a single “public” IP address. Along with connection sharing, NAT also hides internal IP addresses
from the computers on the Internet. NAT is required if your ISP has assigned only one IP address to you. The
computers/devices that connect through the router will need to be assigned IP addresses from a private subnet.
1. Click Network > Internet > Routing Mode.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Routing Settings
NAT with WAN1
NAT with WAN2
Save
Description
Select NAT or Classical.
Toggle to ON to use NAT with WAN1 or OFF for classical.
Toggle to ON to use NAT with WAN2 or OFF for classical.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
47
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Transparent
When Transparent Routing Mode is enabled, NAT is not performed on traic between the LAN and WAN
interfaces. Broadcast and multicast packets that arrive on the LAN interface are switched to the WAN and vice
versa, if they do not get iltered by irewall or VPN policies. To maintain the LAN and WAN in the same broadcast
domain select Transparent mode, which allows bridging of traic from LAN to WAN and vice versa, except
for router-terminated traic and other management traic. All DSR features (such as 3G modem support) are
supported in transparent mode assuming the LAN and WAN are conigured to be in the same broadcast domain.
Note: NAT routing has a feature called “NAT Hair -pinning” that allows internal network users on the LAN and DMZ to
access internal servers (e.g., an internal FTP server) using their externally-known domain name. This is also referred to as
“NAT loopback” since LAN generated traic is redirected through the irewall to reach LAN servers by their external name.
1. Click Network > Internet > Routing.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Routing Settings
Save
Description
Select Transparent.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
48
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Bridge
When Bridge Mode routing is enabled, the irst physical LAN port and secondary WAN/DMZ (port 2) interfaces
are bridged together at Layer 2, creating an aggregate network. The other LAN ports and the primary WAN
(WAN1) are not part of this bridge, and the router asks as a NAT device for these other ports. With Bridge mode
for the LAN port 1 and WAN2/DMZ interfaces, L2 and L3 broadcast traic as well as ARP / RARP packets are
passed through. When WAN2 receives tagged traic the tag information will be removed before the packet is
forwarded to the LAN port 1 interface.
Note: Bridge mode option is available on DSR-500 / 500N / 500AC 1000 / 1000N / 1000AC routers only.
1. Click Network > Internet > Routing.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Routing Settings
Bridge Interface IP Address
DMZ Interface IP Address
Subnet Mask
NAT with WAN1
Save
Description
Select Bridge.
Enter the bridge interface IP address.
Enter the DMZ interface IP address.
Enter the subnet mask.
Toggle ON to turn NAT on WAN1 or OFF for classical.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
49
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
IP Aliasing
Path: Network > Internet > IP Aliasing
A single WAN Ethernet port can be accessed via multiple IP addresses by adding an alias to the port. This is done
by coniguring an IP Alias address. To edit or delete any existing aliases, right-click the alias and select either Edit
or Delete.
To create a new alias:
1. Click Network > Internet > IP Aliasing.
2. Click Add New IP Aliasing.
3. Enter the following information and click Save.
Field
Interface
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Save
Description
Select either WAN1 or WAN2.
Enter an alias IP address for the WAN interface you selected.
Enter a subnet mask for the WAN interface you selected.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
50
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
DMZ Settings
Path: Network > Internet > DMZ Settings
If you set WAN2 port to DMZ, you will need to conigure the port here.
To conigure the DMZ Settings:
1. Click Network > Internet > DMZ Settings.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
IP Address
Subnet Mask
DHCP Mode
DHCP Server
DHCP Relay
Enable DNS Proxy
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
WINS Server
Save
Description
Enter an IP address for the DMZ interface.
Enter the subnet mask for the DMZ interface.
Select one of the following modes:
• None - Turns of DHCP.
• DHCP Server (default) - The router will act as the DHCP server on your network.
• DHCP Relay - DHCP clients on your network will receive IP address leases from a DHCP server on a
diferent subnet.
Refer to “DHCP Server” on page 19 for more information.
Refer to “DHCP Relay” on page 20 for more information.
Toggle to On to manually enter DNS and/or WINS server IP address(es). If set to Of, your router’s LAN
IP address will be assigned the DNS server to your clients and the router will get the DNS information
from your ISP.
If DNS Proxy is set to ON, enter the primary DNS server IP address.
If DNS Proxy is set to ON, enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
If DNS Proxy is set to ON, enter the WINS server IP address.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
51
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
DMZ LAN DHCP Reserved IPs
The router’s DHCP server can assign IP settings to your DMZ clients on your network by adding a client’s MAC
address and the IP address to be assigned. Whenever the router receives a request from a client, the MAC address
of that client is compared with the MAC address list present in the database. If an IP address is already assigned
to that computer or device in the database, the customized IP address is conigured otherwise an IP address is
assigned to the client automatically from the DMZ DHCP pool.
To create DHCP reservations:
1. Click Network > Internet > DMZ LAN DHCP Reserved IPs.
2. Click Add New DMZ DHCP Reserved IP.
3. Enter the following information and click Save.
Field
Description
DMZ DHCP Reserved IP
Toggle to ON to enable this reservation.
Enable
Enter the IP address you want to assign to this device. Note that this IP address must be in the
IP Address
same range as the starting/ending IP address under DHCP Settings.
MAC Address
Enter the MAC address of this device (xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx format).
Save
Click Save to save your reservation.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
52
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Dynamic DNS Settings
Path: Network > Internet > Dynamic DNS
Dynamic DNS (DDNS) is an Internet service that allows routers with varying public IP addresses to be located
using Internet domain names. To use DDNS, you must setup an account with a DDNS provider such as DynDNS.
org, D-Link DDNS, or Oray.net.
Each conigured WAN can have a diferent DDNS service if required. Once conigured, the router will update
DDNS services changes in the WAN IP address so that features that are dependent on accessing the router’s WAN
via FQDN will be directed to the correct IP address. When you set up an account with a DDNS service, the host
and domain name, username, password and wildcard support will be provided by the account provider.
To conigure DDNS:
1. Click Network > Internet > Dynamic DNS
2. Click the tab on top to select which WAN port you want to conigure DDNS to.
3. Next to Dynamic DNS Service Type, select your DDNS service.
4. Enter the following information and click Save. The information below is for DynDNS. Other services
will have similar ields.
Field
User Name
Domain Name
Password
Status
Allow Wildcards
Update Periodically
Save
Description
Enter your DDNS user name.
Enter the domain name.
Enter your DDNS password.
Displays the current connection status.
Toggle to ON to allow wildcards.
Toggle to ON to set a forced update.
Click Save to save your reservation.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
53
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Traic Management
Bandwidth Proiles
Path: Network > Internet > Traic Management > Bandwidth Proiles
Bandwidth proiles allow you to regulate the traic low from the LAN to WAN 1 or WAN 2. This is useful to ensure
that low priority LAN users (like guests or HTTP service) do not monopolize the available WAN’s bandwidth for
cost-savings or bandwidth-priority-allocation purposes.
Bandwidth proiles coniguration consists of enabling the bandwidth control feature from the GUI and adding
a proile which deines the control parameters. The proile can then be associated with a traic selector, so that
bandwidth proile can be applied to the traic matching the selectors. Selectors are elements like IP addresses
or services that would trigger the conigured bandwidth regulation.
To edit, delete, or create a new bandwidth proile:
1. Click Network > Internet > Traic Management > Bandwidth Proiles.
2. Toggle Enable Bandwidth Proiles to ON and click Save.
3. Click Add New Bandwidth Proile.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
54
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
4. Enter the following information and click Save.
Field
Name
Policy Type
WAN Interface
Description
Enter a name for your proile. This identiier is used to associate the conigured proile to the
traic selector.
Select the policy type (Inbound or Outbound) from the drop-down menu.
Select which WAN interface you want to associate this proile with.
Proile Type
Select either Priority or Rate from the drop-down menu.
Priority
Minimum Bandwidth Rate
Maximum Bandwidth Rate
Save
If you selected Priority, select Low, Medium, or High.
If you selected Rate, enter the minimum bandwidth rate.
If you selected Rate, enter the maximum bandwidth rate.
Click Save to save your reservation.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
55
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Traic Shaping
Path: Network > Internet > Traic Management > Traic Shaping
Once a proile has been created it can then be associated with a traic low from the LAN to WAN. Traic selector
coniguration binds a bandwidth proile to a type or source of LAN traic with the following settings.
To create a traic selector:
1. Click Network > Internet > Traic Management > Traic Shaping.
2. Click Add New Traic Selector.
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Description
Available Proiles
Select a bandwidth proile from the drop-down menu.
Service
Select a service from the drop-down menu.
Traic Selector Match Type Select IP or MAC Address.
IP Address
Subnet Mask
MAC Address
Save
If you selected IP, enter the IP address of the source associated with this proile.
If you selected IP, enter a subnet mask.
If you selected MAC, enter the MAC address of the source associated with this proile.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
56
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Routing
Static Routes
Path: Network > Routing > Static Routes
Manually adding static routes to this device allows you to deine the path selection of traic from one interface
to another. There is no communication between this router and other devices to account for changes in the path;
once conigured the static route will be active and efective until the network changes.
The List of Static Routes displays all routes that have been added manually by an administrator and allows several
operations on the static routes.
To create a new static route:
1. Click Network > Routing > Static Routes.
2. Click Add New Static Route.
3. Complete the ields in the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
57
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Field
Route Name
Active
Private
Destination IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
Interface
Gateway IP Address
Metric
Save
Description
Enter a name for your route.
Toggle to ON to activate this route or to OFF to deactivate.
Toggle to ON to make this route private. If the route is made private, then the route will not be shared
in a RIP broadcast or multicast.
Enter the IP address of the static route’s destination.
Enter the subnet mask of the static route.
The physical network interface (WAN1, WAN2, WAN3, DMZ or LAN), through which this route is
accessible.
IP address of the gateway through which the destination host or network can be reached.
Determines the priority of the route. If multiple routes to the same destination exist, the route with
the lowest metric is chosen.
Click Save to save your route.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
58
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
RIP
Path: Network > Routing > RIP
Dynamic routing using the Routing Information Protocol (RIP) is an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) that is
common in LANs. With RIP this router can exchange routing information with other supported routers in the
LAN and allow for dynamic adjustment of routing tables in order to adapt to modiications in the LAN without
interrupting traic low.
Note: The DSR-150/150N/250/250N routers do not support RIP.
To conigure RIP:
1. Click Network > Routing > RIP.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Direction
Version
Save
Description
The RIP direction will deine how this router sends and receives RIP packets. Select one of the following:
• Both: The router both broadcasts its routing table and also processes RIP information received
from other routers. This is the recommended setting in order to fully utilize RIP capabilities.
• Out Only: The router broadcasts its routing table periodically but does not accept RIP information
from other routers.
• In Only: The router accepts RIP information from other routers, but does not broadcast its routing
table.
• None: The router neither broadcasts its route table nor does it accept any RIP packets from other
routers. This efectively disables RIP.
The RIP version is dependent on the RIP support of other routing devices in the LAN.
• Disabled: This is the setting when RIP is disabled.
• RIP-1: A class-based routing version that does not include subnet information. This is the most
commonly supported version.
• RIP-2: Includes all the functionality of RIPv1 plus it supports subnet information. Though the data
is sent in RIP-2 format for both RIP-2B and RIP-2M, the mode in which packets are sent is diferent.
RIP-2B broadcasts data in the entire subnet while RIP-2M sends data to multicast addresses.
Note: If RIP-2B or RIP-2M is the selected version, authentication between this router and other
routers (conigured with the same RIP version) is required. MD5 authentication is used in a irst/
second key exchange process. The authentication key validity lifetimes are conigurable to ensure
that the routing information exchange is with current and supported routers detected on the LAN.
Click Save to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
59
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
OSPF
Path: Network > Routing > OSPF
OSPF is an interior gateway protocol that routes Internet Protocol (IP) packets solely within a single routing
domain. It gathers link state information from available routers and constructs a topology map of the network.
OSPF version 2 is a routing protocol which described in RFC2328 - OSPF Version 2. OSPF is IGP (Interior Gateway
Protocols). OSPF is widely used in large networks such as ISP backbone and enterprise networks.
Note: The DSR-150/150N/250/250N routers do not support OSPFv2.
To conigure OSPF:
1. Click Network > Routing > OSPF.
2. Right-click the port you want to edit (LAN/WAN1/WAN2/WAN3) and select Edit.
3. Complete the ields in the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
60
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Field
OSPFv2 Enable
Interface
Area
Priority
Hello Interval
Dead Interval
Cost
Authentication Type
Md5 Key ID
Md5 Authentication Key
Save
Description
Toggle ON to enable OSPF.
Displays the physical network interface on which OSPFv2 is Enabled/Disabled.
Enter the area to which the interface belongs. Two routers having a common segment; their interfaces
have to belong to the same area on that segment. The interfaces should belong to the same subnet and
have similar mask.
Helps to determine the OSPFv2 designated router for a network. The router with the highest priority
will be more eligible to become Designated Router. Setting the value to 0 makes the router ineligible to
become Designated Router. The default value is 1. Lower the value means higher the priority.
The number of seconds for Hello Interval timer value. Enter the number in seconds that the Hello packet
will be sent. This value must be the same for all routers attached to a common network. The default
value is 10 seconds.
The number of seconds that a device’s hello packets must not have been seen before its neighbors
declare the OSPF router down. This value must be the same for all routers attached to a common
network. The default value is 40 seconds. OSPF requires these intervals to be exactly the same between
two neighbors. If any of these intervals are diferent, these routers will not become neighbors on a
particular segment.
Enter the cost of sending a packet on an OSPFv2 interface.
Select one of the following authentication types:
• None: The interface does not authenticate OSPF packets.
• Simple: OSPF packets are authenticated using simple text key.
• MD5: The interface authenticates OSPF packets with MD5 authentication.
If MD5 authentication is selected, enter the MD5 key ID.
If MD5 authentication is selected, enter the MD5 authentication key.
Click Save to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
61
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Protocol Binding
Path: Network > Routing > Protocol Binding
Protocol bindings are useful when the Load Balancing feature is in use. Selecting from a list of conigured services
or any of the user-deined services, the type of traic can be assigned to go over only one of the available WAN
ports. For increased lexibility the source network or machines can be speciied as well as the destination network
or machines. For example, the VOIP traic for a set of LAN IP addresses can be assigned to one WAN and any
VOIP traic from the remaining IP addresses can be assigned to the other WAN link. Protocol bindings are only
applicable when load balancing mode is enabled and more than one WAN is conigured.
To add, edit, or delete a protocol binding entry:
1. Click Network > Routing > Protocol Binding.
2. Right-click a current entry and select Edit or Delete. To add a new entry, click Add New Protocol Binding.
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Service
Local Gateway
Source Network
Destination Network
Save
Description
Select a service from the drop-down menu.
Select a WAN interface.
Select the source network: Any, Single Address, or Address Range. If Single Address or Address
Range is selected, enter the IP address or IP range.
Select the destination network: Any, Single Address, or Address Range. If Single Address or Address
Range is selected, enter the IP address or IP range.
Click Save to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
62
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
IPv6
IP Mode
Path: Network > IPv6 > IP Mode
This page allows you to conigure the IP protocol version to be used on the router. In order to support IPv6 on
your local network (LAN), you must set the router to be in IPv4 / IPv6 mode. This mode will allow IPv4 nodes to
communicate with IPv6 devices through this router.
To enable IPv6 on the router:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > IP Mode.
2. Select IPv4 & IPv6.
3. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
63
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
WAN Settings
Path: Network > IPv6 > WAN1 Settings
For IPv6 WAN connections, this router can have a static IPv6 address or receive connection information when
conigured as a DHCPv6 client. In the case where the ISP assigns you a ixed address to access the internet, the
static coniguration settings must be completed. In addition to the IPv6 address assigned to your router, the
IPv6 preix length deined by the ISP is needed. The default IPv6 Gateway address is the server at the ISP that
this router will connect to for accessing the internet. The primary and secondary DNS servers on the ISP’s IPv6
network are used for resolving internet addresses, and these are provided along with the static IP address and
preix length from the ISP.
When the ISP allows you to obtain the WAN IP settings via DHCP, you need to provide details for the DHCPv6
client coniguration. The DHCPv6 client on the gateway can be either stateless or stateful. If a stateful client is
selected the gateway will connect to the ISP’s DHCPv6 server for a leased address. For stateless DHCP there need
not be a DHCPv6 server available at the ISP, rather ICMPv6 discover messages will originate from this gateway
and will be used for auto coniguration.
A third option to specify the IP address and preix length of a preferred DHCPv6 server is available as well.
Dynamic IP
To conigure a dynamic (DHCP) IPv6 Internet connection:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > WAN1 Settings.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Connection Type
DHCPv6 Auto Coniguration
Preix Delegation
Save
Description
Select DHCPv6 from the drop-down menu.
Select either Stateless Address or Stateful Address.
Select this option to request router advertisement preix from any available
DHCPv6 servers available on the ISP, the obtained preix is updated to the advertised preixes on
the LAN side. This option can be selected only in Stateless Address Auto Coniguration mode of
DHCPv6 Client.
Click Save to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
64
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Static IP
To conigure a static IPv6 Internet connection:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > WAN1 Settings.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Connection Type
IPv6 Address
IPv6 Preix Length
Default IPv6 Gateway
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
Save
Description
Select Static.
Enter the IP address supplied by your ISP.
Enter the IPv6 preix length supplied by your ISP.
Enter the IPv6 gateway address supplied by your ISP.
Enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
65
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
PPPoE
To conigure a dynamic (DHCP) IPv6 Internet connection:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > WAN1 Settings.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Connection Type
User Name
Password
Authentication Type
DHCPv6 Options
Primary DNS Server
Secondary DNS Server
Save
Description
Select PPPoE.
Enter your PPPoE user name.
Enter your PPPoE password.
Select the authentication type from the drop-down menu (Auto-negotiate/PAP/CHAP/MS-CHAP/MSCHAPv2).
Select the mode of DHCPv6 client that will start in this mode (Disable dhcpv6/Stateless dhcpv6/Stateful
dhcpv6/Stateless dhcpv6 with preix delegation.
Enter the primary DNS server IP address.
Enter the secondary DNS server IP address.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
66
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Static Routing
Path: Network > IPv6 > Static Routing
Manually adding static routes to this device allows you to deine the path selection of traic from one interface
to another. There is no communication between this router and other devices to account for changes in the path;
once conigured the static route will be active and efective until the network changes.
The List of Static Routes displays all routes that have been added manually by an administrator and allows several
operations on the static routes.
To create a new static route:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > Static Routing.
2. Click Add New IPv6 Static Route.
3. Complete the ields in the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
67
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Field
Route Name
Active
IPv6 Destination
IPv6 Preix Length
Interface
IPv6 Gateway
Metric
Save
Description
Enter a name for your route.
Toggle to ON to activate this route or to OFF to deactivate.
Enter the IP address of the static route’s destination.
Enter the preix length of the static route.
The physical network interface (WAN1, WAN2, WAN3, DMZ or LAN), through which this route is
accessible.
IPv6 address of the gateway through which the destination host or network can be reached.
Determines the priority of the route. If multiple routes to the same destination exist, the route with
the lowest metric is chosen.
Click Save to save your route.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
68
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
OSPFv3
Path: Network > IPv6 > OSPFv3
OSPF is an interior gateway protocol that routes Internet Protocol (IP) packets solely within a single routing
domain. It gathers link state information from available routers and constructs a topology map of the network.
Open Shortest Path First version 3 (OSPFv3) supports IPv6. To enable an OSPFv3 process on a router, you need to
enable the OSPFv3 process globally, assign the OSPFv3 process a router ID, and enable the OSPFv3 process on
related interfaces.
Note: The DSR-150/150N/250/250N routers do not support OSPFv3.
To conigure OSPF:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > OSPFv3.
2. Right-click the port you want to edit (LAN/WAN1/WAN2) and select Edit.
3. Complete the ields in the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
69
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Field
OSPFv3 Enable
Interface
Priority
Hello Interval
Dead Interval
Cost
Save
Description
Toggle ON to enable OSPFv3.
Displays the physical network interface on which OSPFv3 is Enabled/Disabled.
Helps to determine the OSPFv3 designated router for a network. The router with the highest priority
will be more eligible to become Designated Router. Setting the value to 0 makes the router ineligible to
become Designated Router. The default value is 1. Lower the value means higher the priority.
The number of seconds for Hello Interval timer value. Enter the number in seconds that the Hello packet
will be sent. This value must be the same for all routers attached to a common network. The default
value is 10 seconds.
The number of seconds that a device’s hello packets must not have been seen before its neighbors
declare the OSPF router down. This value must be the same for all routers attached to a common
network. The default value is 40 seconds. OSPF requires these intervals to be exactly the same between
two neighbors. If any of these intervals are diferent, these routers will not become neighbors on a
particular segment.
Enter the cost of sending a packet on an OSPFv3 interface.
Click Save to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
70
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
6 to 4 Tunneling
Path: Network > IPv6 > 6 to 4 Tunneling
6to4 is an Internet transition mechanism for migrating from IPv4 to IPv6, a system that allows IPv6 packets to be
transmitted over an IPv4 network. Select the check box to Enable Automatic Tunneling and allow traic from an
IPv6 LAN to be sent over an IPv4 Option to reach a remote IPv6 network.
To enable 6 to 4 tunneling:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > 6 to 4 Tunneling.
2. Toggle Activate Auto Tunneling to ON.
3. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
71
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
ISATAP
Path: Network > IPv6 > 6 to 4 Tunneling
ISATAP (Intra-Site Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol) is an IPv6 transition mechanism meant to transmit
IPv6 packets between dual-stack nodes on top of an IPv4 network. ISATAP speciies an IPv6-IPv4 compatibility
address format as well as a means for site border router discovery. ISATAP also speciies the operation of IPv6 over
a speciic link layer - that being IPv4 used as a link layer for IPv6.
To add, edit, or delete a ISATAP entry:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > ISATAP.
2. Right-click a current entry and select Edit or Delete. To add a new entry, click Add New ISATAP Tunnel.
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
ISATAP Subnet Preix
End Point Address
IPv4 Address
Save
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Description
This is the 64-bit subnet preix that is assigned to the logical ISATAP subnet for this intranet. This can be
obtained from your ISP or internet registry, or derived from RFC 4193.
This is the endpoint address for the tunnel that starts with this router. The endpoint can be the LAN
interface (assuming the LAN is an IPv4 network), or a speciic LAN IPv4 address.
The end point address if not the entire LAN.
Click Save to save your settings.
72
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
LAN Settings
DHCPv6 Server
Path: Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > IPv6 LAN Settings
In IPv6 mode, the LAN DHCP server is disabled by default (similar to IPv4 mode). The DHCPv6 server will serve
IPv6 addresses from conigured address pools with the IPv6 Preix Length assigned to the LAN.
The default IPv6 LAN address for the router is fec0::1. You can change this 128-bit IPv6 address based on your
network requirements. The other ield that deines the LAN settings for the router is the preix length. The IPv6
network (subnet) is identiied by the initial bits of the address called the preix. By default this is 64 bits long. All
hosts in the network have common initial bits for their IPv6 address; the number of common initial bits in the
network’s addresses is set by the preix length ield.
To conigure IPv6 LAN settings on the router:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > IPv6 LAN Settings.
2. Complete the ields in the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
73
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Field
IPv6 Address
IPv6 Preix Length
Status
Mode
Domain Name
Server Preference
DNS Servers
Lease / Rebind Time
Preix Delegation
Save
Description
Enter the IPv6 LAN address for the router.
Enter the preix length.
Toggle to ON to enable DHCPv6.
The IPv6 DHCP server is either stateless or stateful. If stateless is selected an external IPv6 DHCP server is
not required as the IPv6 LAN hosts are auto-conigured by this router. In this case the router advertisement
daemon (RADVD) must be conigured on this device and ICMPv6 router discovery messages are used by the
host for auto-coniguration. There are no managed addresses to serve the LAN nodes. If stateful is selected
the IPv6 LAN host will rely on an external DHCPv6 server to provide required coniguration settings.
Enter a domain name (optional).
Server Preference is used to indicate the preference level of this DHCP server. DHCP advertise messages with
the highest server preference value to a LAN host are preferred over other DHCP server advertise messages.
The default is 255.
The DNS server details can be manually entered here (primary/secondary options. An alternative is to
allow the LAN DHCP client to receive the DNS server details from the ISP directly. By selecting Use DNS
proxy, this router acts as a proxy for all DNS requests and communicates with the ISP’s DNS servers (a WAN
coniguration parameter).
Enter the duration of the DHCPv6 lease from this router to the LAN client.
Toggle to ON to enable preix delegation in DHCPv6 server. This option can be selected only in Stateless
Address Auto Coniguration mode of DHCPv6 server.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
74
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
IPv6 Address Pools
Path: Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > IPv6 Address Pools
This feature allows you to deine the IPv6 delegation preix for a range of IP addresses to be served by the
router’s DHCPv6 server. Using a delegation preix you can automate the process of informing other networking
equipment on the LAN of DHCP information speciic for the assigned preix.
To add, edit, or delete a IPv6 address pool entry:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > IPv6 Address Pools tab.
2. Right-click a current entry and select Edit or Delete. To add a new entry, click Add New Address Pool.
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Start IPv6 Address
End IPv6 Address
Preix Length
Save
Description
Enter the starting IPv6 LAN address.
Enter the ending IPv6 LAN address.
Enter the preix length.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
75
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
IPv6 Preix Length
Path: Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > IPv6 Preix Length
To add, edit, or delete a IPv6 preix length entry:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > IPv6 Preix Length tab.
2. Right-click a current entry and select Edit or Delete. To add a new entry, click Add New Preix Length.
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Proile
Preix Length
Save
Description
Enter a name for this proile.
Enter the preix length.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
76
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Router Advertisement
Path: Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > Router Advertisement
Router Advertisements are analogous to IPv4 DHCP assignments for LAN clients, in that the router will assign
an IP address and supporting network information to devices that are conigured to accept such details. Router
Advertisement is required in an IPv6 network is required for stateless auto coniguration of the IPv6 LAN.
By coniguring the Router Advertisement Daemon on this router, the router will listen on the LAN for router
solicitations and respond to these LAN hosts with router advisements.
To conigure router advertisement settings:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > Router Advertisement tab.
2. Complete the ields in the table on the next page and click Save.
Field
Status
Advertise Mode
Advertise Interval
Managed
Other
Router Preference
MTU
Router Lifetime
Save
Description
Toggle to ON to enable this feature.
Select Unsolicited Multicast to send router advertisements (RA’s) to all interfaces in the multicast group.
To restrict RA’s to well-known IPv6 addresses on the LAN, and thereby reduce overall network traic, select
Unicast only.
When advertisements are unsolicited multicast packets, this interval sets the maximum time between
advertisements from the interface. The actual duration between advertisements is a random value between
one third of this ield and this ield. The default is 30 seconds.
Toggle to ON to use the administered/stateful protocol for address auto-coniguration. If set to OFF, the
host uses administered/stateful protocol for non-address auto coniguration.
Toggle to ON to use administered/stateful protocol of other (i.e., non-address) information auto coniguration.
This parameter (low/medium/high) determines the preference associated with the RADVD process of the
router. This is useful if there are other RADVD-enabled devices on the LAN as it helps avoid conlicts for IPv6
clients.
The router advertisement will set this maximum transmission unit (MTU) value for all nodes in the LAN that
are auto-conigured by the router. The default is 1500.
This value is present in RAs and indicates the usefulness of this router as a default router for the interface.
The default is 3600 seconds. Upon expiration of this value, a new RADVD exchange must take place between
the host and this router.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
77
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
Advertisement Preixes
Path: Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > Advertisement Preixes
Router advertisements conigured with advertisement preixes allow this router to inform hosts how to perform
stateless address auto coniguration. Router advertisements contain a list of subnet preixes that allow the router
to determine neighbors and whether the host is on the same link as the router.
To add, edit, or delete an advertisement preix entry:
1. Click Network > IPv6 > LAN Settings > Advertisement Preixes tab.
2. Right-click a current entry and select Edit or Delete. To add a new entry, click Add New Advertisement
Length.
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
IPv6 Preix Type
SLA ID
IPv6 Preix
IPv6 Preix Length
Preix Lifetime
Save
Description
To ensure hosts support IPv6 to IPv4 tunnel select the 6to4 preix type. Selecting Global/Local/ISATAP will
allow the nodes to support all other IPv6 routing options.
The SLA ID (Site-Level Aggregation Identiier) is available when 6to4 Preixes are selected. This should be
the interface ID of the router’s LAN interface used for router advertisements.
When using Global/Local/ISATAP preixes, this ield is used to deine the IPv6 network advertised by this
router.
This value indicates the number contiguous, higher order bits of the IPv6 address that deine up the
network portion of the address. Typically this is 64.
This deines the duration (in seconds) that the requesting node is allowed to use the advertised preix. It
is analogous to DHCP lease time in an IPv4 network.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
78
Section 5 - Connect to the Internet
IPv6 Tunnels Status
Path: Network > IPv6 > IPv6 Tunnels Status
This page displays the current status of IPv6 Tunnels.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
79
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
Wireless Settings
The Wireless Network Setup Wizard is available for users new to wireless networking. By going through a few
coniguration pages you can enable a Wi-Fi™ network on your LAN and allow supported 802.11 clients to connect
to the conigured Access Point. To run the wizard, refer to “#6 Wireless Network Setup” on page 12.
Access Points
Path: Wireless > General > Access Points
This router has an integrated 802.11n/ac radio that allows you to create an access point for wireless LAN clients.
The security/encryption/authentication options are grouped in a wireless Proile, and each conigured proile
will be available for selection in the AP coniguration menu. The proile deines various parameters for the AP,
including the security between the wireless client and the AP, and can be shared between multiple APs instances
on the same device when needed.
Up to four unique wireless networks can be created by coniguring multiple “virtual” APs . Each such virtual AP
appears as an independent AP (unique SSID) to supported clients in the environment, but is actually running on
the same physical radio integrated with this router.
Note: Proiles may be thought of as a grouping of AP parameters that can then be applied to not just one but multiple
AP instances (SSIDs), thus avoiding duplication if the same parameters are to be used on multiple AP instances or SSIDs.
To add, edit, or delete an access point entry:
1. Click Wireless > General > Access Points.
2. Right-click a current entry and select Edit or Delete. To add a new entry, click Add New Access Point.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
80
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
AP Name
Proile Name
Active Time
Schedule Control
Start/Stop Time
WLAN Partition
Save
Description
Enter a name for your virtual access point.
Select a proile from the drop-down menu to associate this access point with. If you do not want to use the
default proile, create a proile (refer to the next page) and then create an access point.
Toggle to ON to “turn on” this access point.
Toggle to ON if you want to specify a time to have this access point turned on.
Enter a start and stop time.
Toggle to ON to prevent associated wireless clients from communicating with each other.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
81
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
Proiles
Path: Wireless > General > Proiles
Creating a proile allows you to assign the security type, encryption and authentication to use when connecting
the AP to a wireless client. The default mode is “open”, i.e., no security. This mode is insecure as it allows any
compatible wireless clients to connect to an AP conigured with this security proile.
To create a new proile, use a unique proile name to identify the combination of settings. Conigure a unique
SSID that will be the identiier used by the clients to communicate to the AP using this proile. By choosing to
broadcast the SSID, compatible wireless clients within range of the AP can detect this proile’s availability. The AP
ofers all advanced 802.11 security modes, including WEP, WPA, and WPA2.
To add, edit, or delete a proile:
1. Click Wireless > General > Proiles.
2. Right-click a current entry and select Edit or Delete. To add a new entry, click Add New Access Point.
3. Complete the ields in the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
82
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
Field
Proile Name
SSID
Description
Enter a name for your proile.
Enter a name for your wireless network (SSID).
Toggle to ON if you want your SSID broadcast openly or toggle to OFF to hide it. Clients will have to know
Broadcast SSID
the SSID to connect.
Select what kind of wireless security you want to use:
• Open: Select this option to create a public “open” network to allow unauthenticated devices to access
this wireless gateway.
• WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy): This option requires a static (pre -shared) key to be shared between
the AP and wireless client . Note that WEP does not support 802.11n data rates; is it appropriate for
legacy 802.11 connections.
• WPA (Wi-Fi Protected Access): For stronger wireless security than WEP, choose this option. The
Security
encryption for WPA will use TKIP and also CCMP if required. The authentication can be a preshared
key (PSK), Enterprise mode with RADIUS server, or both. Note that WPA does not support 802.11n data
rates; is it appropriate for legacy 802.11 connections.
• WPA2: This security type uses CCMP encryption (and the option to add TKIP encryption) on either PSK
(pre-shared key) or Enterprise (RADIUS Server) authentication.
• WPA + WPA2: This uses both encryption algorithms, TKIP and CCMP. WPA clients will use TKIP and
WPA2 clients will use CCMP encryption algorithms.
Select the encryption type:
• WEP - Select Open or Shared.
• WPA - Select TKIP or TKIP+CCMP.
Encryption
• WPA2 - Select CCMP or TKIP+CCMP.
• WPA+WPA2 - TKIP+CCMP will be the only option.
Select the authentication type:
• WEP - Select 64-bit or 128-bit.
Authentication
• WPA/WPA2/WPA+WPA2 - Select PSK (passphrase), RADIUS (RADIUS server), or PSK+RADIUS (both).
WEP Passphrase/Key (1-4) If you selected WEP, enter a passphrase or up to four hexadecimal keys (a-f, 0-9, A-F).
WPA Password
If you selected WPA, WPA2, or WPA+WPA2, enter a WPA password.
Save
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
The AP coniguration page allows you to create a new AP and link to it one of the available proiles. This router
supports multiple AP’s referred to as virtual access points (VAPs). Each virtual AP that has a unique SSIDs appears
as an independent access point to clients. This valuable feature allows the router’s radio to be conigured in a way
to optimize security and throughput for a group of clients as required by the user. To create a VAP, refer to “Access
Points” on page 80. After setting the AP name, the proile drop-down menu is used to select one of the conigured
proiles.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
83
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
Radio Settings
Path: Wireless > General > Radio Settings
You may conigure the channels and power levels available for the AP’s enabled on the router. The router has a dual
band 802.11n radio, meaning either 2.4 GHz or 5 GHz frequency of operation can be selected (not concurrently
though). Based on the selected operating frequency, the mode selection will let you deine whether legacy
connections or only 802.11n connections (or both) are accepted on conigured APs.
The ratiied 802.11n support on this radio requires selecting the appropriate broadcast mode, and then deining
the channel spacing and control side band for 802.11n traic. The default settings are appropriate for most
networks. For example, changing the channel spacing to 40MHz can improve bandwidth at the expense of
supporting earlier 802.11n clients. The available transmission channels are governed by regulatory constraints
based on the region setting of the router.
To conigure the radio settings:
1. Click Wireless > General > Radio Settings.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Operating Frequency
Mode
Channel Spacing
Control Side Band
Current Channel
Channel
Default Transmit Power
Transmit Power
Transmission Rate
Save
Description
Select 2.4GHz or 5GHz.
Select the 802.11 mode:
• 2.4GHz - g and b, g only, n and g, or n only.
• 5GHz - a only, n and a, or n only.
Select the Channel Width:
Auto 20/40 - This is the default setting. Select if you are using both 802.11n and non-802.11n wireless devices.
20MHz - Select if you are not using any 802.11n wireless clients.
Select Upper or Lower. Available for 802.11n only.
Displays the current channel.
Select the channel you want to use.
Enter the default transmit power (0-31).
Displays the current transmit power.
Select a transmission rate from the drop-down menu. This will lock the transmission rate of your wireless
connection. It is strongly recommended to use Best (Automatic).
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
84
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
802.11AC Coniguration
Path: Wireless > General >Radio Settings > 5 Ghz
This section provides coniguration options to use the DSR-500AC or DSR-1000AC advanced wireless capabilities
in the 5 GHz band.
With 802.11AC, data throughput can be signiicantly increased as compared to 802.11n rates as the channel
bandwidth can be as high as 80 MHz. The available channels and spacing bandwidth are regulated by the
regulatory setting of the speciic country the DSR-500AC or DSR-1000AC is deployed in. By selecting 802.11AC
rates, the 5 GHz radio will use the enhance capability of the new design and will send more data in a single
packet (via wireless frame aggragation).
Field
Mode
Channel Spacing
Current Channel
Channel
Default Transmit Power
Transmit Power
Transmission Rate
Save
Description
This is the 802.11 modulaition technique being used
Distance in MHz between the successive channels
Channel being used in the available spectrum.
Channel number selected by user, this is deined by the country code for the device.
Output transmit power set by user
Transmit power currently in use by the radio.
Select a transmission rate from the drop-down menu. This will lock the transmission rate of your wireless
connection. It is strongly recommended to use Best (Automatic).
Rates used by device to download the data to client.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
85
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
WMM Settings
Path: Wireless > Advanced > WMM
Wi-Fi Multimedia (WMM) provides basic Quality of Service (QoS) features to IEEE 802.11 networks. WMM prioritizes
traic according to four Access Categories (AC) - voice, video, best efort, and background.
To conigure the radio settings:
1. Click Wireless > Advanced > WMM.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Proile Name
Enable WMM
Default Class of Service
IP DSCP / TOS
Save
Description
Select the proile to associate this coniguration to from the drop-down menu.
Toggle to ON to enable WMM.
Select an available access category (voice, video, best efort, or background) to assign as “default”.
Under Class of Service, select a service and map it to the IP DSCP / TOS value.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
86
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
WDS
Path: Wireless > Advanced > WDS
Wireless Distribution System (WDS) is a system enabling the wireless interconnection of access points in a
network. This feature is only guaranteed to work between devices of the same type (i.e., using the same chipset/
driver).
When you enable WDS, use the same security coniguration as the default access point. The WDS links do not
have true WPA/WPA2 support, as in there is no WPA key handshake performed. Instead the Session Key to be
used with a WDS Peer is computed using a hashing function (similar to the one used for computing a WPA PMK).
The inputs to this function are a PSK (conigurable by an administrator from the WDS page) and an internal
“magic” string (non-conigurable).
In efect the WDS links use TKIP/AES encryption, depending on the encryption conigured for the default AP. In
case the default AP uses mixed encryption (TKIP + AES). The WDS link will use the AES encryption scheme.
Note: For a WDS link to function properly the Radio settings on the WDS peers have to be the same.
To conigure the radio settings:
1. Click Wireless > Advanced > WDS.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
WDS Enable
WDS Encryption
WDS Security
WDS Authentication
WDS Passphrase
System MAC Address
Add New WDS
Save
Description
Toggle to ON to enable WDS and click Save.
Displays the current wireless encryption used.
Displays the current security type.
Displays the current authentication type.
Enter the WDS passphrase (if WEP, WPA, WPA2, or WPA+WPA2 is enabled).
Displays the system MAC address.
Once you enabled WDS (and clicked Save), click Add New WDS and enter the MAC address of a WDS peer.
You can add up to four WDS peers.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
87
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
Advanced Settings
Path: Wireless > Advanced > Advanced Settings
You can modify the 802.11 communication parameters in this page. Generally, the default settings are appropriate
for most networks.
1. Click Wireless > Advanced > Advanced Settings.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Beacon Interval
Description
Beacons are packets sent by an Access Point to synchronize a wireless network. The default value is 100.
(Delivery Traic Indication Message) 3 is the default setting. A DTIM is a countdown informing clients of the
DTIM Interval
next window for listening to broadcast and multicast messages.
This value should remain at its default setting of 2432. If inconsistent data low is a problem, only a minor
RTS Threshold
modiication should be made.
The fragmentation threshold, which is speciied in bytes, determines whether packets will be fragmented.
Fragmentation Threshold
Packets exceeding the 2346 byte setting will be fragmented before transmission. 2346 is the default setting.
Select either Long or Short. The Preamble Type deines the length of the CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check)
Preamble Mode
block for communication between the Access Point and roaming wireless adapters. High network traic
areas should use Short preamble type.
Select either None or CTS-to-Self Protection. Select the CTS-to-Self Protection to enable CTS-to-Self
Protection Mode
protection mechanism, which is used to minimize collisions among stations in a mixed 802.11b & g
environment. The default selection is None.
Toggle to ON to enable the Unscheduled Automatic Power Save Delivery (also referred to as WMM Power
Power Save Enable
Save) feature that allows the radio to conserve power.
Save
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
88
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
WPS
Path: Wireless > Advanced > WPS
WPS is a simpliied method to add supporting wireless clients to the network. WPS is only applicable for APs that
employ WPA or WPA2 security. To use WPS, select the eligible VAPs from the drop-down menu of APs that have
been conigured with this security and enable WPS status for this AP.
The WPS Current Status section outlines the security, authentication, and encryption settings of the selected AP.
These are consistent with the AP’s proile. There are two setup options:
• Personal Identiication Number (PIN): The wireless device that supports WPS may have an
alphanumeric PIN, if it does add the PIN in this ield. The router will connect within 60 seconds
of clicking the “Conigure via PIN” button immediately below the PIN ield. There is no LED
indication that a client has connected.
• Push Button Coniguration (PBC): For wireless devices that support PBC, press and hold the
WPS button for two seconds, and then press the WPS button (or initiate WPS via GUI) on your
wireless client within two minutes. The AP will detect the wireless device and establish a secure
link to the client.
To enable and connect clients using WPS:
1. Click Wireless > Advanced > WPS.
2. Select which VAP you want to perform the WPS process from the drop-down menu.
3. Toggle WPS Status to ON and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
89
Section 6 - Wireless Settings
4. Once enabled the following screen will appear.
5. Under WPS Setup Method, decide to either use PIN or PBC (Push Button).
6. If you want to use PIN method, enter the PIN next to Station PIN and click Conigure Via PIN. You will
need to enter the PIN on your wireless client and start the WPS process within one minute.
7. If you want to use push button method, click Conigure Via PBC. This will initiate the WPS session. You
will need to press the WPS button (or initiate through an interface) on your client within one minute.
8. Allow up to two minutes to connect. Check the Session Status to see if it successfully connected.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
90
Section 7 - VPN
VPN
A VPN provides a secure communication channel (“tunnel”) between two gateway routers or a remote PC client.
The following types of tunnels can be created:
• Gateway-to-gateway VPN: To connect two or more routers to secure traic between remote
sites.
• Remote Client (client-to-gateway VPN tunnel): A remote client initiates a VPN tunnel as the
IP address of the remote PC client is not known in advance. The gateway in this case acts as a
responder.
• Remote client behind a NAT router: The client has a dynamic IP address and is behind a NAT
Router. The remote PC client at the NAT router initiates a VPN tunnel as the IP address of the
remote NAT router is not known in advance. The gateway WAN port acts as responder.
• PPTP server for LAN / WAN PPTP client connections.
• L2TP server for LAN / WAN L2TP client connections.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
91
Section 7 - VPN
IPSec VPN
Policies
Path: VPN > IPSec VPN > Policies
An IPsec policy is between this router and another gateway or this router and an IPsec client on a remote host.
The IPsec mode can be either tunnel or transport depending on the network being traversed between the two
policy endpoints.
• Transport: This is used for end-to-end communication between this router and the tunnel
endpoint, either another IPsec gateway or an IPsec VPN client on a host. Only the data payload
is encrypted and the IP header is not modiied or encrypted.
• Tunnel: This mode is used for network-to-network IPsec tunnels where this gateway is one
endpoint of the tunnel. In this mode the entire IP packet including the header is encrypted
and/or authenticated.
When tunnel mode is selected, you can enable NetBIOS and DHCP over IPsec. DHCP over IPsec allows this router
to serve IP leases to hosts on the remote LAN. As well in this mode you can deine the single IP address, range of
IPs, or subnet on both the local and remote private networks that can communicate over the tunnel.
To conigure the radio settings:
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > Policies.
2. Click Add new IPSec Policy. Fill out the General section which you will name the VPN, select policy
type, deine the tunnel type, and deine endpoints.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
92
Section 7 - VPN
Field
Policy Name
Policy Type
IP Protocol Version
IKE Version
IPSec Mode
Select Local Gateway
Remote Endpoint
IP Address/FQDN
Enable Mode Conig
Enable NetBIOS
Enable RollOver
Protocol
Enable DHCP
Local IP/Remote IP
Enable Keepalive
Description
Enter a unique name for the VPN Policy. This name is not an identiier for the remote WAN/client.
Select either Manual or Auto.
• Manual: All settings (including the keys) for the VPN tunnel are manually input for each end point. No
third-party server or organization is involved.
• Auto: Some parameters for the VPN tunnel are generated automatically. This requires using the IKE
(Internet Key Exchange) protocol to perform negotiations between the two VPN Endpoints.
Select either IPv4 or IPv6.
Select the version of IKE.
Select either Tunnel or Transport. IPsec tunnel mode is useful for protecting traic between diferent
networks, when traic must pass through an intermediate, untrusted network. Tunnel mode is primarily
used for interoperability with gateways, or end-systems that do not support L2TP/IPsec or PPTP connections.
Transport mode is the default mode for IPsec, and it is used for end-to-end communications (for example, for
communications between a client and a server).
In the event that two WAN ports are conigured to connect to your ISP, select the gateway that will be used
as the local endpoint for this IPsec tunnel.
Select the type of identiier that you want to provide for the router at the remote endpoint (either IP Address
or FQDN [Fully Qualiied Domain Name])
Enter the identiier for the router.
Toggle to ON to enable. Mode Conig is similar to DHCP and is used to assign IP addresses to the remote
VPN clients.
Toggle to ON to allow NetBIOS broadcasts to travel over the VPN tunnel
Toggle to ON to enable VPN rollover. You must have the WAN Mode set to Rollover.
Select a protocol from the drop-down menu.
Toggle to ON to allow VPN clients that are connected to your router over IPsec to receive an assigned IP
using DHCP.
Select the type of identiier that you want to provide for the endpoint:
• Any: Speciies that the policy is for traic from the given end point (local or remote). Note that selecting
Any for both local and remote end points is not valid.
• Single: Limits the policy to one host. Enter the IP address of the host that will be part of the VPN.
• Range: Allows computers within an IP address range to connect to the VPN. Enter the Start IP Address
and End IP Address in the provided ields.
• Subnet: Allows an entire subnet to connect to the VPN. Enter the network address and subnet mask in
the provided ields.
Toggle to ON to periodically send ping packets to the host on the peer side of the network to keep the
tunnel alive.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
93
Section 7 - VPN
3. Once the tunnel type and endpoints of the tunnel are deined you can determine the Phase 1/ Phase
2 negotiation to use for the tunnel. This is covered in the IPsec mode setting, as the policy can be
Manual or Auto. For Auto policies, the Internet Key Exchange (IKE) protocol dynamically exchanges
keys between two IPsec hosts. The Phase 1 IKE parameters are used to deine the tunnel’s security
association details.
The Phase 2 Auto policy parameters cover the security association lifetime and encryption/authentication
details of the phase 2 key negotiation.
The VPN policy is one half of the IKE/VPN policy pair required to establish an Auto IPsec VPN tunnel. The
IP addresses of the machine or machines on the two VPN endpoints are conigured here, along with
the policy parameters required to secure the tunnel.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
94
Section 7 - VPN
A Manual policy does not use IKE and instead relies on manual keying to exchange authentication
parameters between the two IPsec hosts. The incoming and outgoing security parameter index
(SPI) values must be mirrored on the remote tunnel endpoint. As well the encryption and integrity
algorithms and keys must match on the remote IPsec host exactly in order for the tunnel to establish
successfully. Note that using Auto policies with IKE are preferred as in some IPsec implementations the
SPI (security parameter index) values require conversion at each endpoint.
DSR routers supports VPN roll-over feature. This means that policies conigured on the primary WAN
will rollover to the secondary WAN in case of a link failure. This feature can be used only if your WAN is
conigured in Auto-Rollover mode.
Note: Once you have created an IPSec policy, you may right-click the policy and select Export to save
as a ile. You can then upload this to another DSR router or keep as a backup. To upload a saved policy,
refer to “Easy VPN Setup” on page 102.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
95
Section 7 - VPN
Tunnel Mode
Path: VPN > IPSec VPN > Tunnel Mode
When tunnel mode is selected, you can enable NetBIOS and DHCP over IPSec. DHCP over IPSec allows this router
to serve IP leases to hosts on the remote LAN. You can also deine a single IP address, a range of IPs, or a subnet
on both the local and remote private networks that can communicate over the tunnel.
The router allows full tunnel and split tunnel support. Full tunnel mode just sends all traic from the client across
the VPN tunnel to the router. Split tunnel mode only sends traic to the private LAN based on pre-speciied client
routes. These client routes give the client access to speciic private networks, thereby allowing access control
over speciic LAN services.
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > Tunnel Mode.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Tunnel Mode
Start/End IP Address
Primary/Secondary DNS
Primary/Secondary WINS
Save
Description
Select either Full Tunnel or Split Tunnel.
Enter the starting and ending IP addresses.
Enter the primary and secondary DNS server addresses.
Enter the primary and secondary WINS server addresses.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
96
Section 7 - VPN
Split DNS Names
In a split DNS infrastructure, you create two zones for the same domain, one to be used by the internal network,
the other used by the external network. Split DNS directs internal hosts to an internal domain name server for
name resolution and external hosts are directed to an external domain name server for name resolution.
To add a DNS name:
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > Tunnel Mode > Split DNS Names tab.
2. Click Add New Split DNS name. You can right-click any created entries to edit or delete.
3. Enter a domain name and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
97
Section 7 - VPN
DHCP Range
This page displays the IP range to be assigned to clients connecting using DHCP over IPsec. By default the range
is in 192.168.12.0 subnet.
To conigure the DHCP over IPSec DHCP server settings:
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > DHCP Range.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Starting IP Address
Ending IP Address
Subnet Mask
Save
Description
Enter the starting IP address to issue your clients connecting using DHCP over IPSec.
Enter the ending IP address.
Enter the subnet mask.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
98
Section 7 - VPN
Certiicates
This router uses digital certiicates for IPsec VPN authentication. You can obtain a digital certiicate from a wellknown Certiicate Authority (CA) such as VeriSign, or generate and sign your own certiicate using functionality
available on this gateway.
The router comes with a self-signed certiicate, and this can be replaced by one signed by a CA as per your
networking requirements. A CA certiicate provides strong assurance of the server’s identity and is a requirement
for most corporate network VPN solutions.
Trusted Certiicates
The certiicates menu allows you to view a list of certiicates (both from a CA and self-signed) currently loaded on
the router. The following certiicate data is displayed in the list of Trusted (CA) certiicates:
CA Identity (Subject Name): The certiicate is issued to this person or organization
Issuer Name: This is the CA name that issued this certiicate
Expiry Time: The date after which this Trusted certiicate becomes invalid
To upload a certiicate:
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > Certiicate > Trusted Certiicates tab.
2. Click the Browse button. Locate your certiicate and click Open.
3. Click Upload.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
99
Section 7 - VPN
Active Self Certiicates
A self certiicate is a certiicate issued by a CA identifying your device (or self-signed if you don’t want the identity
protection of a CA). The Active Self Certiicate table lists the self certiicates currently loaded on the router. The
following information is displayed for each uploaded self certiicate:
Name: The name you use to identify this certiicate, it is not displayed to IPsec VPN peers.
Subject Name: This is the name that will be displayed as the owner of this certiicate. This should be your
oicial registered or company name, as IPsec or SSL VPN peers are shown this ield.
Serial Number: The serial number is maintained by the CA and used to identify this signed certiicate.
Issuer Name: This is the CA name that issued (signed) this certiicate
Expiry Time: The date after which this signed certiicate becomes invalid. You should renew the certiicate
before it expires.
To upload a certiicate:
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > Certiicate > Active Self Certiicates tab.
2. Click the Browse button. Locate your certiicate and click Open.
3. Click Upload.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
100
Section 7 - VPN
Self Certiicate Requests
To request a self certiicate to be signed by a CA, you can generate a Certiicate Signing Request from the router
by entering identiication parameters and passing it along to the CA for signing. Once signed, the CA’s Trusted
Certiicate and signed certiicate from the CA are uploaded to activate the self -certiicate validating the identity
of this gateway. The self certiicate is then used in IPsec and SSL connections with peers to validate the gateway’s
authenticity.
To generate a certiicate signing request:
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > Certiicates > Self Certiicate Requests.
2. Click New Self Certiicate.
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Name
Subject
Hash Algorithm
Signature Key Length
Application Type
IP Address
Domain Name
Email Address
Save
Description
Enter a name (identiier) for the certiicate.
This ield will populate the CN (Common Name) entry of the generated certiicate. Subject names are usually
deined in the following format: CN=, OU=, O=, L=,
ST=, C=. For example: CN=router1, OU=my_company, O=mydept, L=SFO, C=US.
Select the algorithm from the drop-down menu. Select either MD5 or SHA-1.
Select the signature key length from the drop-down menu. Select either 512, 1024, or 2048
Select the application type from the drop-down menu. Select either HTTPS or IPSec.
Enter an IP address (optional).
Enter a domain name (optional).
Enter your email address.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
101
Section 7 - VPN
Easy VPN Setup
To upload an exported IPSec VPN policy:
1. Click VPN > IPSec VPN > Easy VPN Setup.
2. Click Browse and navigate to the policy ile you want to upload. Select it and click Open.
3. Click Upload.
4. Once uploaded, go to VPN > IPSec VPN > Policies and the loaded VPN will be listed. Right-click it to
edit or delete.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
102
Section 7 - VPN
PPTP VPN
Server
Path: VPN > PPTP VPN > Server
A PPTP VPN can be established through this router. Once enabled a PPTP server is available on the router for LAN
and WAN PPTP client users to access. Once the PPTP server is enabled, PPTP clients that are within the range of
conigured IP addresses of allowed clients can reach the router’s PPTP server. Once authenticated by the PPTP
server (the tunnel endpoint), PPTP clients have access to the network managed by the router.
The range of IP addresses allocated to PPTP clients can coincide with the LAN subnet. As well the PPTP server
will default to local PPTP user authentication, but can be conigured to employ an external authentication server
should one be conigured.
To create a PPTP VPN server:
1. Click VPN > PPTP VPN > Server.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Enable PPTP Server
PPTP Routing Mode
Starting/Ending IP Address
IPv6 Preix
IPv6 Preix Length
Authentication
Authentication Supported
Idle TimeOut
NetBIOS
Save
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Description
Select either IPv4 or IPv6.
Select either NAT or Classical.
Enter the IP address range to assign your PPTP clients.
If you selected IPv6, enter the IPv6 preix.
If you selected IPv6, enter the IPv6 preix length.
Select the authentication type from the drop-down menu.
Toggle which type of authentication you want to enable to ON.
Enter the amount of time in seconds that the connection will disconnect when idle.
Toggle to ON to allow NetBIOS broadcasts to travel over the VPN tunnel.
Click to save your settings.
103
Section 7 - VPN
Client
Path: VPN > PPTP VPN > Client
PPTP VPN Client can be conigured on this router. Using this client you can access remote network which is
local to PPTP server. Once client is enabled, the user can access Status > Active VPNs page and establish PPTP
VPN tunnel clicking Connect.
To conigure the router as a PPTP VPN client:
1. Click VPN > PPTP VPN > Client tab.
2. Toggle Client to ON and complete the ields in the table below.
Field
Client
Server IP
Description
Toggle to ON to enable PPTP client.
Enter the IP address of the PPTP server you want to connect to.
Remote Network
Enter the remote network address. This address is local for the PPTP Server.
Remote Netmask
Username
Password
MPPE Encryption
Idle Time Out
Save
Enter the remote network subnet mask.
Enter your PPTP user name.
Enter your PPTP password.
Toggle to ON to enable Microsoft Point-to-Point Encryption (MPPE).
Enter the amount of time (in seconds) that you will disconnect from the PPTP server when idle.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
104
Section 7 - VPN
PPTP Active Users List
A list of PPTP connections will be displayed on this page. Right-click the connection to connect and disconnect.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
105
Section 7 - VPN
L2TP VPN
Server
Path: VPN > L2TP VPN > Server
A L2TP VPN can be established through this router. Once enabled a L2TP server is available on the router for LAN
and WAN L2TP client users to access. Once the L2TP server is enabled, PPTP clients that are within the range of
conigured IP addresses of allowed clients can reach the router’s L2TP server. Once authenticated by the L2TP
server (the tunnel endpoint), L2TP clients have access to the network managed by the router.
The range of IP addresses allocated to L2TP clients can coincide with the LAN subnet. As well the L2TP server
will default to local L2TP user authentication, but can be conigured to employ an external authentication server
should one be conigured.
To create a L2TP VPN server:
1. Click VPN >L2TP VPN > Server.
2. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Field
Enable L2TP Server
L2TP Routing Mode
Starting/Ending IP Address
IPv6 Preix
IPv6 Preix Length
Authentication
Authentication Supported
Idle TimeOut
NetBIOS
Save
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Description
Select either IPv4 or IPv6.
Select either NAT or Classical.
Enter the IP address range to assign your L2TP clients.
If you selected IPv6, enter the IPv6 preix.
If you selected IPv6, enter the IPv6 preix length.
Select the authentication type from the drop-down menu.
Toggle which type of authentication you want to enable to ON.
Enter the amount of time in seconds that the connection will disconnect when idle.
Toggle to ON to allow NetBIOS broadcasts to travel over the VPN tunnel.
Click to save your settings.
106
Section 7 - VPN
Client
L2TP VPN Client can be conigured on this router. Using this client we can access remote network which is local to
L2TP server. Once client is enabled, the user can access Status > Active VPNs page and establish L2TP VPN tunnel
clicking Connect.
To conigure the router as a L2TP VPN client:
1. Click VPN > L2TP VPN > Client tab.
2. Toggle Client to ON and complete the ields in the table below.
Field
Client
Server IP
Description
Toggle to ON to enable L2TP client.
Enter the IP address of the L2TP server you want to connect to.
Remote Network
Enter the remote network address. This address is local for the L2TP Server.
Remote Netmask
Username
Password
Reconnect Mode
MPPE Encryption
Save
Enter the remote network subnet mask.
Enter your L2TP user name.
Enter your L2TP password.
Select Always On or On Demand.
Toggle to ON to enable Microsoft Point-to-Point Encryption (MPPE).
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
107
Section 7 - VPN
L2TP Active Users List
A list of L2TP connections will be displayed on this page. Right-click the connection to connect and disconnect.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
108
Section 7 - VPN
SSL VPN
Server Policies
SSL VPN Policies can be created on a Global, Group, or User level. User level policies take precedence over Group
level policies and Group level policies take precedence over Global policies. These policies can be applied to a
speciic network resource, IP address, or IP ranges on the LAN, or to diferent SSL VPN services supported by the
router. The List of Available Policies can be iltered based on whether it applies to a user, group, or all users (global).
To add a SSL VPN policy, you must irst assign it to a user, group, or make it global (i.e., applicable to all SSL VPN
users). If the policy is for a group, the available conigured groups are shown in a drop-down menu and one
must be selected. Similarly, for a user-deined policy, a SSL VPN user must be chosen from the available list of
conigured users.
The next step is to deine the policy details. The policy name is a unique identiier for this rule. The policy can
be assigned to a speciic Network Resource (details follow in the subsequent section), IP address, IP network,
or all devices on the LAN of the router. Based on the selection of one of these four options, the appropriate
coniguration ields are required (i.e., choosing the network resources from a list of deined resources, or deining
the IP addresses). For applying the policy to addresses the port range/port number can be deined.
The inal steps require the policy permission to be set to either permit or deny access to the selected addresses
or network resources. As well the policy can be speciied for one or all of the supported SSL VPN services (i.e. VPN
tunnel).
Once deined, the policy goes into efect immediately. The policy name, SSL service it applies to, destination
(network resource or IP addresses), and permission (deny/permit) is outlined in a list of conigured policies for
the router.
Note: You must enable Remote Management. Refer to “Remote Management” on page 173.
To create a new SSL VPN policy:
1. Make sure you have enabled remote management and have created user(s) and group(s) to assign to
this policy.
2. Click VPN > SSL VPN > SSL VPN Server Policy.
3. Click Add New SSL VPN Server Policy.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
109
Section 7 - VPN
4. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Network Resource
Field
Policy Type
Available Groups/Users
Apply Policy To
Policy Name
IP Address
Mask Length
ICMP
Begin/End
Deined Resources
Service
Permission
Save
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
IP Address
Description
Select Global, Group, or User.
If you selected Group, select a group from the drop-down menu. If you selected User,
select a user from the drop-down menu.
Select Network Resource, IP Address, IP Network, or All Addresses.
Enter a unique name for this policy.
If you selected IP Address or IP Network, enter the IP address.
If you selected IP Network, enter the mask length (0-32).
Toggle to ON to include ICMP traic.
Enter a port range or leave blank to include all TCP and UDP ports. These ields are not
available when selecting Network Resource.
If you selected Network Resource, select the resource for the Deined Resource dropdown menu. If you have not created a resource, refer to“Resources”on page 113 to create
a deined resource.
Select either VPN Tunnel, Port Forwarding, or All. This ield is not available when
selecting Network Resource.
Select either Permit or Deny.
Click to save your settings.
110
Section 7 - VPN
Portal Layouts
Path: VPN > SSL VPN > Portal Layouts
You may create a custom page for remote VPN users that is viewed during authentication. You may include
login instructions, services, and other details. Note that the default portal LAN IP address is https://192.168.10.1/
scgi-bin/userPortal/portal. This is the same page that opens when the “User Portal” link is clicked on the SSL VPN
menu of the router web UI.
To create a new portal layout:
1. Click VPN > SSL VPN > Portal Layouts.
2. Click Add New SSL VPN Portal Layout.
Note: You may right-click a layout from the list and edit or delete a layout.
3. Complete the ields from the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
111
Section 7 - VPN
Field
Description
Enter a name for this portal. This name will be used as part of the path for the SSL portal
Portal Layout Name
URL. Only alphanumeric characters are allowed for this ield.
Login Proile View
Select a login proile from the drop-down menu.
Enter the portal web browser window title that appears when the client accesses this
Portal Site Title
portal. This ield is optional.
Banner Title
The banner title that is displayed to SSL VPN clients prior to login. This ield is optional.
Banner Message
Enter a message you want to display.
Display Banner Message on Login Toggle to ON to display the banner title and message or OFF to hide the banner title
Page
and message.
Toggle to ON or OFF. This security feature prevents expired web pages and data from
HTTP Meta Tags for Cache Control
being stored in the client‘s web browser cache. It is recommended to toggle to ON.
Toggle to ON or Of. An ActiveX cache control web cleaner can be pushed from the
Active X Web Cache Cleaner
gateway to the client browser whenever users login to this SSL VPN portal.
Authentication Type
Select the type of authentication from the drop-down menu.
Group
Select what group to include from the drop-down menu.
VPN Tunnel Page
Toggle to ON to allow remote users to view this page.
Port Forwarding
Toggle to ON to allow remote users to view this page.
Save
Click to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
112
Section 7 - VPN
Resources
Path: VPN > SSL VPN > Resources
Network resources are services or groups of LAN IP addresses that are used to easily create and conigure SSL
VPN policies. This shortcut saves time when creating similar policies for multiple remote SSL VPN users.
Adding a Network Resource involves creating a unique name to identify the resource and assigning it to one or
all of the supported SSL services. Once this is done, editing one of the created network resources allows you to
conigure the object type (either IP address or IP range) associated with the service. The Network Address, Mask
Length, and Port Range/Port Number can all be deined for this resource as required.
Add New Resource
To add a new resource:
1. Click VPN > SSL VPN > Resources.
2. Click Add New Resource.
3. Complete the ields from the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
113
Section 7 - VPN
Field
Resource Name
Service
ICMP
Object Type
Object Address
Mask Length
Begin/End
Save
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Description
Enter a unique name for this resource.
Select VPN Tunnel, Port Forwarding, or All.
Toggle to ON to include ICMP traic.
Select Single IP Address or IP Network.
Enter the IP address.
If you selected IP Network, enter the mask length (0-32).
Enter a port range for the object.
Click to save your settings.
114
Section 7 - VPN
Port Forwarding
Port forwarding allows remote SSL users to access speciied network applications or services after they login to
the User Portal and launch the Port Forwarding service. Traic from the remote user to the router is detected and
re-routed based on conigured port forwarding rules.
Internal host servers or TCP applications must be speciied as being made accessible to remote users. Allowing
access to a LAN server requires entering the local server IP address and TCP port number of the application to be
tunnelled.
To add a port forwarding rule:
1. Click VPN > SSL VPN > Resources.
2. Click Add New Rule under either Port Forwarding List for Conigured Applications (TCP Port) or under
Port Forwarding List for Conigured Host Names (FQDN).
3. Enter the IP address of the local server.
4. Next enter either the TCP port number or the domain name (FQDN).
5. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
115
Section 7 - VPN
Client
Path: VPN > SSL VPN > SSL VPN Client
An SSL VPN tunnel client provides a point-to-point connection between the browser-side machine and this
router. When a SSL VPN client is launched from the user portal, a "network adapter" with an IP address from the
corporate subnet, DNS and WINS settings is automatically created. This allows local applications to access services
on the private network without any special network coniguration on the remote SSL VPN client machine.
It is important to ensure that the virtual (PPP) interface address of the VPN tunnel client does not conlict with
physical devices on the LAN. The IP address range for the SSL VPN virtual network adapter should be either in a
diferent subnet or non-overlapping range as the corporate LAN.
The router allows full tunnel and split tunnel support. Full tunnel mode just sends all traic from the client
across the VPN tunnel to the router. Split tunnel mode only sends traic to the private LAN based on prespeciied client routes. These client routes give the SSL client access to speciic private networks, thereby
allowing access control over speciic LAN services.
To conigure client mode:
1. Click VPN > SSL VPN > SSL VPN Client.
2.
3.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Toggle Full Tunnel Support to ON to support full tunnel or OFF to enable split tunnel.
Enter a DNS suix to assign to this client (optional).
Enter a primary and secondary DNS server addresses (optional).
Enter the range of IP addresses clients will be assigned (DHCP).
Next to LCP Timeout, set the value for LCP echo interval (in seconds).
Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
116
Section 7 - VPN
Client Routes
Path: VPN > SSL VPN > SSL VPN Client
If the SSL VPN client is assigned an IP address in a diferent subnet than the corporate network, a client route
must be added to allow access to the private LAN through the VPN tunnel. As well a static route on the private
LAN‘s irewall (typically this router) is needed to forward private traic through the VPN Firewall to the remote
SSL VPN client.
When split tunnel mode is enabled, the user is required to conigure routes for VPN tunnel clients:
• Destination network: The network address of the LAN or the subnet information of the
destination network from the VPN tunnel clients‘ perspective is set here.
• Subnet mask: The subnet information of the destination network is set here.
To conigure a client route:
1. Click VPN > SSL VPN > Client Routes.
2. Click Add New Client Route.
3. Enter the destination network and subnet mask.
4. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
117
Section 7 - VPN
Open VPN
Settings
VPN > OpenVPN > Settings
OpenVPN allows peers to authenticate each other using a pre-shared secret key, certiicates, or username/
password. When used in a multiclient-server coniguration, it allows the server to release an authentication
certiicate for every client, using signature and Certiicate authority. An OpenVPN can be established through
this router.
You can select server mode, client mode, or access server client mode. In access server client mode, the user has
to download the auto login proile from the OpenVPN Access Server and upload the same to connect.
Server
To conigure the router as an OpenVPN Server:
1. Click VPN > OpenVPN > Settings.
2. Toggle OpenVPN to ON and complete the ields in the table below.
Field
Mode
VPN Network
Select Server.
Enter the IP network for the VPN.
VPN Netmask
Enter the netmask.
Port
Tunnel Protocol
Encryption Algorithm
Hash Algorithm
Tunnel Type
Save
Description
Enter what port to use. The default port is 1194.
Select either TCP or UDP.
Select the encryption algorithm from the drop-down menu.
Select the hash algorithm from the drop-down menu.
Select either Full Tunnel or Split Tunnel. Full Tunnel mode just sends all traic from the client across the
VPN tunnel to the router. Split Tunnel mode only sends traic to the private LAN based on pre-speciied
client routes. If you select Split Tunnel, refer to “Local Networks” on page 121 to create local networks.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
118
Section 7 - VPN
Client
To conigure the router as an OpenVPN client:
1. Click VPN > OpenVPN > Settings.
2. Toggle OpenVPN to ON and complete the ields in the table below.
Field
Mode
Server IP
Port
Tunnel Protocol
Encryption Algorithm
Hash Algorithm
Save
Description
Select Client.
Enter the IP address of the OpenVPN server.
Enter what port to use. The default port is 1194.
Select either TCP or UDP.
Select the encryption algorithm from the drop-down menu.
Select the hash algorithm from the drop-down menu.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
119
Section 7 - VPN
Access Server Client
To conigure the router as an OpenVPN access server client:
1. Click VPN > OpenVPN > Settings.
2. Toggle OpenVPN to ON and complete the ields in the table below.
Field
Mode
Port
Upload Status
File
Save
Description
Select Access Server Client.
Enter what port to use. The default port is 1194.
Displays if a coniguration ile has been uploaded.
Click Browse and locate the coniguration ile. Click Open and then click Upload.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
120
Section 7 - VPN
Local Networks
If you selected Split Tunnel (from OpenVPN Server), you can create a local network by following the steps below:
1. Click VPN > OpenVPN > Local Networks.
2. Click Add New OpenVPN Local Network.
3. Enter a local IP network.
4. Enter the subnet mask.
5. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
121
Section 7 - VPN
Remote Networks
To create remote networks:
1. Click VPN > OpenVPN > Remote Networks.
2. Click Add New OpenVPN Remote Network.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Enter a name of the remote network.
Enter a local IP network.
Enter the subnet mask.
Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
122
Section 7 - VPN
Authentication
This page will allow you to upload certiicates and keys. Click Browse and select the ile you want to upload. Click
Open and then click Upload.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
123
Section 7 - VPN
GRE
VPN > VPN Settings > GRE
GRE tunnels allow for broadcast traic on the LAN of the router to be passed over the internet and received by
remote LAN hosts. This is primarily useful in the D-Link Discovery Protocol (DDP) application where broadcast
traic from one LAN host is to be received by all LAN hosts in the local subnets of the GRE endpoints.
Note the following limits for the number of supported GRE tunnels per product:
• DSR-150/150N: 5
• DSR-250/250N: 10
• DSR-500/500N/500AC: 15
• DSR-1000/1000N/1000AC: 20
There are two simple steps involved in establishing a GRE tunnel on the router:
1. Create a GRE tunnel from the GUI
2. Setup a static route for the remote local networks using the GRE tunnel
When creating the GRE tunnel, the IP Address should be a unique address that identiies that GRE tunnel endpoint.
It will be referenced in the other router’s static route as the Gateway IP address. The Remote End Address in the
GRE tunnel coniguration page is the WAN IP address of the other endpoint router.
Once the tunnel is established, a static route on the router can be made using the interface set to the conigured
GRE tunnel name. The destination IP address of the static route is the remote LAN subnet, and the route’s gateway
IP address will be the GRE tunnel IP of the terminating router (the same router that manages the remote LAN
subnet). Once these two steps are completed, all DDP broadcast traic can low between remote LAN subnets
via the GRE Tunnel.
To create a GRE tunnel:
1. Click VPN > GRE > GRE Tunnels.
2. Click Add New GRE Tunnel.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
124
Section 7 - VPN
3. Complete the ields in the table below and then click Save.
Field
GRE Tunnel Name
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Interface
Remote End Address
Enable DDP Broadcast
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Gateway IP Address
Save
Description
Enter a name for the tunnel.
Enter the IP address of this endpoint. It will be referenced in the other router’s static route as the Gateway
IP address.
Enter the subnet mask.
Select the interface to create this tunnel with from the drop-down menu.
Enter the WAN IP address of the endpoint router.
Toggle to ON to enable DDP broadcasting.
Enter the destination IP address of the static route from the remote LAN subnet.
Enter the subnet mask.
Enter the IP address of the termination router.
Click Save to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
125
Section 8 - Security
Security
Groups
Path: Security > Authentication > User Database > Groups
The group page allows creating, editing, and deleting groups. The groups are associated to set of user types.
To edit/delete an existing group, or add a new group:
1. Click Security > Authentication > User Database > Groups tab.
2. Right-click a group entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new group, click Add New Group.
3. Complete the ields in the table below and click Save.
Admin User Type
Field
Group Name
Description
User Type
Idle Timeout
Save
Network User Type
Description
Enter a name for the group.
Enter a description for the group.
Select the user type:
• Admin - Grants all users in this group super-user privileges. By default, there is one admin user.
• Network - Grants the next level of privileges.
• Front Desk - Grants permissions to create temporary users who can Internet/network access (Hotspot).
• Guest - Guest users will only have read access.
Network and Admin users can toggle ON PPTP, L2TP, Xauth (Network only), SSLVPN, and Captive Portal.
Enter the number of minutes of inactivity that must occur before the users in this user group are logged out
of their web management session automatically. Entering an Idle Timeout value of 0 (zero) means never log
out.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
126
Section 8 - Security
Login Policies
Path: Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Groups
Using the following procedure, you can grant or deny a user group login access to the web management interface.
1. Click Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Groups tab.
2. Click Add Login Policies.
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Group Name
Description
Select the group you want to conigure.
Toggle ON to deny login access to the web management interface for all users in this user group. Toggle OFF
Disable Login
will allow users to log in.
Deny Login from Option Toggle ON to deny login access to the web management interface from the WAN2/DMZ Port for all users in
Interface
this user group. Toggle OFF will allow users.
Save
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
127
Section 8 - Security
Browser Policies
Path: Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Groups
Use this feature to allow or deny users in a selected group from using a particular web browser to log in to the
router’s web management interface.
1. Click Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Groups tab.
2. Click Add Browser Policies.
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Group Name
Client Browser
Save
Description
Select the group you want to conigure from the drop-down menu.
Select a web browser from the drop-down menu.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
4. Your policy will now be in the browser policies list. By default the status will be set to deny. If you
want to set the status to allow, right-click the policy and select Allow.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
128
Section 8 - Security
IP Policies
Path: Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Groups
Use this feature to allow or deny users in a user group to log in to the router’s web management interface from
a particular network or IP address.
1. Click Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Groups tab.
2. Click Add IP Policies.
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Group Name
Source Address Type
Network Address/IP
Address
Mask Length
Save
Description
Select the group you want to conigure from the drop-down menu.
Select either Network to specify a IP network or IP Address to specify a speciic IP address.
Enter the network address or IP address.
If you selected Network, enter the mask length.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
129
Section 8 - Security
Users
User Management
Path: Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Users
After you add user groups, you can add users to the user groups. Users can be added individually, or they can
be imported from a comma-separated-value (CSV) formatted ile. After you add users, you can edit them when
changes are required or delete users when you no longer need them.
To edit/delete existing users, or add a new user:
1. Click Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Users tab.
2. Right-click a group entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new group, click Add New User.
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
User Name
First Name
Last Name
Select Group
Password
Conirm Password
Save
Description
Enter the user name for this user. This name is a unique identiier
Enter the user’s irst name.
Enter the user’s last name.
Select the group you want to assign this user to from the drop-down menu.
Enter a case-sensitive login password that the user must specify at the login prompt to access the web
management interface. For security, each typed password character is masked with a dot (•).
Enter the password to conirm.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
130
Section 8 - Security
Import User Database
Path: Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Get User DB
The DSR administrator can add users to the local built-in database directly via an appropriately-formatted comma
separated value (CSV) ile. The advantage of this feature is to allow for a large number of users to be added to
the system with one operation, and the same ile can be uploaded to multiple DSR devices as needed. Once
uploaded the speciic users in the local user database can be modiied via the GUI as needed.
To import a user database:
1. Click Security > Authentication > Internal User Database > Get User DB tab.
2. Click Browse and locate the ile you want to upload. Select it and click Open.
3. Click Upload.
4. Once completed, go to Security > Authentication > User Database > Users and your imported users
will be displayed in the Users List.
5. From the list you can right-click the user to edit or delete.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
131
Section 8 - Security
Create a User Database (CSV File)
The following parameters must be used to deine the User database CSV ile.
1. Create an empty text ile with a .csv extension.
2. Each line in the ile corresponds to a single user entry. Every line should end with carriage return
equivalent of CRLF. Do not add comments or other text in this ile.
3. Formatting rules:
a) All the ields must be enclosed within double quotes.
b) Consecutive ields are separated by commas.
c) There should be no leading or trailing spaces in a line.
d) There should be no spaces between ields.
Each line in the CSV user database ile should follow the following format:
"UserName","FirstName","LastName","GroupName","MultiLogin","Password"
The above sample has ields that can assume the following values:
• Username (text ield): Name of the user and identiier in the DSR’s database, and so it must
be unique in the local user database.
• FirstName (text ield): This is a user detail and need not be unique.
• LastName (text ield): This is a user detail and need not be unique.
• GroupName (text ield): The group that is associated with this user.
• MultiLogSup (Boolean value): With this enabled (“1”), then multiple users can share a single
username and password.
• Password (text ield): password to assign for this username
• The Group for a corresponding user (“GroupName” in the CSV) must be created via the GUI
in advance of the User Database CSV upload action.
• None of the above ields can be left empty or NULL in the User Database CSV.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
132
Section 8 - Security
External Authentication Servers
RADIUS Server
Path: Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > RADIUS Server
A RADIUS server can be conigured and accessible by the router to authenticate client connections.
To conigure the router to connect to your RADIUS server:
1. Click Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > RADIUS Server tab.
2. Complete the RADIUS server information from the table below and click Save. You can conigure up to
three servers.
Field
Authentication Server IP
Address
Authentication Port
Secret
Timeout
Retries
Save
Server Check
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Description
Enter the IP address of your RADIUS server.
Enter the RADIUS authentication server port.
Enter the secret key that allows the device to log into the conigured RADIUS server. It must match
the secret on RADIUS server.
Set the amount of time in seconds that the router should wait for a response from the RADIUS
server.
This determines the number of tries the controller will make to the RADIUS server before giving
up.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
Click to test the connection(s) to your RADIUS Server(s).
133
Section 8 - Security
POP3 Server
Path: Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > POP3 Server
POP3 is an application layer protocol most commonly used for e-mail over a TCP/IP connection. The authentication
server can be used with SSL encryption over port 995 to send encrypted traic to the POP3 server. The POP3
server’s certiicate is veriied by a user-uploaded CA certiicate. If SSL encryption is not used, port 110 will be used
for the POP3 authentication traic.
To conigure the router to connect to your POP3 server:
1. Click Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > POP3 Server tab.
2. Complete the POP3 server information from the table below and click Save. You can conigure up to
three servers.
Field
Authentication Server IP
Address
Authentication Port
SSL Enable
CA File
Timeout
Retries
Save
Server Check
Description
Enter the IP address of your POP3 server.
Enter the POP3 authentication server port.
Toggle to ON to enable SSL support for POP3. If this option is enabled, it is mandatory to select a
certiicate authority for it.
Certiicate Authority to verify POP3 server’s certiicate.
Set the amount of time in seconds that the router should wait for a response from the POP3 server.
This determines the number of tries the controller will make to the POP3 server before giving up.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
Click to test the connection(s) to your POP3 Server(s).
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
134
Section 8 - Security
POP3 Trusted Server
Path: Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > POP3 Trusted CA
A CA ile is used as part of the POP3 negotiation to verify the conigured authentication server identity. Each of
the three conigured servers can have a unique CA used for authentication.
To conigure:
1. Click Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > POP3 Trusted CA tab.
2. Click Add CA File.
3. Click Browse and select a CA ile. Click Open and then click Upload.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
135
Section 8 - Security
LDAP Server
Path: Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > LDAP Server
The LDAP authentication method uses LDAP to exchange authentication credentials between the router and an
external server. The LDAP server maintains a large database of users in a directory structure, so users with the
same user name but belonging to diferent groups can be authenticated since the user information is stored in
a hierarchal manner. Also of note is that coniguring a LDAP server on Windows or Linux servers is considerably
less complex than setting up NT Domain or Active Directory servers for user authentication.
The details conigured on the controller will be passed for authenticating the router and its hosts. The LDAP
attributes, domain name (DN), and in some cases the administrator account & password are key ields in allowing
the LDAP server to authenticate the controller.
To conigure the router to connect to your LDAP server:
1. Click Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > LDAP Server tab.
2. Complete the LDAP server information from the table below and click Save. You can conigure up to
three servers.
Field
Description
Authentication Server (1-3) Enter the IP address of your primary LDAP server.
These are attributes related to LDAP users conigured in LDAP server. These may include attributes like
LDAP Attribute (1-4)
SAM account name, associated domain name etc. These can be used to distinguish between diferent
users having same user name.
LDAP Base DN
Enter the base domain name.
Timeout
Set the amount of time in seconds that the router should wait for a response from the LDAP server.
Retries
This determines the number of tries the controller will make to the LDAP server before giving up.
Save
Administrator Account
Server Check
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
Enter the admin account information that will be used when LDAP authentication is required for PPTP/
L2TP connection.
Click to test the connection(s) to your LDAP Server(s).
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
136
Section 8 - Security
AD Server
Path: Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > AD Server
Active Directory authentication is an enhanced version of NT Domain authentication. The Kerberos protocol is
leveraged for authentication of users, who are grouped in Organizational Units (OUs). In particular the Active
Directory server can support more than a million users given is structure while the NT Domain server is limited to
thousands. The conigured Authentication Servers and Active Directory domain(s) are used to validate the user
with the directory of users on the external Windows based server. This authentication option is common for SSL
VPN client users and is also useful for IPsec / PPTP / L2TP client authentication.
To conigure the router to connect to your AD server:
1. Click Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > AD Server tab.
2. Complete the AD server information from the table on the next page and click Save. You can conigure
up to three servers.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
137
Section 8 - Security
Field
Authentication Server (1-3)
Active Directory Domain
(1-3)
Timeout
Retries
Administrator Account
Save
Server Check
Description
Enter the IP address of your AD server(s).
Enter the active directory domain name(s).
Set the amount of time in seconds that the router should wait for a response from the AD server.
This determines the number of tries the controller will make to the AD server before giving up.
Enter the admin account information that will be used when authentication is required for PPTP/L2TP
connection.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
Click to test the connection(s) to your AD Server(s).
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
138
Section 8 - Security
NT Domain Server
Path: Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > NT Domain
The NT Domain server allows users and hosts to authenticate themselves via a pre-conigured Workgroup
ield. Typically Windows or Samba servers are used to manage the domain of authentication for the centralized
directory of authorized users.
To conigure the router to connect to your NT domain server:
1. Click Security > Authentication > External Auth Server > NT Domain tab.
2. Complete the NT server information from the table below and click Save. You can conigure up to
three servers.
Field
Authentication Server (1-3)
Workgroup (1-3)
Timeout
Retries
Administrator Account
Save
Server Check
Description
Enter the IP address of your NT server(s).
Enter the NT workgroup name(s).
Set the amount of time in seconds that the router should wait for a response from the AD server.
This determines the number of tries the controller will make to the AD server before giving up.
Enter the admin account information that will be used when authentication is required for PPTP/L2TP
connection.
Click Save at the bottom to save and activate your settings.
Click to test the connection(s) to your AD Server(s).
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
139
Section 8 - Security
Login Proiles
Path: Security > Authentication > Login Proiles
When a wireless client connects to the SSIDs or VLANs, the user sees a login page. The Login Proile and SLA page
allows you to customize the appearance of that page with speciic text and images. The wireless router supports
multiple login and SLA pages. Associate login page or SLAs on SSIDs or VLANs separately.
To add, delete, or edit login proiles:
1. Click Security > Authentication > Login Proiles tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new group, click Add New Login Proile.
3. Complete the ields from the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
140
Section 8 - Security
Field
Proile Name
Description
General Details
Enter a name for this captive portal proile. The name should allow you to diferentiate this captive proile from
others you may set up.
Browser Title
Enter the text that will appear in the title of the browser during the captive portal session.
Background
Select whether the login page displayed during the captive portal session will show an image or color. Choices are:
• Image: Displays an image as the background on the page. Use the Page Background Image ield to select a
background image.
• Color: Sets the background color on the page. Select the color from the drop-down menu
Page Background Image
If you set Background to Image, upload the image ile by clicking Add > Browse. Select an image, click Open and
then click the Upload button. The maximum size of the image is 100 kb.
Page Background Upload
Choose the ile you want to upload.
Page Background Color
Custom Color
Minimal Page for Mobile
Devices
If you set Background to Color, select the background color of the page that will appear during the captive portal
session from the drop-down menu.
If you choose Custom on Page Background Color, enter the HTML color code.
Toggle to ON to allow the web page to be properly viewed from a mobile device.
Header Details
Background
Select whether the login page displayed during the captive portal session will show an image or color. Choices are:
• Image: Show image on the page. Use the Header Background Color ield to select a background color. The
maximum size of the image is 100 kb.
• Color: Show background color on the page. Use the radio buttons to select an image.
Header Background Image
If you set Background to Image, upload the image ile by clicking Add > Browse. Select an image, click Open and
then click the Upload button. The maximum size of the image is 100 kb.
Header Background Upload Choose the ile you want to upload.
Header Background Color
Custom Color
Header Caption
Caption Font
If you set Background to Color, select the header color from the drop-down menu.
If you choose Custom on Page Background Color, you can choose particular color by illing in the HTML color code.
Enter the text that appears in the header of the login page during the captive portal session.
Select the font for the header text.
Font Size
Select the font size for the header text.
Font Color
Select the font color for the header text.
Login Section Title
Welcome Message
Error Message
Change Footer Content
Footer Content
Footer Font Color
Login Details
Enter the text that appears in the title of the login box when the user logs in to the captive portal session. This ield
is optional.
Enter the welcome message that appears when users log in to the captive session successfully. This ield is optional.
Enter the error message that appears when users fail to log in to the captive session successfully. This ield is
optional.
Footer Details
Enables or disables changes to the footer content on the login page.
If Change Footer Content is checked, enter the text that appears in the footer.
If Change Footer Content is checked, select the color of the text that appears in the footer.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
141
Section 8 - Security
External Payment Gateway
Enable External Payment
Gateway
Session Title 1
Message
Session Title 2
Success Message
Session Title 3
Failure Message
Enable Billing Proile
Service Disclaimer Text
Payment Server
Enables or disables external payment gateway and online wireless service purchasing from on the login page.
Enter the text that appears in the title of the online purchasing login box when the user logs in to the captive portal
session.
Enter the text appears in the online purchasing login box when the user logs in to the captive portal session.
Enter the text that appears in the title of the message box while online purchasing is complete.
Enter the text that appears in the message box while online purchasing is complete.
Enter the text that appears in the title of the message box while online purchasing is fail.
Enter the text that appears in the message box while online purchasing is fail.
Select the billing proile which will be shown on the login page. The table only listed the billing proiles which are
set Unit Price. Enable the billing proile by switch ON on STATUS.
Enter the service disclaimer text which is shown before user select and purchase wireless service.
Select the payment received account and its payment agent.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
142
Section 8 - Security
Web Content Filtering
Static Filtering
Path: Security > Authentication > Static Filtering
You may block access to certain Internet services.
To block or allow a service:
1. Click Security > Web Content Filter > Static Filtering tab.
2. Toggle Content Filtering to ON.
3. Toggle the service to ON to block. Toggle to OFF to allow.
4. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
143
Section 8 - Security
Approved URLs
Path: Security > Web Content Filter > Static Filtering > Approved URL
The approved URL list is an acceptance list for all URL domain names. Domains added to this list are allowed
in any form. For example, if the domain “dlink” is added to this list then all of the following URL’s are permitted
access from the LAN: www.dlink.com, support.dlink.com, etc.
Importing/exporting from a text or CSV ile is also supported.
To add/import/export URLs to the approved list:
1. Click Security > Web Content Filter > Static Filtering > Approved URL tab.
2. To import a list from a text/CSV ile, click Upload URLs List from File. If you want to export the current
list, click Export URLs List to File. To add a new URL, click Add New Approved URL.
3. Enter a URL and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
144
Section 8 - Security
Blocked Keywords
Path: Security > Web Content Filter > Static Filtering > Blocked Keywords
Keyword blocking allows you to block all website URL’s or site content that contains the keywords in the
conigured list. This is lower priority than the Approved URL List; i.e. if a blocked keyword is present in a site
allowed by a trusted domain in the Approved URL List, then access to that site will be allowed. Import/export
from a text or CSV ile is also supported.
To add/import/export URLs to the approved list:
1. Click Security > Web Content Filter > Static Filtering > Blocked Keywords tab.
2. To import a list from a text/CSV ile, click Upload Keywords List from File. If you want to export the
current list, click Export Keywords List to File. To add a new URL, click Add New Keyword.
3. Enter a keyword and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
145
Section 8 - Security
Dynamic Filtering
Path: Security > Web Content Filter > Dynamic Filtering
Dynamic Filtering will allow you to ilter content from a list of categories. The router must be upgraded with the
WCF license and then the Content Filtering option, which allows the user to ilter out internet sites, needs to be
enabled. When enabled, access to a website belonging to one of these conigured categories will be blocked
with an error page.
To add/import/export URLs to the approved list:
1. Click Security > Web Content Filter > Dynamic Filtering.
2. Toggle Global Filtering to ON to enable dynamic iltering.
3. Toggle any of the listed categories to ON to block. Toggle to OFF to allow.
4. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
146
Section 8 - Security
Firewall
Firewall Rules
Path: Security > Firewall > Firewall Rules > IPv4 Firewall Rules or IPv6 Firewall Rules
Inbound (WAN to LAN/DMZ) rules restrict access to traic entering your network, selectively allowing only
speciic outside users to access speciic local resources. By default all access from the insecure WAN side are
blocked from accessing the secure LAN, except in response to requests from the LAN or DMZ. To allow outside
devices to access services on the secure LAN, you must create an inbound irewall rule for each service.
If you want to allow incoming traic, you must make the router’s WAN port IP address known to the public. This is
called “exposing your host.” How you make your address known depends on how the WAN ports are conigured;
for this router you may use the IP address if a static address is assigned to the WAN port, or if your WAN address
is dynamic a DDNS (Dynamic DNS) name can be used.
Outbound (LAN/DMZ to WAN) rules restrict access to traic leaving your network, selectively allowing only
speciic local users to access speciic outside resources. The default outbound rule is to allow access from
the secure zone (LAN) to either the public DMZ or insecure WAN. On other hand the default outbound rule
is to deny access from DMZ to insecure WAN. You can change this default behavior in the Firewall Settings >
Default Outbound Policy page. When the default outbound policy is allow always, you can to block hosts on
the LAN from accessing internet services by creating an outbound irewall rule for each service.
To create a new irewall rule:
1. Click Security > Firewall > IPv4 Firewall Rules tab or IPv6 Firewall Rules tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new group, click Add New IPv4/IPv6
Firewall Rule.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
147
Section 8 - Security
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
From Zone
To Zone
Service
Action
Source Hosts
Destination Hosts
Log
QoS Priority (IPv4 only)
Description
Select the source of originating traic: either secure LAN, public DMZ, or insecure WAN. For an inbound rule
WAN should be selected.
Select the destination of traic covered by this rule. If the From Zone is the WAN, the To Zone can be the
public DMZ or secure LAN. Similarly if the From Zone is the LAN, then the To Zone can be the public DMZ
or insecure WAN.
Select a service from the drop-down menu. ANY means all traic is afected by this rule.
Select an action from the drop-down menu.
Select a source host. If you select Single Address or Address Range, you will need to enter the IP address or
IP range.
Select a Destination host. If you select Single Address or Address Range, you will need to enter the IP address
or IP range.
Select whether to log irewall traic or not.
Outbound rules (where To Zone = insecure WAN only) can have the traic marked with a QoS priority tag.
Select a priority level:
• Normal-Service: ToS=0 (lowest QoS)
• Minimize-Cost: ToS=1
• Maximize-Reliability: ToS=2
• Maximize-Throughput: ToS=4
• Minimize-Delay: ToS=16
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
148
Section 8 - Security
Schedules
Path: Security > Firewall > Schedules
Firewall rules can be enabled or disabled automatically if they are associated with a conigured schedule. The
schedule coniguration page allows you to deine days of the week and the time of day for a new schedule, and
then this schedule can be selected in the irewall rule coniguration page.
Note: All schedules will follow the time in the router’s conigured time zone. Refer to the section on choosing your Time
Zone and coniguring NTP servers for more information.
To add, delete, or edit a schedule:
1. Click Security > Firewall > Schedules.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new schedule, click Add New Schedule.
Speciic Days enabled
Field
Name
Enter a name for your schedule.
Scheduled Days
Select All Days or Speciic Days.
Monday - Sunday
Scheduled Time of Day
Start Time/End Time
Save
Speciic Times enabled
Description
If you selected Speciic Days, toggle each day you want to ON.
Select All Day or Speciic Times.
If you selected Speciic Times, use the mouse on the blue boxes representing the hour, minutes, and am/
pm to select the start time and end time. Click, hold, and move up to decrease the value or move down to
increase the value.
Click to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
149
Section 8 - Security
Custom Services
Path: Security > Firewall > Custom Services
Custom services can be deined to add to the list of services available during irewall rule coniguration. While
common services have known TCP/UDP/ICMP ports for traic, many custom or uncommon applications exist
in the LAN or WAN. In the custom service coniguration menu you can deine a range of ports and identify the
traic type (TCP/UDP/ICMP) for this service. Once deined, the new service will appear in the services list of the
irewall rules coniguration menu.
To add, delete, or edit a custom service:
1. Click Security > Firewall > Custom Services.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new schedule, click Add New Custom
Service.
Field
Name
Enter a name for your custom service.
Description
Type
Enter the layer 3 protocol that the service uses (TCP, UDP, BOTH, or ICMP).
Port Type
Select Port Range or Multiple Ports.
Start Port
If you selected Port Range, enter the irst (TCP, UDP or BOTH) port of a range that the service uses.
Finish Port
If you selected Port Range, enter the last port of a range that the service uses.
Ports
If you selected Multiple Ports, enter the port or ports separated by a comma.
ICMP Type
Save
The ICMP type is a numeric value that can range between 0 and 40.
Click to save your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
150
Section 8 - Security
ALGs
Path: Security > Firewall > ALGs
Application Level Gateways (ALGs) are security components that enhance the irewall and NAT support of this
router to seamlessly support application layer protocols. In some cases enabling the ALG will allow the irewall
to use dynamic ephemeral TCP/ UDP ports to communicate with the known ports a particular client application
(such as H.323 or RTSP) requires, without which the admin would have to open large number of ports to
accomplish the same support. Because the ALG understands the protocol used by the speciic application that it
supports, it is a very secure and eicient way of introducing support for client applications through the router’s
irewall.
1. Click Security > Firewall > ALGs tab.
2. Toggle the protocol(s) to ON that you want to allow through the router.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
151
Section 8 - Security
SMTP ALGs
Path: Security > Firewall > ALGs > SMTP ALGs
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) is a text based protocol used for transferring email between mail servers
over the Internet. Typically the local SMTP server will be located on a DMZ so that mail sent by remote SMTP
servers will traverse the router to reach the local server. Local users will then use email client software to retrieve
their email from the local SMTP server. SMTP is also used when clients are sending email and SMTP ALG can be
used to monitor SMTP traic originating from both clients and servers.
1. Click Security > Firewall > ALGs > SMTP ALGs tab.
2. Toggle Status to ON.
3. Enter the port at which the SMTP packets are inspected.
4. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
152
Section 8 - Security
Approved Mail IDs
Path: Security > Firewall > ALGs > Approved Mail IDs
1. Click Security > Firewall > ALGs > Approved Mail IDs tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new mail ID, click Add New Approved
Mail ID.
3. Enter a mail ID and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
153
Section 8 - Security
Blocked Mail IDs
Path: Security > Firewall > ALGs > Blocked Mail IDs
1. Click Security > Firewall > ALGs > Blocked Mail IDs tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new mail ID, click Add New Blocked Mail
ID.
3. Enter a mail ID and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
154
Section 8 - Security
Mail Filtering
Path: Security > Firewall > ALGs > Mail Filtering
1. Click Security > Firewall > ALGs > Mail Filtering tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new mail ID, click Add New Mail Filter.
3. Enter a subject and a mail ID.
4. Select to allow or block.
5. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
155
Section 8 - Security
VPN Passthrough
Path: Security > Firewall > VPN Passthrough
This router’s irewall settings can be conigured to allow encrypted VPN traic for IPsec, PPTP, and L2TP VPN tunnel
connections between the LAN and internet. A speciic irewall rule or service is not appropriate to introduce this
passthrough support; instead the options in the VPN Passthrough page must be toggled to ON.
1. Click Security > Firewall > VPN Passthrough.
2. Toggle the VPN protocol you want to allow to ON and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
156
Section 8 - Security
Dynamic Port Forwarding
Application Rules
Path: Security > Firewall > Dynamic Port Forwarding > Application Rules
Application rules are also referred to as port triggering. This feature allows devices on the LAN or DMZ to request
one or more ports to be forwarded to them. Port triggering waits for an outbound request from the LAN/DMZ
on one of the deined outgoing ports, and then opens an incoming port for that speciied type of traic. This can
be thought of as a form of dynamic port forwarding while an application is transmitting data over the opened
outgoing or incoming port(s).
Port triggering application rules are more lexible than static port forwarding that is an available option when
coniguring irewall rules. This is because a port triggering rule does not have to reference a speciic LAN IP or IP
range. As well ports are not left open when not in use, thereby providing a level of security that port forwarding
does not ofer.
Note: Port triggering is not appropriate for servers on the LAN, since there i s a dependency on the LAN device making
an outgoing connection before incoming ports are opened.
Some applications require that when external devices connect to them, they receive data on a speciic port or
range of ports in order to function properly. Th e router must send all incoming data for that application only on
the required port or range of ports. The router has a list of common applications and games with corresponding
outbound and inbound ports to open. You can also specify a port triggering rule by deining the type of traic
(TCP or UDP) and the range of incoming and outgoing ports to open when enabled.
1. Click Security > Firewall > Dynamic Port Forwarding > Application Rules tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new schedule, click Add New Application
Rule.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
157
Section 8 - Security
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Name
Enable
Description
Enter a name for your rule.
Toggle to ON to activate the rule.
Protocol
Select TCP or UDP.
Interface
Select either LAN or DMZ.
Outgoing (Trigger) Port Range
Incoming Port Range
Save
Enter the start and end trigger port range.
Enter the port range to open.
Click to save your settings.
4. Click on the Application Rules Status tab to see a list of rules and their status.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
158
Section 8 - Security
Attack Checks
Path: Security > Firewall > Attack Checks
Attacks can be malicious security breaches or unintentional network issues that render the router unusable
Attack checks allow you to manage WAN security threats such as continual ping requests and discovery via ARP
scans. TCP and UDP lood attack checks can be enabled to manage extreme usage of WAN resources.
Additionally certain Denial-of-Service (DoS) attacks can be blocked. These attacks, if uninhibited, can use up
processing power and bandwidth and prevent regular network services from running normally. ICMP packet
looding, SYN traic looding, and Echo storm thresholds can be conigured to temporarily suspect traic from
the ofending source.
1. Click Security > Firewall > Attack Checks.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Stealth Mode
Block TCP Flood
Block UDP Flood
Allow Ping from LAN
Block ICMP Notiication
Block Fragmented Packets
Block Multicast Packets
Block Spoofed IP Packets
SYN Flood Detect Rate
Echo Storm
ICMP Flood
Description
If this option is toggled to ON, the router will not respond to port scans from the WAN. This makes it less
susceptible to discovery and attacks.
If this option is toggled to ON, the router will drop all invalid TCP packets and be protected from a SYN lood
attack.
If this option is toggled to ON, the router will not accept more than 20 simultaneous, active UDP connections from a single computer on the LAN. You can set the number of simultaneous active UDP connections
to be accepted from a single computer on the LAN; the default is 25.
Toggle to ON to allow local computers to ping.
Toggle to ON to prevent ICMP packets from being identiied as such. ICMP packets, if identiied, can be
captured and used in a Ping (ICMP) lood DoS attack.
Toggle to ON to drop any fragmented packets through or to the gateway
Toggle to ON to drop multicast packets, which could indicate a spoof attack, through or to the router.
Toggle to ON to block any spoofed IP packets.
The rate at which the SYN Flood can be detected.
The number of ping packets per second at which the router detects an Echo storm attack from the WAN and
prevents further ping traic from that external address.
The number of ICMP packets per second at which the router detects an ICMP lood attack from the WAN and
prevents further ICMP traic from that external address.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
159
Section 8 - Security
IntelÂŽ AMT
Path: Security > Firewall > IntelÂŽ AMT
IntelÂŽ Active Management Technology (AMT) allows you to remotely access and manage every networked
device, even those that lack a working operating system or hard drive, or are turned of as long as the computer
is connected to line power and to the network. Intel AMT uses a separate management processor that runs
independently on the client machine and can be reached through the wired or wireless network.
1. Click Security > Firewall > Intel AMT.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Ports
WAN Host
Internal IP Address
Relector
Redirect to Port 16992-16995
Redirect to Port 9971
Description
When enabled, inbound/outbound irewall rules are added for certain ports to enable Intel AMT service.
Select ANY to allow all hosts access or select Specify WAN IPs and enter IP addresses of hosts (separate
with a comma) you want to grant access to. Do not use spaces.
Enter the LAN IP address.
Toggle to ON to enable Relector. This will send data back to the client on selected ports.
Toggle to ON to use the selected port. Enter the listening port on which the server will listen for incoming
connections.
Toggle to ON to use the selected port. Enter the listening port on which the server will listen for incoming
connections.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
160
Section 8 - Security
IPS
Path: Security > Firewall > IPS
The router’s Intrusion Prevention System (IPS) prevents malicious attacks from the internet from accessing
the private network. Static attack signatures loaded to the router allow common attacks to be detected and
prevented. The checks can be enabled between the WAN and DMZ or LAN, and a running counter will allow the
administrator to see how many malicious intrusion attempts from the WAN have been detected and prevented.
Note: The DSR-150/150N routers do not support Intrusion Prevention System.
1. Click Security > Firewall > IPS.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Enable Intrusion Detection
Description
Toggle to ON to enable intrusion detection.
Enable Intrusion Prevention
Toggle to ON to enable intrusion prevention.
LAN and WAN
Toggle to ON to detect intrusions between the LAN and WAN interfaces.
DMZ and WAN
Toggle to ON to detect intrusions between the DMZ and WAN interfaces.
Number of Signatures Loaded
Displays the number of signatures loaded.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
161
Section 9 - Maintenance
Maintenance
System Settings
Path: Maintenance > Administration > System Setting
You may change the name of the router here.
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > System Setting.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Current System Name
Displays the current name for the router.
New Name for System
Enter a new name for the router.
Save
Description
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
162
Section 9 - Maintenance
Date and Time
Path: Maintenance > Administration > Date and Time
You can conigure your time zone, whether or not to adjust for Daylight Savings Time, and with which Network
Time Protocol (NTP) server to synchronize the date and time. You can choose to set Date and Time manually,
which will store the information on the router’s real time clock (RTC). If the router has access to the internet, the
most accurate mechanism to set the router time is to enable NTP server communication.
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > Date and Time.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Current Device Time
Time Zone
Daylight Saving
NTP Servers
NTP Server Type
Primary NTP Server
Description
Displays the current date and time on the router.
Select your time zone from the drop-down menu.
Toggle to ON to enable daylight saving time.
Toggle to ON to use NTP servers on the Internet.
Select either Default or Custom to enter speciic NTP Server addresses.
If you selected Custom, enter the primary NTP server address.
Secondary NTP Server
If you selected Custom, enter the secondary NTP server address.
Time to re-synchronize
Enter the time in minutes for the router to re-synch with the NTP server(s).
Save
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
163
Section 9 - Maintenance
Session Settings
Path: Maintenance > Administration > Session Settings
Here you can set the timeout value for admin and guest logins.
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > Session Settings.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Administrator
Description
Enter the timeout value in minutes for the Administrator account.
Guest
Enter the timeout value in minutes for the Guest account.
Save
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
164
Section 8 - Security
License Updates
Path: Maintenance > Administration > License Update
Certain features can be added to the router by purchasing a license key. An activation code is provided based on
the router’s MAC Address, so it will be unique to that particular device.
Each license has the following three parameters:
Field
Model
Activation Code
Expiration
Description
The license model as it relates to the feature being added.
The activation code corresponding to this license.
Licenses can either have a ixed duration, or are perpetual for the life of this router.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
165
Section 9 - Maintenance
USB Share Ports
Path: Maintenance > Administration > USB Share Ports
This page allows conigure the SharePort feature available on this router.
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > USB Share Ports.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
USB Port 1 Printer
Description
Toggle to ON to enable USB port 1. Once enabled you will need to enter your printer information.
USB Port 2 Printer
Toggle to ON to enable USB port 2. Once enabled you will need to enter your printer information.
Interface Name
Enable Printer
Save
Displays the name of the printer interface.
Displays if the printer is enabled or not. Toggle to ON to enable.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
166
Section 9 - Maintenance
SMS Service
Inbox
Path: Maintenance > Administration > SMS Service > Inbox
The D-Link Services Router has a USB interface to connect 3G modem support to send and receive Short
Messaging Service (SMS). The received messages can be seen in the Inbox and allows the user to create a new
SMS. If WAN3 is used in dedicated WAN mode, load balancing mode, or if the 3G USB device is not connected to
router then the controls on this page will not be available.
To view any incoming messages:
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > SMS Service > Inbox tab.
2. The following details are displayed.
Field
S. No
Sender
Time Stamp
Description
Displays the serial number of the message.
Displays the sender of the message.
Displays the time when the message was sent.
Text
Displays the content of the message.
Save
Click to save and activate your settings.
3. Right-click the entry to delete, refresh, reply, or forward the message.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
167
Section 9 - Maintenance
Create SMS
Path: Maintenance > Administration > SMS Service> Create SMS
This page allows you to send a message using the SMS service.
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > SMS Service > Create SMS tab.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Send Message.
Field
Receiver
Description
Enter the phone number of the intended receiver.
Text Message
Enter the message you want to send.
Send Message
Click to send your message.
Cancel
Click to reset the ields.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
168
Section 9 - Maintenance
Package Manager
Path: Maintenance > Administration > Package Manager
A package is a set of iles which are installed by the router from D-Link’s repositories. This feature allows users
to download new drivers for supported USB devices and language packs to enable multi-lingual support for
the router’s management interface. Multi-lingual support via the package manager allows the user to choose
a language of choice so that the entire textual content in the router’s user interface is presented in the selected
language.
This feature supports a single driver and single language pack to be stored in the router (i.e. these iles are
available for use after device reboot) . There are 2 types of installations supported by this feature:
1. Manual Installation: Upon selecting manual installation, the user has to download the
package which will then display the available languages that the router GUI now supports.
Note: Only drivers provided by D-Link can be used for manual installation. A validation process will
be performed during installation.
2. Auto Installation: By selecting the link “click here” the auto-installation of the package is
exercised. A page showing the list of available drivers / language packs is displayed from which
the user can select and install one of the options. For this type of installation the router must be
able to access the internet, as this will allow the user to download the package from a repository
server which consists of all the available languages.
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > Package Manager.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
169
Section 9 - Maintenance
2. Complete the ields from the table below.
Field
List of Default Drivers
Manual Install
Description
Displays the default drivers that are installed.
Click to display a list of available packages for download. You must be connected to the Internet. Here you
can select the driver to update or install.
If you have downloaded a packed, click Browse and select the package. Click Open and then click Install.
Install History
Displays a list of package installations.
Click Here
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
170
Section 9 - Maintenance
Set Language
Path: Maintenance > Administration > Set Language
You can download language packs (refer to “Package Manager” on page 169) and install them on the router. Once
you have downloaded a pack, follow the steps below to install:
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > Set Language.
2. Select a loaded language pack from the drop-down menu and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
171
Section 9 - Maintenance
Web GUI Management
Path: Maintenance > Administration > Web GUI Management
The Web GUI Management page will allow you to specify by IP address or VLAN what users can conigure the
router using the web GUI.
1. Click Maintenance > Administration > Web GUI Management.
2. Toggle Enable to ON and click Save.
3. Click Add New Coniguration.
4. Enter a name for this coniguration.
5. Select either Single IP Address and enter the IP address of the computer/device or VLAN Network
and enter the VLAN ID that you want to allow access to the web GUI.
6. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
172
Section 9 - Maintenance
Remote Management
Path: Maintenance > Management > Remote Management
Enable this feature to be able to manage the router from a remote location, using HTTPS or Telnet. Both HTTPS
and Telnet access can be restricted to a subset of IP addresses. The router administrator can deine a known PC,
single IP address or range of IP addresses that are allowed to access the GUI with HTTPS. The opened port for SSL
traic can be changed from the default of 443 at the same time as deining the allowed remote management IP
address range.
1. Click Maintenance > Management > Remote Management.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Enable Remote Management
HTTPS Port No.
SSH
SNMP
Access Type
Respond to Ping
Save
Description
Toggle to ON to enable remote management.
Enter the port for HTTPS access. The default port is 443.
Toggle ON to enable SSH (Secure Shell) protocol which can be used to access the CLI over the network
from a remote host.
Toggle to ON to enable SNMP for remote management.
Select either All IP Addresses, IP Address Range (enter an IP range), or Only Selected PC (enter an IP
address).
Toggle to ON to allow the router to respond to ping requests from the WAN.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
173
Section 9 - Maintenance
SNMP
Path: Maintenance > Management > SNMP
SNMP is an additional management tool that is useful when multiple routers in a network are being managed by
a central Master system. When an external SNMP manager is provided with this router’s Management Information
Base (MIB) ile, the manager can update the router’s hierarchal variables to view or update coniguration
parameters. The router as a managed device has an SNMP agent that allows the MIB coniguration variables
to be accessed by the Master (the SNMP manager). The Access Control List on the router identiies managers
in the network that have read-only or read-write SNMP credentials. The Traps List outlines the port over which
notiications from this router are provided to the SNMP community (managers) and also the SNMP version (v1,
v2c, v3) for the trap.
SNMP User List
1. Click Maintenance > Management > SNMP > SNMP tab.
2. Right-click a user and select Edit if you want to change the security level.
3. Select the security level from the drop-down list. Select one of the following:
• No-Auth No-Priv: Only requires a user name match for authentication.
• Auth No-Priv: Provides authentication based on the MD5 or SHA algorithms.
• Auth Priv: Provides authentication based on the MD5 or SHA algorithms as well as encryption
privacy with the DES 256-bit standard.
4. Click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
174
Section 9 - Maintenance
SNMP Trap List
Path: Maintenance > Management > SNMP > SNMP Trap List
To create a new SNMP trap:
1. Click Maintenance > Management > SNMP > SNMP Trap List tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new trap, click Add SNMP Trap.
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
IP Address
Port
Community
Authentication Type
Save
Description
The IP Address of the SNMP trap agent.
The SNMP trap port to which the trap messages will be sent.
The community string to which the agent belongs. Most agents are conigured to listen for traps in the
Public community.
The SNMP version used by the trap agent. The choices are v1, v2c, or v3.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
175
Section 9 - Maintenance
Access Control
Path: Maintenance > Management > SNMP > Access Control List
To edit, delete, or create a new access control entry:
1. Click Maintenance > Management > SNMP > Access Control List tab.
2. Right-click an entry and select either Edit or Delete. To add a new trap, click Add Access Control.
3. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Community
Access Type
Save
Description
The IP Address of the SNMP agent.
The network mask used to determine the list of allowed SNMP managers.
The community string to which the agent belongs. Most agents are conigured to listen for traps in the
Public community.
Access will be either read only (ROcommunity) or read-write (RWcommunity).
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
176
Section 9 - Maintenance
SNMP System Info
Path: Maintenance > Management > SNMP > SNMP System Info
To create a new SNMP trap:
1. Click Maintenance > Management > SNMP > SNMP System Info tab.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
SysContact
Description
The name of the contact person for this router. Examples: admin, John Doe.
SysLocation
The physical location of the router: Example: Rack #2, 4th Floor.
SysName
Save
A name given for easy identiication of the router.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
177
Section 9 - Maintenance
Diagnostics
Ping an IP Address/Domain Name
Path: Maintenance > Management > Diagnostics > Network Tools
As part of the diagnostics functions on the router, you can ping an IP address or domain name. You can use this
function to test connectivity between the router and another device on the network or the Internet.
1. Click Maintenance > Diagnostics > Network Tools tab.
2. Under Command Output for Ping and Traceroute, in the IP Address/Domain Name ield, enter an IP
address or domain name.
3. Click Ping. The results will appear in the Command Output display below.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
178
Section 9 - Maintenance
Using Traceroute
Path: Maintenance > Management > Diagnostics > Network Tools
The router provides a Traceroute function that lets you map the network path to a public host. Up to 30 “hops”
between this router and the destination will be displayed.
1. Click Maintenance > Diagnostics > Network Tools tab.
2. Under Command Output for Ping and Traceroute, in the IP Address/Domain Name ield, enter an IP
address or domain name.
3. Click Traceroute. The results will appear in the Command Output display below.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
179
Section 9 - Maintenance
Performing DNS Lookups
Path: Maintenance > Management > Diagnostics > Network Tools
The router provides a DNS lookup function that lets you retrieve the IP address of a Web, FTP, Mail, or any other
server on the Internet.
1. Click Maintenance > Diagnostics > Network Tools tab.
2. Under DNS Lookup, in the Domain Name ield, enter an Internet name.
3. Click Lookup. The results will appear in the Command Output display. If the host or domain entry exists,
a response will appear with the IP address. If the message Host Unknown appears, the Internet name
does not exist.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
180
Section 9 - Maintenance
Capture Packets
Path: Maintenance > Management > Diagnostics > Capture Packets
The router lets you capture all packets that pass through the LAN and WAN interfaces. The packet trace is limited
to 1MB of data per capture session. If the capture ile size exceeds 1MB, it is deleted automatically and a new
capture ile is created.
1. Click Maintenance > Diagnostics > Capture Packets tab.
2. Select an interface from the drop-down menu.
3. Click Start Trace. The trace can be downloaded by clicking the Download button, which will
immediately begin the download to the browser’s default download location. To stop the trace click
Stop Trace.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
181
Section 9 - Maintenance
System Check
Path: Maintenance > Management > Diagnostics > System Check
As part of the diagnostics functions on the router, you can view the static and dynamic routes for both IPv4 and IPv6.
1. Click Maintenance > Diagnostics > System Check tab.
2. Click Display IPv4 Table or Display IPv6 Table. The results will appear in the Command Output
display.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
182
Section 9 - Maintenance
Power Saving
Path: Maintenance > Management > Power Saving
The router allows you to adjust the power consumption of the hardware based on your actual usage. The two
“green” options available for your LAN switch are Power Saving by Link Status and Length Detection State.
1. Click Maintenance > Diagnostics > Power Saving.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
By Link Status
By Cable Length Detection
Save
Description
With “Power Saving by Link Status” option toggled to ON, the total power consumption by the LAN switch
is dependent function of on the number of connected ports. The overall current draw when a single port is
connected is less than when all the ports are connected.
With “Length Detection State” option toggled to ON, the overall current supplied to a LAN port is reduced
when a smaller cable length is connected on a LAN port.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
183
Section 9 - Maintenance
Firmware Upgrade
You can upgrade to a newer irmware version from the Administration web page. In the Firmware Upgrade
section, to upgrade your irmware, click Browse, locate and select the irmware image on your host, and click
Upgrade. After the new irmware image is validated, the new image is written to lash and the router will
automatically reboot with the new irmware.
Warning: During the irmware upgrade, do NOT try to go online, turn of the DSR, shut down your PC, or interrupt the
process in anyway until the operation is complete. This should take only a minute or so including the reboot process.
Interrupting the upgrade process at speciic points when the flash is being written to may corrupt the flash memory
and render the router unusable without a low-level process of restoring the flash irmware (not through the web GUI).
Check Update
Path: Maintenance > Firmware > Firmware Upgrade
This router supports an automated notiication to determine if a newer irmware version is available for this
router. By clicking the Check Now button in the notiication section, the router will check a D-Link server to see
if a newer irmware version for this router is available for download.
To see if a new version is available:
1. Click Maintenance > Firmware > Firmware Upgrade > Check Update tab.
2. Click Check Now. If new irmware is available or if you have the most current version a message will
appear under Status.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
184
Section 9 - Maintenance
Using PC
To upgrade the irmware from a PC:
1. Download the latest irmware version from the D-Link support website.
2. Once downloaded, log in to the router and click Maintenance > Firmware > Firmware Upgrade >
Using System (PC) tab.
3. Click Browse and locate the irmware ile you downloaded. Select it and click Open.
4. Click Upgrade.
Note: The upgrade process takes a few minutes. Do not interrupt the upgrade or turn of the router;
otherwise you can damage the irmware. Wait for the upgrade to complete before browsing any sites from
your browser.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
185
Section 9 - Maintenance
Using USB
To upgrade the irmware using a USB thumb drive:
1. Download the latest irmware version from the D-Link support website and copy the ile to a USB
thumb drive.
2. Plug the USB thumb drive into a USB port on the router.
3. Log in to the router and click Maintenance > Firmware > Firmware Upgrade > Using USB tab.
4. Select the irmware ile from the list and click Upgrade.
Note: The upgrade process takes a few minutes. Do not interrupt the upgrade or turn of the router;
otherwise you can damage the irmware. Wait for the upgrade to complete before browsing any sites from
your browser.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
186
Section 9 - Maintenance
Coniguration Files
Backup
Path: Maintenance > Firmware > Backup / Restore
After you conigure the router, you can back up the coniguration settings. When you back up the settings, they
are saved as a ile. You can then use the ile to restore the settings on the same router if something goes wrong
or on a diferent router (must be the same model) that will replace the existing router.
To backup your coniguration iles:
1. Click Maintenance > Firmware > Backup / Restore tab.
2. To save the ile to your computer, click Save to System (PC). If you have a USB thumb drive connected
to the router, you can click Save to USB Port 1 (or Port 2).
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
187
Section 9 - Maintenance
Restore
To restore your settings from a saved backup ile:
1. Click Maintenance > Firmware > Backup / Restore.
2. To restore the ile from your computer, click Browse and select the ile. Click Open and then click
Restore.
To restore the ile from a USB thumb drive, select the ile in the list under the corresponding USB port
and click Restore.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
188
Section 9 - Maintenance
Coniguration Settings
If there is a USB storage device currently plugged in to the router, you can enable auto-backup. The snapshot of
current coniguration settings will be updated on the USB storage device and overwrite any iles with the same
ilename (i.e., if there was an earlier coniguration backup done to this location).
1. Click Maintenance > Firmware > Backup / Restore > Coniguration Settings tab.
2. Toggle Backup Coniguration to USB Automatically to ON to automatically save your coniguration
settings to a ile on your USB storage device.
3. Toggle Encrypt Coniguration File to ON to encrypt the coniguration ile. This will ensure conidential
information like system username/passwords are not available for view by unauthorized sources.
Enabling this option will apply to coniguration iles backed up on the host as well as a USB drive.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
189
Section 9 - Maintenance
Soft Reboot
Performing a soft reboot simply performs a power cycle.
1. Click Maintenance > Firmware > Soft Reboot.
2. Click Soft Reboot. The router will power cycle.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
190
Section 9 - Maintenance
Reset to Factory Default Settings
If you reset the router to its factory default settings, it returns to the state when it was new — all changes you
made to the default coniguration are lost. Examples of settings that get restored include critical things you need
to get online, such as login password, SSID, IP addresses, and wireless security keys.
1. Click Maintenance > Firmware > Soft Reboot.
2. Click Default. The router will power cycle and reset all settings to the default values.
Note: After restoring to the factory default settings, the router’s default LAN IP address is 192.168.10.1, the
default login user name is ‘admin’, and the default login password is ‘admin’.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
191
Section 9 - Maintenance
Log Settings
The router allows you capture log messages. You can monitor the type of traic that goes through the router
and be notiied of potential attacks or errors when they are detected by the controller. The following sections
describe the log coniguration settings and the ways you can access these logs.
Deining What to Log
Path: Maintenance > Logs Settings > Log Facilities
The Facility Logs page lets you determine the granularity of logs to receive from the wireless controller. Select
one of the following facilities:
• Kernel: The Linux kernel. Log messages that correspond to this facility would correspond to
traic through the irewall or network stack.
• System: Application and management-level features available on this router for managing the
unit.
• Local1-UTM: This facility corresponds to IPS (Intrusion Prevention System) which helps in
detecting malicious intrusion attempts from the WAN.
• Local0-Wireless: This facility corresponds to the 802.11 driver used for providing AP
functionality to your network.
1. Click Maintenance > Log Settings > Log Facilities.
2. Select the facility and then toggle ON which events you want to log and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
192
Section 9 - Maintenance
For each facility, the following events (in order of severity) can be logged:
• Emergency: system is unusable
• Alert: action must be taken immediately
• Critical: critical conditions
• Error: error conditions
• Warning: warning conditions
• Notiication: normal but signiicant condition
• Information: informational
• Debugging: debug-level messages
When a particular severity level is selected, all events with severity equal to and greater than the chosen severity
are captured. For example if you have conigured CRITICAL level logging for the Wireless facility, then 802.11
logs with severities CRITICAL, ALERT, and EMERGENCY are logged.
The display for logging can be customized based on whether the logs are sent to the Event Log viewer in the
web management interface (the Event Log viewer is in the Status > System Information > All Logs > Current
Logs) or a remote Syslog server for later review. E-mail logs, discussed in a subsequent section, follow the same
coniguration as logs conigured for a Syslog server.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
193
Section 9 - Maintenance
Routing Logs
Path: Maintenance > Logs Settings > Routing Logs
Traic can be tracked based on whether the packet was accepted or dropped by the irewall. Denial of service
attacks, general attack information, login attempts, dropped packets, and similar events can be captured for
review.
Note: Enabling logging options may generate a signiicant volume of log messages and is recommended for
debugging purposes only.
Traic through each network segment (LAN, WAN, DMZ) can be tracked based on whether the packet was
accepted or dropped by the irewall.
Accepted Packets are those that were successfully transferred through the corresponding network segment (i.e.,
LAN to WAN). This option is particularly useful when the Default Outbound Policy is “Block Always” so you can
monitor traic that is passed through the irewall.
Dropped Packets are packets that were intentionally blocked from being transferred through the corresponding
network segment. This option is useful when the Default Outbound Policy is “Allow Always”.
1. Click Maintenance > Log Settings > Routing Logs.
2. Toggle which events you want to log to ON and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
194
Section 9 - Maintenance
System Logs
Path: Maintenance > Logs Settings > System Logs
In addition to network segment logging, unicast and multicast traic can be logged. Unicast packets have a
single destination on the network, whereas broadcast (or multicast) packets are sent to all possible destinations
simultaneously. One other useful log control is to log packets that are dropped due to conigured bandwidth
proiles over a particular interface. This data will indicate to the admin whether the bandwidth proile has to be
modiied to account for the desired internet traic of LAN users.
1. Click Maintenance > Log Settings > System Logs.
2. Toggle which events you want to log to ON and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
195
Section 9 - Maintenance
Remote Logs
Path: Maintenance > Logs Settings > Remote Logs
Once you have conigured the type of logs that you want the router to collect, they can be sent to either a Syslog
server or an E-Mail address. For remote logging a key coniguration ield is the Remote Log Identiier. Every
logged message will contain the conigured preix of the Remote Log Identiier, so that syslog servers or email
addresses that receive logs from more than one router can sort for the relevant device’s logs.
Once you enable the option to e-mail logs, enter the e-mail server’s address (IP address or FQDN) of the SMTP
server. The router will connect to this server when sending e-mails out to the conigured addresses. The SMTP
port and return e-mail addresses are required ields to allow the router to package the logs and send a valid e-mail
that is accepted by one of the conigured “send-to” addresses. Up to three e-mail addresses can be conigured as
log recipients.
In order to establish a connection with the conigured SMTP port and server, deine the server’s authentication
requirements. The router supports Login Plain (no encryption) or CRAM-MD5 (encrypted) for the username and
password data to be sent to the SMTP server. Authentication can be disabled if the server does not have this
requirement. In some cases the SMTP server may send out IDENT requests, and this router can have this response
option enabled as needed.
Once the e-mail server and recipient details are deined you can determine when the router should send out
logs. E-mail logs can be sent out based on a deined schedule by irst choosing the unit (i.e., the frequency) of
sending logs: Hourly, Daily, or Weekly. Selecting Never will disable log e-mails but will preserve the e-mail server
settings.
1. Click Maintenance > Log Settings > Remote Logs.
2. Complete the ields from the table on the next page and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
196
Section 9 - Maintenance
Field
SMTP Port
Description
Enter a preix used to identify the source of the message. This identiier is preixed to both e-mail and
Syslog messages.
Toggle to ON to enable E-Mail logs.
Enter the IP address or network address of the SMTP server. The router will connect to this server to send
e-mail logs when required. The SMTP server must be operational for e-mail notiications to be received.
Enter the SMTP port of the e-mail server.
Return E-Mail Address
Enter the e-mail address where replies from the SMTP server are to be sent (required for failure messages).
Send to E-Mail Address (1-3)
Remote Log Identiier
E-Mail Log
E-Mail Server Address
Day
Enter up to three e-mail addresses where logs and alerts are to be sent.
Select an authentication if the SMTP server requires authentication before accepting connections. Choices
are:
• None: No authentication is used. The User Name and Password ields are not available.
• Login Plain: Authentication used to log in using Base64-encoded passwords over non-encrypted
communication session. Base64-encoded passwords ofer no cryptographic protection, making them
vulnerable.
• CRAM-MD5: A challenge-response authentication mechanism deined in RFC 2195 based on the
HMAC-MD5 MAC algorithm. CRAM-MD5 ofers a higher level of authentication than Login Plain.
If Authentication with SMTP is set to Login Plain or CRAM-MD5, enter the user name to be used for
authentication.
If Authentication with SMTP is set to Login Plain or CRAM-MD5, enter the case-sensitive password to be
used for authentication.
Toggle to ON to have the router respond to IDENT requests from the SMTP server.
Select the period of time that you need to send the log. This option is useful when you do not want to
receive logs by e-mail, but want to keep e-mail options conigured, so you can use the Send Log function
Event Log viewer pages. Choices are:
• Never: Disable sending of logs.
• Hourly: Send logs every hour.
• Daily: Send logs every day at the Time speciied.
• Weekly: Send logs weekly, at the Day and Time speciied.
If Unit is set to Weekly, select the day of the week when logs will be sent.
Time
If Unit is set to Daily or Weekly, select the time when logs will be sent.
Save
Click to save and activate your settings.
Authentication with SMTP
User Name
Password
Respond to identd from SMTP
Unit
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
197
Section 9 - Maintenance
Syslog Server
Path: Maintenance > Logs Settings > Syslog Server
An external Syslog server is often used to collect and store logs from the router. This remote device typically has
less memory constraints than the local Event Viewer on the router. Therefore, a number of logs can be collected
over a sustained period. This is useful for debugging network issues or to monitor router traic over a long
duration.
The router supports eight concurrent Syslog servers. Each server can be conigured to receive diferent log
facility messages of varying severity using the Remote Logs page. This page also lets you send coniguration
logs to three email recipients.
1. Click Maintenance > Log Settings > Syslog Server.
2. Complete the ields from the table on the next page and click Save.
Field
Syslog Server 1
FQDN / IP Address
Description
Toggle to ON to setup a Syslog server.
Enter the IP address or Internet Name of the Syslog server.
Facility
Select which facility you want to log. Refer to “Deining What to Log” on page 192 for deinitions.
Severity
Select the severity level you want to log. Refer to “Deining What to Log” on page 192 for deinitions.
Syslog Server 2-8
Save
Toggle to ON to setup another Syslog server. Repeat the ields above for each server you want to setup.
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
198
Section 9 - Maintenance
Event Logs
Path: Maintenance > Logs Settings > Event Logs
The router’s web management interface displays conigured log messages from the Status menu. When traic
through or to the router matches settings in the Facility Logs page or Routing Logs page, the corresponding log
message will appear in this window with a timestamp.
1. Click Maintenance > Log Settings > Event Logs.
2. Toggle to ON and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
199
Section 9 - Maintenance
IPv6 Logs
Path: Maintenance > Logs Settings > IPv6 Logs
This page allows you to conigure what IPv6 events you want to log.
1. Click Maintenance > Log Settings > IPv6 Logs.
2. Complete the ields from the table below and click Save.
Field
Accepted Packets
Description
LAN to WAN
Toggle to ON to log accepted packets.
Dropped Packets
Toggle to ON to log dropped packets.
WAN
Accepted Packets
Toggle to ON to log accepted packets.
Dropped Packets
Toggle to ON to log dropped packets.
Save
Click to save and activate your settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
200
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Status and Statistics
Dashboard
Path: Status > Dashboard
The router provides a dashboard that displays about the resources the system is using. The dashboard page is
organized into the following sections:
Field
Traic Overview
WAN Ports
Bandwidth Usage
VPNs
Traic Information
Description
Displays a chart of traic overview by service for each interface.
Displays a chart of traic overview by bandwidth and packet information for WAN traic.
Displays bandwidth usage by network segment such as WAN or LAN. The data is broken into by applications
service such as HTTP, HTTPS, DNS, SNMP, and others.
Displays a chart of VPN traic by bandwidth and number of tunnels.
Displays a grid of traic statistics for each interface.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
201
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Manage Dashboard
To manage the dashboard:
1. Click on the Manage Dashboard button.
2. The following window will pop out and allow you to enable or disable the overview panels shown on
the dashboard. Toggle the panel to ON or OFF and click Save.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
202
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
System
Path: Status > System Information > Device > System
The System Info page displays the current system name, irmware version, hardware version, and serial number.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
203
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
LAN Info
Path: Status > System Information > Device > LAN
The LAN Information page summarizes the LAN settings including MAC address, IP address, and link state.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
204
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
WAN1
Path: Status > System Information > Device > WAN1
The WAN1 Information page summarizes the WAN1 port settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
205
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
WAN2
Path: Status > System Information > Device > WAN2
The WAN2 Information page summarizes the WAN2 port settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
206
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
WAN3
Path: Status > System Information > Device > WAN3
The WAN3 Information page summarizes the WAN3 settings.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
207
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Wireless
Path: Status > System Information > Device > Wireless
The Wireless Information page displays traic statistics for each enabled access point. This page will give a
snapshot of how much traic is being transmitted over each wireless link.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
208
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
All Logs
Current Logs
Path: Status > System Information > All Logs > Current Logs
The Current Logs window displays conigured log messages from the router as they appear. Each log will appear
with a timestamp as determined by the router's conigured time. If remote logging such as a Syslog server or
e-mail logging is conigured, the same logs are sent to the remote interface while being displayed here.
Click Clear All to remove all entries in the Display Logs screen or click Send Logs to send all logs in the Current
Logs screen to preconigured e-mail recipients.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
209
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Firewall Logs
Path: Status > System Information > All Logs > Firewall Logs
The Firewall Logs window displays conigured irewall event messages from the router as they appear. Each log
will appear with a timestamp as determined by the router's conigured time.
Click Clear All to remove all entries in the Display Logs screen or click Send Logs to send all logs in the Current
Logs screen to preconigured e-mail recipients.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
210
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
IPSec VPN Logs
Path: Status > System Information > All Logs > IPSec VPN Logs
The IPSec VPN Logs window displays IPSec VPN event messages from the router as they appear. Each log will
appear with a timestamp as determined by the router's conigured time.
Click Clear All to remove all entries in the Display Logs screen or click Send Logs to send all logs in the Current
Logs screen to preconigured e-mail recipients.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
211
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
SSL VPN Logs
Path: Status > System Information > All Logs > SSL VPN Logs
The SSL VPN Logs window displays SSL VPN event messages from the router as they appear. Each log will appear
with a timestamp as determined by the router's conigured time.
Click Clear All to remove all entries in the Display Logs screen or click Send Logs to send all logs in the Current
Logs screen to preconigured e-mail recipients.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
212
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
USB Status
Path: Status > System Information > USB Status
The USB Status page summarizes the USB devices connected to the router. You may connect USB printer and
USB storage device directly to the router.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
213
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Network Information
DHCP Leased Clients
Path: Status > Network Information > DHCP Clients
Three separated tabs display a list of clients whom get IP leased from the router: LAN leased clients, IPv6 leased
clients, and DMZ leased clients.
LAN Leased Clients
IPv6 Leased Clients
DMZ Leased Clients
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
214
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Active Sessions
Path: Status > Network Information > Active Sessions
This table lists the active internet sessions through the router’s irewall. The session’s protocol, state, local, and
remote IP addresses are shown.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
215
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Active VPNs
Path: Status > Network Information > Active VPNs
You can view and change the status (connect or drop) of the router’s VPN associations/connections. Here, the
active VPN associations/connections are listed along with the traic details and tunnel state. The traic is a
cumulative measure of transmitted/received packets since the tunnel was established.
IPSec SAs
SSL VPN Connections
PPTP VPN Connections
OpenVPN Connections
L2TP VPN Connections
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
216
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Interface Statistics
Path: Status > Network Information > Interfaces Statistics
This page displays packet information on the LAN, VLAN, and WLAN interfaces.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
217
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
View Wireless Clients
Path: Status > Network Information > Wireless Clients
The clients connected to a particular AP can be viewed on this page. Connected clients are sorted by the MAC
address and indicate the security parameters used by the wireless link, as well as the time connected to the
corresponding AP. The statistics table has auto-refresh control which allows display of the most current port level
data at each page refresh. The default auto-refresh for this page is 10 seconds.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
218
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Device Stats
Path: Status > Network Information > Device Stats
Detailed transmit and receive statistics for each physical port are presented here. Each interface (WAN1, WAN2/
DMZ, LAN, and VLANs) have port speciic packet level information provided for review. Transmitted/received
packets, port collisions, and the cumulating bytes/sec for transmit/receive directions are provided for each
interface along with the port up time. If you suspect issues with any of the wired ports, this table will help
diagnose uptime or transmit level issues with the port.
The statistics table has auto-refresh control which allows display of the most current port level data at each page
refresh. The default auto-refresh for this page is 10 seconds.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
219
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
Wireless Statistics
Path: Status > Network Information > Wireless Statistics
The Wireless Statistics page displays the incrementing traic statistics for each enabled access point. This page
will give a snapshot of how much traic is being transmitted over each wireless link. If you suspect that a radio
or VAP may be down, the details on this page would conirm if traic is being sent and received through the VAP.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
220
Section 10 - Status and Statistics
View LAN Clients
Path: Status > Network Information > LAN Clients
The LAN clients to the router are identiied by an ARP scan through the LAN switch. The NetBIOS name (if
available), IP address, and MAC address of discovered LAN hosts are displayed.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
221
Section 11 - Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
Internet Connection
Symptom: You cannot access the router’s web-coniguration interface from a PC on your LAN.
Recommended action:
1. Check the Ethernet connection between the PC and the router.
2. Ensure that your PC’s IP address is on the same subnet as the router. If you are using the recommended
addressing scheme, your PC’s address should be in the range 192.168.10.2 to 192.168.10.254.
3. Check your PC’s IP address. If the PC cannot reach a DHCP server, some versions of Windows and
Mac OS generate and assign an IP address. These auto-generated addresses are in the range
169.254.x.x. If your IP address is in this range, check the connection from the PC to the irewall and
reboot your PC.
4. If your router’s IP address has changed and you don’t know what it is, reset the router coniguration
to factory defaults (this sets the irewall’s IP address to 192.168.10.1).
5. If you do not want to reset to factory default settings and lose your coniguration, reboot the
router and use a packet snifer (such as Ethereal™) to capture packets sent during the reboot. Look
at the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) packets to locate the router’s LAN interface address.
6. Launch your browser and ensure that Java, JavaScript, or ActiveX is enabled. If you are using
Internet Explorer, click Refresh to ensure that the Java applet is loaded. Close the browser and
launch it again.
7. Ensure that you are using the correct login information. The factory default login name is admin
and the password is password. Ensure that CAPS LOCK is of when entering this information.
Symptom: Router does not save coniguration changes.
Recommended action:
1. When entering coniguration settings, click Apply before moving to another menu or tab;
otherwise your changes are lost.
2. Click Refresh or Reload in the browser. Your changes may have been made, but the browser may
be caching the old coniguration.
Symptom: Router cannot access the Internet.
Possible cause: If you use dynamic IP addresses, your router may not have requested an IP address from the ISP.
Recommended action:
1. Launch your browser and go to an external site such as www.google.com.
2. Access the irewall’s coniguration main menu at http://192.168.10.1.
3. Select Monitoring > Router Status.
4. Ensure that an IP address is shown for the WAN port. If 0.0.0.0 is shown, your irewall has not
obtained an IP address from your ISP. See the next symptom.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
222
Section 11 - Troubleshooting
Symptom: Router cannot obtain an IP address from the ISP.
Recommended action:
1. Turn of power to the cable or DSL modem.
2. Turn of the router.
3. Wait ive minutes, and then reapply power to the cable or DSL modem.
4. When the modem LEDs indicate that it has resynchronized with the ISP, reapply power to the
router. If the router still cannot obtain an ISP address, see the next symptom.
Symptom: Router still cannot obtain an IP address from the ISP.
Recommended action:
1. Ask your ISP if it requires a login program — PPP over Ethernet (PPPoE) or some other type of login.
2. If yes, verify that your conigured login name and password are correct.
3. Ask your ISP if it checks for your PC’s hostname.
4. If yes, select Network Coniguration > WAN Settings > Ethernet ISP Settings and set the account
name to the PC hostname of your ISP account.
5. Ask your ISP if it allows only one Ethernet MAC address to connect to the Internet, and therefore
checks for your PC’s MAC address.
6. If yes, inform your ISP that you have bought a new network device, and ask them to use the irewall’s
MAC address.
7. Alternatively, select Network Coniguration > WAN Settings > Ethernet ISP Settings and conigure
your router to spoof your PC’s MAC address.
Symptom: Router can obtain an IP address, but PC is unable to load Internet pages.
Recommended action:
1. Ask your ISP for the addresses of its designated Domain Name System (DNS) servers. Conigure
your PC to recognize those addresses. For details, see your operating system documentation.
2. On your PC, conigure the router to be its TCP/IP gateway.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
223
Section 11 - Troubleshooting
Date and time
Symptom: Date shown is January 1, 1970.
Possible cause: The router has not yet successfully reached a network time server (NTS).
Recommended action:
1. If you have just conigured the router, wait at least ive minutes, select Administration > Time Zone,
and recheck the date and time.
2. Verify your Internet access settings.
Symptom: Time is of by one hour.
Possible cause: The router does not automatically adjust for Daylight Savings Time.
Recommended action:
1. Select Administration > Time Zone and view the current date and time settings.
2. Click to check or uncheck “Automatically adjust for Daylight Savings Time”, then click Apply.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
224
Section 11 - Troubleshooting
Pinging to Test LAN Connectivity
Most TCP/IP terminal devices and irewalls contain a ping utility that sends an ICMP echo-request packet to the
designated device. The DSR responds with an echo reply. Troubleshooting a TCP/IP network is made very easy by
using the ping utility in your PC or workstation.
Testing the LAN path from your PC to your router
1. From the PC’s Windows toolbar, Click Start and in the search box at the bottom, type cmd and
press Enter.
2. At the prompt, type ping  where  is the router’s IP address. Example:
ping 192.168.10.1.
3. Press Enter.
4. Observe the display:
• If the path is working, you will see this message sequence:
Pinging  with 32 bytes of data
Reply from : bytes=32 time=NN ms TTL=xxx
• If the path is not working, you will see this message sequence:
Pinging  with 32 bytes of data
Request timed out
5. If the path is not working, Test the physical connections between PC and router:
• If the LAN port LED is of, go to the “LED displays” section on your Install Guide and follow
instructions for “LAN or Internet port LEDs are not lit.”
• Verify that the corresponding link LEDs are lit for your network interface card and for any
hub ports that are connected to your workstation and irewall.
6. If the path is still not up, test the network coniguration:
• Verify that the Ethernet card driver software and TCP/IP software are installed and
conigured on the PC.
• Verify that the IP address for the router and PC are correct and on the same subnet.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
225
Section 11 - Troubleshooting
Testing the LAN path from your PC to a remote device
1. From the PC’s Windows toolbar, Click Start and in the search box at the bottom, type cmd and
press Enter.
2. Type ping -n 10  where -n 10 speciies a maximum of 10 tries and  is
the IP address of a remote device such as your ISP’s DNS server. Example: ping -n 10 10.1.1.1.
3. Press Enter and then observe the display (see the previous procedure).
4. If the path is not working, do the following:
• Check that the PC has the IP address of your irewall listed as the default gateway. (If the
IP coniguration of your PC is assigned by DHCP, this information is not visible in your PC’s
Network Control Panel.)
• Verify that the network (subnet) address of your PC is diferent from the network address
of the remote device.
• Verify that the cable or DSL modem is connected and functioning.
• Ask your ISP if it assigned a hostname to your PC. If yes, select Network Coniguration >
WAN Settings > Ethernet ISP Settings and enter that hostname as the ISP account name.
• Ask your ISP if it rejects the Ethernet MAC addresses of all but one of your PCs.
Many broadband ISPs restrict access by allowing traic from the MAC address of only your
broadband modem; but some ISPs additionally restrict access to the MAC address of just a single
PC connected to that modem. If this is the case, conigure your irewall to clone or spoof the MAC
address from the authorized PC.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
226
Section 11 - Troubleshooting
Restoring factory-default coniguration settings
To restore factory-default coniguration settings, do either of the following:
1. Do you know the account password and IP address?
• If yes, select Maintenance > Firmware & Conig > Soft Reboot and click Default.
• If no, do the following:
On the rear panel of the router, press and hold the Reset button about 10 seconds, until
the test LED lights and then blinks. Release the button and wait for the router to reboot.
2. If the router does not restart automatically; manually restart it to make the default settings efective.
3. After a restore to factory defaults —whether initiated from the coniguration interface or the Reset
button — the following settings apply:
• LAN IP address: 192.168.10.1
• Username: admin
• Password: admin
• DHCP server on LAN: enabled
• WAN port coniguration: Get coniguration via DHCP
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
227
Appendix A - Glossary
Appendix A - Glossary
ARP
Address Resolution Protocol. Broadcast protocol for mapping IP addresses to MAC addresses.
CHAP
Challenge-Handshake Authentication Protocol. Protocol for authenticating users to an ISP.
DDNS
Dynamic DNS. System for updating domain names in real time. Allows a domain name to be
assigned to a device with a dynamic IP address.
DHCP
Dynamic Host Coniguration Protocol. Protocol for allocating IP addresses dynamically so that
addresses can be reused when hosts no longer need them.
DNS
Domain Name System. Mechanism for translating H.323 IDs, URLs, or e-mail IDs into IP addresses.
Also used to assist in locating remote gatekeepers and to map IP addresses to hostnames of
administrative domains.
FQDN
Fully qualiied domain name. Complete domain name, including the host portion. Example:
serverA.companyA.com.
FTP
File Transfer Protocol. Protocol for transferring iles between network nodes.
HTTP
Hypertext Transfer Protocol. Protocol used by web browsers and web servers to transfer iles.
IKE
Internet Key Exchange. Mode for securely exchanging encryption keys in ISAKMP as part of
building a VPN tunnel.
IPsec
IP security. Suite of protocols for securing VPN tunnels by authenticating or encrypting IP packets
in a data stream. IPsec operates in either transport mode (encrypts payload but not packet
headers) or tunnel mode (encrypts both payload and packet headers).
ISAKMP
Internet Key Exchange Security Protocol. Protocol for establishing security associations and
cryptographic keys on the Internet.
ISP
Internet service provider.
MAC Address
Media-access-control address. Unique physical-address identiier attached to a network adapter.
MTU
Maximum transmission unit. Size, in bytes, of the largest packet that can be passed on. The MTU
for Ethernet is a 1500-byte packet.
NAT
Network Address Translation. Process of rewriting IP addresses as a packet passes through a
router or irewall. NAT enables multiple hosts on a LAN to access the Internet using the single
public IP address of the LAN’s gateway router.
NetBIOS
Microsoft Windows protocol for ile sharing, printer sharing, messaging, authentication, and
name resolution.
NTP
Network Time Protocol. Protocol for synchronizing a router to a single clock on the network,
known as the clock master.
PAP
Password Authentication Protocol. Protocol for authenticating users to a remote access server or
ISP.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
228
Appendix A - Glossary
PPPoE
Point-to-Point Protocol over Ethernet. Protocol for connecting a network of hosts to an ISP
without the ISP having to manage the allocation of IP addresses.
PPTP
Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol. Protocol for creation of VPNs for the secure transfer of data
from remote clients to private servers over the Internet.
RADIUS
Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service. Protocol for remote user authentication and
accounting. Provides centralized management of usernames and passwords.
RSA
Rivest-Shamir-Adleman. Public key encryption algorithm.
TCP
Transmission Control Protocol. Protocol for transmitting data over the Internet with guaranteed
reliability and in-order delivery.
UDP
User Data Protocol. Protocol for transmitting data over the Internet quickly but with no
guarantee of reliability or in-order delivery.
VPN
Virtual private network. Network that enables IP traic to travel securely over a public TCP/IP
network by encrypting all traic from one network to another. Uses tunneling to encrypt all
information at the IP level.
WINS
Windows Internet Name Service. Service for name resolution. Allows clients on diferent IP
subnets to dynamically resolve addresses, register themselves, and browse the network without
sending broadcasts.
XAUTH
IKE Extended Authentication. Method, based on the IKE protocol, for authenticating not just
devices (which IKE authenticates) but also users. User authentication is performed after device
authentication and before IPsec negotiation.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
229
Appendix B - Factory Default Settings
Appendix B - Factory Default Settings
Feature
Description
User Login URL
Default Settings
http://192.168.10.1
Device Login
User Name
admin
Password
admin
WAN MAC Address
Use default address
WAN MTU size
1500
Internet Connection
Local Area Network (LAN)
Firewall
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Port Speed
Autosense
IP Address
192.168.10.1
IPv4 Subnet Mask
255.255.255.0
RIP Direction
None
RIP Version
Disabled
RIP Authentication
Disabled
DHCP Server
Enabled
DHCP Starting IP Address
192.168.10.2
DHCP Ending IP Address
192.168.10.100
Time Zone
GMT
Daylight Saving Time
Disabled
SNMP
Disabled
Remote Management
Disabled
Inbound Communication from Internet
Disabled (except Port 80 HTTP)
Outbound Communication to Internet
Enabled (all)
Source MAC Filtering
Disabled
Stealth Mode
Enabled
230
Appendix C - Standard Services Available for Port Forwarding & Firewall Coniguration
Appendix C - Standard Services for Port
Forwarding & Firewall Coniguration
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
ANY
AIM
BGP
BOOTP_CLIENT
BOOTP_SERVER
CU-SEEME:UDP
CU-SEEME:TCP
DNS:UDP
DNS:TCP
FINGER
FTP
HTTP
HTTPS
ICMP-TYPE-3
ICMP-TYPE-4
ICMP-TYPE-5
ICMP-TYPE-6
ICMP-TYPE-7
ICMP-TYPE-8
ICMP-TYPE-9
ICMP-TYPE-10
ICMP-TYPE-11
ICMP-TYPE-13
ICQ
IMAP2
IMAP3
IRC
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
NEWS
NFS
NNTP
PING
POP3
PPTP
RCMD
REAL-AUDIO
REXEC
RLOGIN
RTELNET
RTSP:TCP
RTSP:UDP
SFTP
SMTP
SNMP:TCP
SNMP:UDP
SNMP-TRAPS:TCP
SNMP-TRAPS:UDP
SQL-NET
SSH:TCP
SSH:UDP
STRMWORKS
TACACS
TELNET
TFTP
VDOLIVE
231
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Facility: System (Networking)
Log Message
Severity
Log Message
Severity
DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
networkIntable.txt not found
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Interface is already deleted in bridge
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
removing %s from bridge %s... %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
adding %s to bridge %s... %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
stopping bridge...
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
stopping bridge...
DEBUG
failed to call ddns enable
ERROR
stopping bridge...
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Wan is not up
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
doDNS:failed
DEBUG
Illegal invocation of ddnsView (%s)
ERROR
doDNS:failed
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
doDNS:Result = FAILED
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
doDNS:Result SUCCESS
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
Write Old Entry: %s %s %s: to %s
DEBUG
Illegal operation interface got deleted
ERROR
Write New Entry: %s %s #%s : to %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Write Old Entry: %s %s %s: to %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Write New Entry: %s %s #%s : to %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
ifStaticMgmtDBUpdateHandler: returning
with “
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
nimfLinkStatusGet: bufer: \
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
DEBUG
Failed to call ddns enable
ERROR
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
DEBUG
Failed to call ddns enable
ERROR
nimfLinkStatusGetErr: returning with
status: %d
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: current Mac Option:
%d
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: current Port Speed
Option: %d
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: current Mtu Option:
%d
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
BridgeConig: too few arguments to
command %s
BridgeConig: too few arguments to
command %s
ERROR
ERROR
232
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: looks like we are
reconnecting. “
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: Mtu Size: %d
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: NIMF table is %s
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap:WAN_MODE
TRIGGER
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: MTU: %d
DEBUG
Failed to call ddns enable
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: old Mtu Flag: %d
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: user has changed
MTU option
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: MTU: %d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: old MTU size: %d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Setting LED [%d]:[%d] For %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
l2tpEnable: command string: %s
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: handling reboot
scenario
DEBUG
failed to call ddns enable
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: INDICATOR = %d
DEBUG
ddns: SQL error: %s
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: UpdateFlag: %d
DEBUG
ddnsDisable failed
ERROR
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: old Port Speed
Option: %d
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: old Mac Address
Option: %d
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: returning with
status: %s
nimfGetUpdateMacFlag: MacTable Flag
is: %d
Failed to open the resolv.conf ile.
Exiting./n
Could not write to the resolv.conf ile.
Exiting.
nimfMacGet: Mac Option changed
DEBUG
nimfMacGet: Update Flag: %d
DEBUG
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
Error opening the lanUptime File
ERROR
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
Error Opening the lanUptime File.
ERROR
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
failed to open %s
ERROR
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
failed to open %s
ERROR
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
failed to query networkInterface table
ERROR
nimfMacGet:Mac option Not changed \
DEBUG
failed to query networkInterface table
ERROR
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ERROR
ERROR
233
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
failed to enable IPv6 forwarding
ERROR
nimfMacGet: MacAddress: %s
DEBUG
failed to set capabilities on the “
ERROR
nimfMacGet: returning with status: %s
DEBUG
failed to enable IPv6 forwarding
ERROR
Now in enableing LanBridge function
DEBUG
failed to set capabilities on the “
ERROR
sucessfully executed the command %s
DEBUG
failed to disable IPv6 forwarding
ERROR
Now in disableing LanBridge function
DEBUG
failed to set capabilities on the “
ERROR
sucessfully executed the command %s
DEBUG
failed to open %s
ERROR
conigPortTblHandler:Now we are in
Sqlite Update “
DEBUG
Could not create ISATAP Tunnel
ERROR
The Old Coniguration of ConiPort
was:%s
DEBUG
Could not destroy ISATAP Tunnel
ERROR
The New Coniguration of ConiPort
was:%s
DEBUG
Could not conigure ISATAP Tunnel
ERROR
The user has deselected the conigurable
port
DEBUG
Could not de-conigure ISATAP Tunnel
ERROR
failed query %s
DEBUG
nimfStatusUpdate: updating
NimfStatus failed
ERROR
failed query %s
DEBUG
nimfStatusUpdate: updating
NimfStatus failed
ERROR
failed query %s
DEBUG
nimfLinkStatusGet: determinig link’s
status failed
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
nimfLinkStatusGet: opening status ile
failed
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
Failed to commit
ERROR
%s:%d SIP ENABLE: %s
DEBUG
ifStatusDBUpdate: Failed to begin “
ERROR
sipTblHandler:failed to update ifStatic
DEBUG
%s: SQL error: %s
ERROR
sipTblHandler:failed to update Conigport
DEBUG
%s: Failed to commit “
ERROR
%s:%d SIP DISABLE: %s
DEBUG
nimfNetIfaceTblHandler: unable to get
LedPinId
ERROR
%s:%d SIP SET CONF: %s
DEBUG
nimfNetIfaceTblHandler: unable to get
LedPinId
ERROR
Failed to open %s: %s
DEBUG
nimfNetIfaceTblHandler: unable to get
LedPinId
ERROR
Failed to start sipalg
DEBUG
%s: unable to kill dhclient
ERROR
Failed to stop sipalg
DEBUG
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: unable to get
current Mac Option
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
234
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: unable to get
current Port “
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: unable to get
current MTU Option
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: error getting
Mac Address from “
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: unable to get
the MTU
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: error setting
interface advanced “
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: error getting
MTU size
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: unable to get
Mac Address
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: error setting
interface advanced “
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: failed to get old
connectiontype
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: old connection
type is: %s
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: failed to get old
MTU Option
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: error getting
MTU size
nimfOldFieldValueGet: failed to get
old “
nimfOldFieldValueGet: user has
changed MTU size
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: failed to get old
Port Speed “
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: user has
changed Port Speed
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: failed to get old
Mac Address “
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: user has
changed Mac Address “
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: unable to get
Mac Address
nimfAdvOptSetWrap:Failed to RESET
the lag
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: setting
advanced options failed
nimfAdvOptSetWrap: interface
advanced options applied
nimfGetUpdateMacFlag: unable to get
Flag from MacTable
nimfMacGet: Updating MAC address
failed
Failed to get conig info
DEBUG
Network Mask: 0x%x
DEBUG
RTP DSCP Value: 0x%x
DEBUG
Need more arguments
DEBUG
Invalid lanaddr
DEBUG
Invalid lanmask
DEBUG
Invalid option
DEBUG
Failed to set conig info
DEBUG
Unknown option
DEBUG
sshdTblHandler
DEBUG
pPort: %s
DEBUG
pProtocol: %s
DEBUG
pListerAddr: %s
DEBUG
pKeyBits: %s
DEBUG
pRootEnable: %s
DEBUG
pRsaEnable: %s
DEBUG
pDsaEnable: %s
DEBUG
pPassEnable: %s
DEBUG
pEmptyPassEnable: %s
DEBUG
pSftpEnable: %s
DEBUG
pScpEnable: %s
DEBUG
pSshdEnable: %s
DEBUG
pPrivSep: %s
DEBUG
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
Re-Starting sshd daemon....
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
sshd re-started successfully.
DEBUG
error executing the command %s
ERROR
sshd stopped .
DEBUG
error executing the command %s
ERROR
failed query %s
DEBUG
error executing the command %s
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
235
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
vlan disabled, not applying vlan
coniguration..
DEBUG
disableLan function is failed to disable
ConigPort”
ERROR
failed query %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
failed query %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
no ports present in this vlanId %d
DEBUG
Unable to Disable conigurable port
from
ERROR
failed query %s
DEBUG
conigPortTblHandler has failed
ERROR
vlan disabled, not applying vlan
coniguration..
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
disabling vlan
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
enabling vlan
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
vlan disabled, not applying vlan
coniguration..
DEBUG
no ports present in this vlanId %d
DEBUG
failed query %s
DEBUG
vlan disabled, not applying vlan
coniguration..
DEBUG
removing %s from bridge%s... %s
DEBUG
adding %s to bridge%d... %s
DEBUG
restarting bridge...
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
[switchConig] Ignoring event on port
number %d
DEBUG
sqlite3_mprintf failed
ERROR
restarting bridge...
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
executing %s ... %s
DEBUG
removing %s from bridge%s... %s
DEBUG
adding %s to bridge%d... %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
[switchConig] Ignoring event on %s
DEBUG
Could not get all the required variables
to email the Logs.
ERROR
restarting bridge...
DEBUG
runSmtpClient failed
ERROR
[switchConig] Ignoring event on port
number %d
DEBUG
getaddrinfo returned %s
ERROR
[switchConig] executing %s ... %s
DEBUG
ile not found
ERROR
restarting bridge...
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
UserName: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Password: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
IspName: %s
DEBUG
No memory to allocate
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Failed to execute switchConig for
port\
Failed to execute switchConig for port
enable
Failed to execute ifconig for port
enable
Failed to execute ethtool for\
Failed to execute switchConig for port
disable
Failed to execute ifconig for port
disable
Failed to execute switchConig for port
mirroring
Usage:%s  
 
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
236
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
DialNumber: %s
DEBUG
Failed to Open SSHD Coniguration File
ERROR
Apn: %s
DEBUG
Ipaddress should be provided with
accessoption 1
ERROR
GetDnsFromIsp: %s
DEBUG
Subnetaddress should be provided
with accessoption 2
ERROR
IdleTimeOutFlag: %s
DEBUG
Failed to restart sshd
ERROR
IdleTimeOutValue: %d
DEBUG
unable to open the “
ERROR
AuthMetho: %d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
executing %s ... %s
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
removing %s from bridge%d... %s
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
adding %s to bridge%d... %s
DEBUG
unknown vlan state
ERROR
stopping bridge...
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
vlanId %d
ERROR
restarting bridge...
DEBUG
sqlite3_mprintf failed
ERROR
Could not conigure 6to4 Tunnel Interface
DEBUG
Access port can be present only in
single vlan
ERROR
Could not de-conigure 6to4 Tunnel
Interface
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
vlanId %d
ERROR
failed to restart 6to4 tunnel interfaces
DEBUG
unknown vlan state
ERROR
BridgeConig: too few arguments to
command %s
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
port number %d
ERROR
BridgeConig: unsupported command %d
DEBUG
Failed to clear vlan for oldPVID %d
ERROR
BridgeConig returned error=%d
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
port number %d
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
DEBUG
Failed to clear vlan for %d
ERROR
Error in executing DB update handler
DEBUG
Failed to set vlan entry for vlan %d
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
DEBUG
Failed to set vlan entries, while
enabling \
ERROR
Failed to remove vlan Interface for vlanId \
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
port number %d
ERROR
Invalid oidp passed
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
vlanId %d
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
237
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Invalid oidp passed
DEBUG
Failed to enable vlan
ERROR
Failed to get oid from the tree
DEBUG
Failed to disable vlan
ERROR
threegEnable: Input to wrapper %s
DEBUG
Failed to set vlanPort table entries,
while \
ERROR
threegEnable: spawning command %s
DEBUG
Failed to enable vlan
ERROR
threegMgmtHandler: query string: %s
DEBUG
unknown vlan state
ERROR
threegMgmtHandler: returning with
status: %s
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
adding to dhcprealy ifgroup failed
DEBUG
unknown vlan state
ERROR
adding to ipset fwDhcpRelay failed
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
vlanId %d
ERROR
DEBUG
sqlite3_mprintf failed
ERROR
Disabling Firewall Rule for DHCP Relay
Protocol
Enabling Firewall Rule for DHCP Relay
Protocol
prerouting Firewall Rule add for Relay
failed
prerouting Firewall Rule add for Relay
failed
DEBUG
DEBUG
Access port can be present only in
single vlan
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
vlanId %d
ERROR
ERROR
DEBUG
unknown vlan state
ERROR
%s: SQL get query: %s
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
port number %d
ERROR
%s: sqlite3QueryResGet failed
DEBUG
Failed to clear vlan for oldPVID %d
ERROR
%s: no result found
DEBUG
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
port number %d
ERROR
%s: bufer overlow
DEBUG
Failed to clear vlan for %d
ERROR
%s: value of %s in %s table is: %s
DEBUG
Failed to set vlan entry for vlan %d
ERROR
%s: returning with status: %s
DEBUG
dnsResolverConigure: addressFamily: %d
DEBUG
dnsResolverConigure: LogicalIfName: %s
DEBUG
chap-secrets File found
DEBUG
Failed to enable vlan
ERROR
PID File for xl2tpd found
DEBUG
Failed to disable vlan
ERROR
pid: %d
DEBUG
Failed to set vlanPort table entries,
while \
ERROR
options.xl2tpd ile found
DEBUG
Failed to enable vlan
ERROR
options.xl2tpd ile not found
DEBUG
unknown vlan state
ERROR
Conf File for xl2tpd found
DEBUG
xl2tpd.conf not found
DEBUG
Chap Secrets ile found
DEBUG
threegEnable:spawning failed
ERROR
Chap Secrets ile not found
DEBUG
threegDisable: unable to kill ppp
daemon
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
threegMgmtHandler: Query: %s
ERROR
chap-secrets File found
DEBUG
threegMgmtHandler: error in
executing database update
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Failed to set vlan entries, while
enabling \
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
port number %d
Failed to execute vlanConig binary for
vlanId %d
threegMgmtInit: unable to open the
database ile %s
threegConnEnable: failed to get the
WanMode
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
238
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
PID File for pptpd found
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
pid: %d
DEBUG
are we getting invoked twice ??
ERROR
PID File for pptpd interface found
DEBUG
could not open %s to append
ERROR
pid: %d
DEBUG
could not write nameserver %s to %s
ERROR
options.pptpd ile found
DEBUG
could not write nameserver %s to %s
ERROR
options.pptpd ile not found
DEBUG
could not open %s to truncate
ERROR
Conf File for pptpd found
DEBUG
pptpd.conf not found
DEBUG
Chap Secrets ile found
DEBUG
could not conigure DNS resolver
ERROR
Chap Secrets ile not found
DEBUG
dnsResolverConigure: could not write
nameserver:%s,”
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
unboundMgmt: unable to open the “
ERROR
chap-secrets File found
DEBUG
ioctl call Failed-could not update
active user Details
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: MtuFlag: %d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: Mtu: %d
DEBUG
Can’t kill xl2tpd
ERROR
DEBUG
xl2tpd restart failed
ERROR
DEBUG
failed to get ield value
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: UserName: %s
DEBUG
failed to get ield value
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: Password: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: DNS speciied:
%s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: Service: %s
DEBUG
unboundMgmt: unable to open the “
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: StaticIp: %s
DEBUG
writing options.xl2tpd failed
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: NetMask: %s
DEBUG
xl2tpdStop failed
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: AuthOpt: %d
DEBUG
writing xl2tpd.conf failed
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: Satus: %d
DEBUG
writing options.xl2tpd failed
ERROR
pppoeEnable: ppp dial string: %s
DEBUG
xl2tpdStop failed
ERROR
pppoeMgmtDBUpdateHandler: returning
with status: %s
DEBUG
xl2tpdStart failed
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: MtuFlag: %d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: Mtu: %d
DEBUG
writing Chap-secrets/Pap-Secrets
failed
ERROR
DEBUG
xl2tpdStop failed
ERROR
DEBUG
xl2tpdStart failed
ERROR
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: IdleTimeOutFlag:
%d
pppoeMgmtTblHandler:
IdleTimeOutValue: %d
pptpMgmtTblHandler: IdleTimeOutFlag:
%d
pptpMgmtTblHandler: IdleTimeOutValue:
%d
pptpMgmtTblHandler: GetDnsFromIsp:
%d
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
dnsResolverConigMgmtInit: unable to
open the “
resolverConigDBUpateHandler:
sqlite3QueryResGet “
ERROR
ERROR
239
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
pptpMgmtTblHandler: UserName: %s
DEBUG
writing Chap-secrets/Pap-Secrets
failed
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: Password: %s
DEBUG
xl2tpdStop failed
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: dynamic MyIp
conigured
DEBUG
xl2tpdStart failed
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: MyIp: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: ServerIp: %s
DEBUG
writing Chap-secrets/Pap-Secrets
failed
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: StaticIp: %s
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: NetMask: %s
DEBUG
unboundMgmt: unable to open the “
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler:
MppeEncryptSupport: %s
DEBUG
Can’t kill pptpd
ERROR
pptpMgmtTblHandler: SplitTunnel: %s
DEBUG
pptpd restart failed
ERROR
pptpEnable: ppp dial string: %s
DEBUG
Can’t kill pptpd
ERROR
pptpEnable: spawning command %s
DEBUG
failed to get ield value
ERROR
PID File for dhcpc found
DEBUG
failed to get ield value
ERROR
pid: %d
DEBUG
unboundMgmt: unable to open the “
ERROR
pptpMgmtDBUpdateHandler: query
string: %s
DEBUG
writing options.pptpd failed
ERROR
pptpMgmtDBUpdateHandler: returning
with status: %s
DEBUG
pptpdStop failed
ERROR
dhcpcReleaseLease: dhcpc release
command: %s
DEBUG
writing pptpd.conf failed
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtTblHandler: MtuFlag: %d
DEBUG
writing options.pptpd failed
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtTblHandler: Mtu: %d
DEBUG
pptpdStop failed
ERROR
DHCPv6 Server started successfully.
DEBUG
pptpdStart failed
ERROR
DHCPv6 Server stopped successfully
DEBUG
writing Chap-secrets/Pap-Secrets
failed
ERROR
DHCPv6 Client started successfully.
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
DHCPv6 Client stopped successfully.
DEBUG
pppStatsUpdate: unable to get default
MTU
ERROR
DHCPv6 Client Restart successful
DEBUG
pppoeMgmtInit: unable to open the
database ile %s
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: MtuFlag: %d
DEBUG
pppoeDisable: unable to kill ppp
daemon
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
240
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: Mtu: %d
DEBUG
pppoeMultipleEnableDisable: pppoe
enable failed
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: IspName: %s
DEBUG
pppoeMultipleEnableDisable: pppoe
disable failed
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: UserName: %s
DEBUG
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: unable to get
current Mtu Option
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: Password: %s
DEBUG
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: unable to get
the Mtu
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: AccountName: %s
DEBUG
pppoeMgmtTblHandler: pppoe enable
failed
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: DomainName: %s
DEBUG
pppoeMgmtDBUpdateHandler: failed
query: %s
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: Secret: not speciied
DEBUG
pppoeMgmtDBUpdateHandler: error
in executing “
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: Secret: %s
DEBUG
pptpMgmtInit: unable to open the
database ile %s
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: dynamic MyIp
conigured
DEBUG
pptpEnable: error executing
command: %s
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: MyIp: %s
DEBUG
pptpEnable: unable to resolve address:
%s
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: ServerIp: %s
DEBUG
pptpEnable: inet_aton failed
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: StaticIp: %s
DEBUG
pptpEnable: inet_aton failed
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: NetMask: %s
DEBUG
pptpEnable:spawning failed
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: SplitTunnel: %s
DEBUG
pptpDisable: unable to kill ppp
daemon
ERROR
needToStartHealthMonitor: returning
with status: %s
DEBUG
pptpMgmtTblHandler: unable to get
current MTU Option
ERROR
l2tpEnable: command string: %s
DEBUG
pptpMgmtTblHandler: unable to get
the Mtu
ERROR
l2tpEnable: command: %s
DEBUG
pptpMgmtTblHandler:
dbRecordValueGet failed for %s “
ERROR
l2tpEnable: command string: %s
DEBUG
pptpMgmtTblHandler: pptp enable
failed
ERROR
PID File for dhcpc found
DEBUG
pptpMgmtTblHandler: pptp disable
failed
ERROR
pid: %d
DEBUG
pptpMgmtDBUpdateHandler:
sqlite3QueryResGet “
ERROR
l2tpMgmtDBUpdateHandler: query string:
%s
DEBUG
pptpMgmtDBUpdateHandler: error in
executing “
ERROR
l2tpMgmtDBUpdateHandler: returning
with status: %s
DEBUG
Illegal invocation of dhcpConig (%s)
ERROR
RADVD started successfully
DEBUG
dhcpLibInit: unable to open the
database ile %s
ERROR
RADVD stopped successfully
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
empty update. nRows=%d nCols=%d
WARN
dhcpcMgmtInit: unable to open the
database ile %s
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
241
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Wan is not up or in load balencing mode
WARN
dhcpcReleaseLease: unable to release
lease
ERROR
threegMgmtHandler: no row found.
nRows = %d nCols = %d
WARN
dhcpcEnable: unable to kill dhclient
ERROR
pppoeMgmtDBUpdateHandler: empty
update.
WARN
dhcpcEnable: enabling dhcpc failed
on: %s
ERROR
dhcpcEnable: dhclient already running
on: %s
WARN
dhcpcDisable: unable to kill dhclient
ERROR
dhcpcDisable: deleted dhclient.leases
WARN
dhcpcDisable: delete failed for
dhclient.leases
ERROR
l2tpMgmtInit: unable to open the
database ile %s
ERROR
dhcpcDisable: failed to reset the ip
ERROR
l2tpEnable: unable to resolve address: %s
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtTblHandler: unable to get
current Mtu Option
ERROR
l2tpEnable: inet_aton failed
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtTblHandler: unable to get
the Mtu
ERROR
The Enable Command is %s
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtTblHandler: dhclient
enable failed
ERROR
l2tpEnable:Executing the Command failed
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtTblHandler: dhcpc release
failed
ERROR
l2tpDisable: command string: %s
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtTblHandler: dhcpc disable
failed
ERROR
l2tpDisable: unable to stop l2tp session
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtDBUpdateHandler: failed
query: %s
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: unable to get
current MTU option
ERROR
dhcpcMgmtDBUpdateHandler: error in
executing “
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: unable to get the
Mtu
ERROR
DHCPv6 Client start failed.
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: dbRecordValueGet
failed for %s “
ERROR
DHCPv6 Client stop failed.
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: l2tpEnable failed
ERROR
failed to create/open DHCPv6 client “
ERROR
l2tpMgmtTblHandler: disabling l2tp failed
ERROR
failed to write DHCPv6 client
coniguration ile
ERROR
l2tpMgmtDBUpdateHandler:
sqlite3QueryResGet “
ERROR
failed to restart DHCPv6 Client
ERROR
l2tpMgmtDBUpdateHandler: error in
executing
ERROR
failed to create/open DHCPv6 Server “
ERROR
Illegal invocation of tcpdumpConig (%s)
ERROR
Restoring old coniguration..
ERROR
Failed to start tcpdump
ERROR
DHCPv6 Server coniguration update
failed
ERROR
Failed to stop tcpdump
ERROR
DHCPv6 Server Restart failed
ERROR
Invalid tcpdumpEnable value
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
242
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Facility: System (VPN)
Log Message
Severity
Log Message
Severity
%d command not supported by eapAuth
DEBUG
PEAP key derive: ERROR
ERROR
pCtx NULL.
DEBUG
PEAP context is NULL: ERROR
ERROR
Current cert subject name= %s
DEBUG
Constructing P2 response: ERROR
ERROR
X509_STORE_CTX_get_ex_data failed.
DEBUG
innerEapRecv is NULL: ERROR
ERROR
Cannot get cipher, no session est.
DEBUG
Decrypting TLS data: ERROR
ERROR
%s: SSL_ERROR_WANT_X509_LOOKUP
DEBUG
Wrong identity size: ERROR
ERROR
err code = (%d) in %s
DEBUG
Wrong size for extensions packet:
ERROR
ERROR
BIO_write: Error
DEBUG
innerEapRecv is NULL: ERROR.
ERROR
Decrypting: BIO reset failed
DEBUG
Inner EAP processing: ERROR
ERROR
Encrypting BIO reset: ERROR
DEBUG
TLS handshake: ERROR.
ERROR
BIO_read: Error
DEBUG
Sending P1 response: ERROR
ERROR
DEBUG
Unexpected tlsGlueContinue return
value.
ERROR
DEBUG
No more fragments in message. ERROR
ERROR
EAP state machine changed from %s to
%s.
EAP state machine changed from %s to
%s.
No phase 2 data or phase 2 data bufer
NULL: ERROR
Allocating memory for PEAP Phase 2
payload: ERROR
Received EAP Packet with code %d
DEBUG
Response ID %d
DEBUG
Response Method %d
DEBUG
Created EAP/PEAP context: OK
DEBUG
Deleted EAP/PEAP context: OK
DEBUG
Upper EAP sent us: decision = %d method
state = %d
DEBUG
Setting last fragment: ERROR
ERROR
P2 decision=(%d); methodState=(%d)
DEBUG
Getting message: ERROR
ERROR
Writing message to BIO: ERROR.
DEBUG
Processing PEAP message: ERROR
ERROR
Encrypted (%d) bytes for P2
DEBUG
Setting fragment: ERROR
ERROR
P2: sending fragment.
DEBUG
Creating receive bufer: ERROR
ERROR
P2: message size = %d
DEBUG
Setting irst fragment: ERROR
ERROR
P2: sending unfragmented message.
DEBUG
Sending P1 response: ERROR
ERROR
P1: Sending fragment.
DEBUG
P1: Total TLS message size = (%d)
DEBUG
P1: sending unfragmented message.
DEBUG
Protocol version mismatch: ERROR
ERROR
peapFragFirstProcess: TLS record size to
receive = (%d)
DEBUG
Processing PEAP message (from frag):
ERROR
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
TLS encrypting response: ERROR
Setting message in fragment bufer:
ERROR
Allocating TLS read bufer is NULL:
ERROR
NULL request (or response) PDU or
NULL context: ERROR
Expecting start packet, got something
else: ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
243
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Setting version %d
DEBUG
Processing PEAP message: ERROR
ERROR
PEAP pkt rcvd: data len=(%d) lags=(%d)
version=(%d)
DEBUG
Processing PEAP message: ERROR
ERROR
Got PEAP/Start packet.
DEBUG
Indicated length not valid: ERROR
ERROR
Got irst fragment
DEBUG
Did not get Acknowledged result:
ERROR
ERROR
Got fragment (n)
DEBUG
Cannot understand AVP value: ERROR
ERROR
Got last fragment
DEBUG
eapExtResp is NULL: ERROR
ERROR
Got unfragmented message
DEBUG
Got frag ack.
DEBUG
eapWscCtxCreate: EAPAUTH_MALLOC
failed.
eapWscProcess: umiIoctl req to WSC
failed, status = %d
ERROR
ERROR
Ext AVP parsed: lags=(0x%x)
DEBUG
eapWscCheck: Invalid frame
ERROR
Mandatory bit not set: WARNING
DEBUG
eapWscBuildReq: Invalid state %d
ERROR
Ext AVP parsed: type=(%d)
DEBUG
Ext AVP parsed: value=(%d)
DEBUG
eapWscProcessWscResp: Invalid data
recd pData = %p, dataLen”
Data received for invalid context,
dropping it
eapWscProcessWscResp: Build Request
failed
eapWscProcessWscResp: Invalid state
%d
eapWscProcessWscResp: Message
processing failed 0x%X
eapWscProcessWscData: Invalid
notiication recd %d
ERROR
ERROR
Got PEAPv0 success!
DEBUG
Got PEAPv0 failure!
DEBUG
pCtx NULL.
DEBUG
Authenticator response check: Error
DEBUG
Authenticator response check: Failed
DEBUG
unable to initialize MD5
ERROR
MS-CHAP2 Response AVP size = %u
DEBUG
MDString: adpDigestInit for md5 failed
ERROR
Created EAP/MS-CHAP2 context: OK.
DEBUG
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
pCtx NULL.
DEBUG
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
Deleted EAP/MS-CHAPv2 context: OK
DEBUG
NULL context created: Error
ERROR
Not authenticated yet.
DEBUG
NULL context received: Error
ERROR
Authenticator response invalid
DEBUG
Authenticator ident invalid.
ERROR
EAP-MS-CHAPv2 password changed.
DEBUG
Success request message invalid: Error
ERROR
rcvd. opCode %d.
DEBUG
Plugin context is NULL
ERROR
pCtx NULL.
DEBUG
Deriving implicit challenge: Error
ERROR
DEBUG
Generating NT response: Error
ERROR
DEBUG
NULL in/out bufer: Error
ERROR
TLS handshake successful.
DEBUG
Incorrect vendor id.
ERROR
Created EAP/TTLS context: OK
DEBUG
Allocating memory for outBuf: ERROR
ERROR
TLS message len changed in the fragment,
ignoring.
no data to send while fragment ack
received.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
244
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Deleted EAP/TTLS context: OK
DEBUG
AVP code not recognized
ERROR
No more fragments in message. ERROR
DEBUG
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
Upper EAP sent us: method state = %d;
decision = %d
DEBUG
Converting password to unicode: Error
ERROR
P2: sending fragment.
DEBUG
Generating password hash: Error.
ERROR
P2 send unfragmented message.
DEBUG
Generating password hash hash: Error.
ERROR
P1: sending fragment.
DEBUG
Generating master key: Error.
ERROR
P1: sending unfragmented message.
DEBUG
\tTLSMsgLen = 0x%x
DEBUG
Send req ptr = 0x%x; Send resp ptr = 0x%x
DEBUG
Converting password to unicode: Error
ERROR
P2 decision=(%d); methodState=(%d)
DEBUG
Constructing failure response: ERROR
ERROR
Default EAP: method state = %d; decision
= %d
DEBUG
Error checking authenticator response.
ERROR
TTLS pkt: data len=(%d) lags=(0x%x)
DEBUG
Error generating NT response.
ERROR
Got start
DEBUG
Username string more than 256 ASCII
characters: ERROR
ERROR
Got irst fragment (n).
DEBUG
Invalid Value-Size.
ERROR
Got fragment (n).
DEBUG
Invalid MS-Length. Got (%d), expected
(%d)
ERROR
Got last fragment
DEBUG
Error constructing response.
ERROR
Got unfragmented message.
DEBUG
Got type (%d), expecting (%d)
ERROR
Got frag ack.
DEBUG
Cannot handle message; opCode = %d
ERROR
DEBUG
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
DEBUG
tlsGlueCtxCreate failed.
ERROR
DEBUG
client certiicate must be set in the
proile.
ERROR
AVP length extract: Error
DEBUG
received TLS message length too big.
ERROR
pFB is NULL
DEBUG
total frags len > initial total TLS length.
ERROR
Requesting message before assembly
complete
DEBUG
total frags len > initial total TLS length.
ERROR
pFB is NULL
DEBUG
total data rcvd(%d) doesnt match the
initial “
ERROR
pFB is NULL
DEBUG
couldnt write %d data to TLS bufer.
ERROR
Bufer cannot hold message: ERROR
DEBUG
invalid lags %s passed to
eapTlsBuildResp.
ERROR
pFB is NULL: Error
DEBUG
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
pFB is NULL
DEBUG
tlsGlueCtxCreate failed.
ERROR
TLS_FB* is NULL.
DEBUG
Context NULL: ERROR
ERROR
pFB->msgBuf is NULL.
DEBUG
Setting proile to glue layer: ERROR.
ERROR
Error calculating binary.
DEBUG
_eapCtxCreate failed.
ERROR
Rcvd. AVP Code-%u: lags-0x%x: len-%u:
vendorId-%u: “
MOD EAP: method state from upper = %d;
decision = %d
Got AVP len = %ul. Should be less than
16777215
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Generating irst 16 bytes of session key:
Error.n
Generating second 16 bytes of session
key: Error.n
ERROR
ERROR
245
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
%d authentication not enabled in the
system.
Initializing inner non-EAP auth plugin:
ERROR
Error calculating binary.
DEBUG
adpDigestInit for SHA1 failed.
DEBUG
adpDigestInit for SHA1 failed.
DEBUG
E = %d
DEBUG
R = %d
DEBUG
Could not initialize des-ecb
DEBUG
adpDigestInit for MD4 failed.
DEBUG
adpDigestInit for SHA1 failed.
DEBUG
adpDigestInit for SHA1 failed.
DEBUG
innerEapRecv is NULL: ERROR.
ERROR
Error converting received auth reponse
to bin.
DEBUG
Decrypting TLS data: ERROR
ERROR
Gnerating challenge hash: Error
DEBUG
Processing Phase 2 method: Error
ERROR
Generating password hash: Error
DEBUG
Writing message to BIO: ERROR.
ERROR
Generating challenge response: Error
DEBUG
TLS handshake: ERROR.
ERROR
Conn cipher name=%s ver=%s: %s
DEBUG
Send req ptr = 0x%x; Send resp ptr = 0x%x
DEBUG
Request ptr = 0x%x;
DEBUG
Protocol version mismatch: ERROR
ERROR
Response ptr = 0x%x
DEBUG
Creating receive bufer: ERROR
ERROR
Rcvd. AVP Code - %ul
DEBUG
Setting irst fragment: ERROR
ERROR
Rcvd. AVP lags - 0x%02x
DEBUG
Setting fragment: ERROR
ERROR
Rcvd. AVP len - %ul
DEBUG
Setting last fragment: ERROR
ERROR
Rcvd. AVP vendor id - %ul
DEBUG
Getting message: ERROR
ERROR
\tCode = %d
DEBUG
Processing TTLS message: ERROR
ERROR
\tIdent = %d
DEBUG
Processing TTLS message: ERROR
ERROR
\tLen = %d
DEBUG
Processing TTLS message: ERROR
ERROR
\tType = %d
DEBUG
Decapsulating AVP: ERROR
ERROR
\tOpCode = %d
DEBUG
Processing EAP receive: Error
ERROR
\tMSID = %d
DEBUG
AVP code not EAP: Error
ERROR
\tmsLen = %d
DEBUG
Encapsulating AVP: ERROR
ERROR
\tvalSize = %d
DEBUG
proile %s doesnt exist.
ERROR
Frag Bufer bytes left = (%d)
DEBUG
proile %s is in use.
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
TTLS key derive: ERROR
TTLS context from EAP plugin is NULL:
ERROR
Allocating memory for TTLS Phase 2
payload: ERROR
TLS Encrypting response: ERROR
Allocating TLS read bufer is NULL:
ERROR
Inner authentication (id: %d)
unhandled
Unexpected tlsGlueContinue return
value.
NULL request (or response) PDU or
NULL context
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
246
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Stripped username=(%s)
DEBUG
proile %s already exists.
ERROR
digestLen = %d.
DEBUG
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed
ERROR
ClearText =
DEBUG
User not found.
ERROR
CipherText =
DEBUG
EAP-MD5 not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
digestLen = %d.
DEBUG
EAP-MSCHAPV2 not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
digestLen1 = %d.
DEBUG
EAP-TLS not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
digestLen2 = %d.
DEBUG
EAP-TTLS not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
password change is not allowed for this
user
DEBUG
EAP-PEAP not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
completed writing the policy
DEBUG
EAP-WSC not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
completed writing the SA
DEBUG
PAP not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
completed writing the proposal block
DEBUG
CHAP not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
cmdBuf: %s
DEBUG
MSCHAP not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
X509_DEBUG : Invalid Certiicate for the
generated”
DEBUG
MSCHAPV2 not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
X590_ERROR : Failed to create File ‘%s’
DEBUG
PAP/Token not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
x509TblHandler
DEBUG
EAP-MD5 not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
pCertType: %s
DEBUG
EAP-MSCHAPV2 not enabled in system
conig.
ERROR
pRowQueryStr: %s
DEBUG
EAP-TLS not enabled in system
coniguration.
ERROR
x509SelfCertTblHandler
DEBUG
EAP-TTLS and EAP-PEAP are not valid
as inner”
ERROR
pRowQueryStr: %s
DEBUG
invalid innerAuth %d.
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
proile %s doesnt exist.
ERROR
umiRegister failed
ERROR
Re-assembling fragments incorrect size
ERROR
eapAuthHandler: Invalid data received
ERROR
Error creating cipher context.
ERROR
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
Error initializing cipher context.
ERROR
malloc failed.
ERROR
Error creating digest context.
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
247
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
BIO_new_mem_buf failed.
ERROR
Error initializing digest context.
ERROR
malloc failed.
ERROR
Error initializing DES in Klite
ERROR
BIO_new_mem_buf failed.
ERROR
Error initializing MD4 in Klite
ERROR
ERROR
Error initializing RC4 in Klite
ERROR
ERROR
Error initializing SHA in Klite
ERROR
ERROR
Error cleaning cipher context.
ERROR
ERROR
Error destroying cipher context.
ERROR
ERROR
Error cleaning digest context.
ERROR
SSL_CTX_use_PrivateKey_ile failed.
ERROR
Error destroying digest context.
ERROR
private key does not match public key
ERROR
Error stripping domain name.
ERROR
SSL_CTX_load_verify_locations failed
ERROR
Error cleaning digest context.
ERROR
SSL_new failed.
ERROR
Error cleaning digest context.
ERROR
Both SSL_VERIFY_PEER and SSL_VERIFY_
NONE set: Error
ERROR
Challenge not present in failure packet.
ERROR
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
Wrong challenge length.
ERROR
EAPAUTH_MALLOC failed.
ERROR
Incorrect password change version
value.
ERROR
eapTimerCreate failed.
ERROR
Error generating password hash.
ERROR
eapCtxDelete:pCtx == NULL
ERROR
Error generating password hash.
ERROR
eapRole != EAP_ROLE_PEER or EAP_ROLE_
AUTHENTICATOR
ERROR
Error encrypting password hash with
block
ERROR
pEapCtx == NULL or pPDU == NULL.
ERROR
Could not initialize des-ecb
ERROR
ERROR
Error cleaning cipher context.
ERROR
ERROR
Error cleaning cipher context.
ERROR
state machine is in invalid state.
ERROR
Error cleaning digest context.
ERROR
unable to create method context.
ERROR
Error cleaning digest context.
ERROR
method ctxCreate failed.
ERROR
adpDigestInit for SHA1 failed.
ERROR
method proile set failed.
ERROR
X509_ERROR : .Query:%s
ERROR
state machine is in invalid state.
ERROR
X509_ERROR : Invalid Certiicate for
the “
ERROR
Only StandAlone authenticator supported
currently.
ERROR
invalid x509 certiicate
ERROR
state machine is in invalid state.
ERROR
Couldn’t get the x509 cert hash
ERROR
BuildReq operation failed
ERROR
Memory allocation failed
ERROR
No method ops deined for current
method
ERROR
FileName too lengthy
ERROR
SSL_CTX_new (TLSv1_client_method)
failed.
unable to set user conigured CIPHER list
%s
Certiicate veriication failed.
Server name match failed. Got (%s)
expected “
SSL_CTX_use_certiicate_ile (cert, PEM)
failed.
received EAP pdu bigger than EAP_MTU_
SIZE.
received EAP pdu bigger than EAP_MTU_
SIZE.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
248
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Process operation failed
ERROR
Couldn’t execute command
ERROR
state machine is in invalid state.
ERROR
Memory allocation failed
ERROR
Packet length mismatch %d, %d
ERROR
Memory allocation failed
ERROR
eapAuthTypeToType: Invalid eapAuthType
%d
ERROR
invalid certiicate data
ERROR
eapTypeToAuthType: Invalid eapType %d
ERROR
.Query:%s
ERROR
unable to create method context.
ERROR
.Query:%s
ERROR
method ctxCreate failed.
ERROR
Memory allocation failed
ERROR
Invalid condition, methodState = %d,
respMethod = %d
ERROR
X509_ERROR : Failed to validate the
certicate “
ERROR
A EAP Ctx map already exists
ERROR
Memory allocation failed
ERROR
ERROR
.Query:%s
ERROR
ERROR
Invalid Sign Key Length : %d
ERROR
ERROR
Invalid Hash Alg : %d
ERROR
ERROR
Invalid Sign Alg : %d
ERROR
ERROR
No Memory Available
ERROR
pCtx is NULL: ERROR
ERROR
Certiicate Request Failed
ERROR
tlsGlueCtxCreate failed
ERROR
File Open Failed
ERROR
eapVars is NULL
ERROR
File is Empty
ERROR
Context NULL: ERROR
ERROR
Memory Allocation Failed
ERROR
Initializing inner EAP auth: ERROR
ERROR
File Open Failed
ERROR
pCtx is NULL: ERROR
ERROR
File is Empty
ERROR
Memory Allocation Failed
ERROR
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
eapTimerCreate: Currently unsupported
for Peer role
eapTimerStart: Currently unsupported for
Peer role
eapTimerDestroy: Currently unsupported
for Peer role
eapTimerCancel: Currently unsupported
for Peer role
eapTimerHandler: Currently unsupported
for Peer role
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
249
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Facility: System (Admin)
Log Message
Severity
Log Message
Severity
Usage:%s 
DEBUG
unable to register to UMI
ERROR
Could not open database: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
CPU LOG File not found
DEBUG
radSendtoServer: socket: %s
ERROR
MEM LOG File not found
DEBUG
radSendtoServer: bind() Failed: %s: %s
ERROR
cpuMemUsageDBUpdateHandler: update
query: %s
DEBUG
Printing the whole list after inserting
DEBUG
%s at %d(minute) %d(hour)
%d(dayOfMonth) %d(month)”
DEBUG
adpCmdExec exited with return code=%d
DEBUG
%s op=%d row=%d
DEBUG
sqlite3_mprintf failed
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed: query=%s
DEBUG
Printing the whole list after delete
DEBUG
%s at %d(minute) %d(hour)
%d(dayOfMonth) %d(month)”
DEBUG
Printing the whole list after inserting
DEBUG
%s at %d(minute) %d(hour)
%d(dayOfMonth) %d(month)”
DEBUG
email logs: No logging events enabled
DEBUG
%s
DEBUG
Mail sent and the Database is reset.
DEBUG
Disabled syslog server
DEBUG
Event logs are full, sending logs to email
DEBUG
Email logs sending failed
DEBUG
Packing attribute: %s
DEBUG
Server found: %s, secret: %s
DEBUG
Packed Auth. Reqest: code:%d, id:%d,
len:%d
DEBUG
Sending Packet to %x:%d ....
DEBUG
Receiving Reply Packet....
DEBUG
Veriied Reply Packet Integrity
DEBUG
Generated Reply Attribute-Value pairs
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
radRecvfromServer: recvfrom() Failed:
%s
radRecvfromServer: Packet too small
from %s:%d: %s
radCheckMsgAuth: Invalid MessageAuthenticator length in”
radDictLoad: couldn’t open dictionary
%s: %s
radBuildAndSendReq: Invalid Request
Code %d
radPairAssign: bad attribute value
length
radPairAssign: unknown attribute type
%d
radPairNew: unknown attribute %d
radPairGen: Attribute(%d) has invalid
length
radPairValue: unknown attribute type
%d
radPairValueLen: unknown attribute
type %d
radPairLocate: Attribute(%d) has
invalid length
radPairUnpackDefault: UnknownAttribute[%d]:
radConigure: can’t open %s: %s
radConigure: %s: line %d: bogus
format: %s
radConfAssert: No AuthServer
Speciied
radConfAssert: No Default Timeout
Speciied
radConfAssert: No Default Retry Count
Speciied
radExtractMppeKey: Invalid MS-MPPEKey Length
radVendorMessage: Invalid Length in
Vendor Message
radVendorMessage: Unknown Vendor
ID received:%d
radVendorAttrGet: Invalid Length in
Vendor Message
radVendorAttrGet: Unknown Vendor
ID:%d
radVendorMessagePack: Unknown
Vendor ID:%d
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
250
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Veriied Message-Authenticator
DEBUG
radGetIPByName: couldn’t resolve
hostname: %s
ERROR
Unloaded RADIUS Dictionary
DEBUG
radGetHostIP: couldn’t get hostname
ERROR
Adding Dictionary Attribute %s
DEBUG
radGetHostIP: couldn’t get host IP
address
ERROR
Adding Dictionary Value %s
DEBUG
RADIUS dictionary loading failed
ERROR
Loaded Dictionary %s
DEBUG
Failed to set default timeout value
ERROR
Adding Dictionary Attribute ‘%s’
DEBUG
Failed to set default retries value
ERROR
Adding Dictionary Value %s
DEBUG
Receiving attribute: %s
DEBUG
Processing attribute: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
Processing attribute: %s
DEBUG
empty update. nRows=%d nCols=%d
ERROR
Processing attribute: %s
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
Processing attribute: %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
radConfGet: “
DEBUG
Invalid SQLITE operation code - %d
ERROR
Added Server %s:%d with “
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
Added Server %s:%d with “
DEBUG
empty result. nRows=%d nCols=%d
ERROR
Default Timeout Set to %d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
Default Retry Count Set to %d
DEBUG
empty result. nRows=%d nCols=%d
ERROR
%s - %s : %d
DEBUG
RADIUS Accounting Exchange Failed
ERROR
Deleting Server %s:%d with “
DEBUG
Unable to set debug for radAcct.
ERROR
Adding RowId:%d to Server %s:%d with “
DEBUG
Unable to set debug level for radAcct.
ERROR
rowIds: %d - %d
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
Deleting Server %s:%d with “
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
RADIUS Deconigured
DEBUG
Unable to initialize RADIUS
ERROR
Found Option %s on line %d of ile %s
DEBUG
radEapMsgQueueAdd: Invalid EAP
packet length(%d)
ERROR
Setting Option %s with value %s
DEBUG
radEapRecvTask: invalid EAP code:%d
ERROR
RADIUS Conigured
DEBUG
%d : Server %s:%d with “
DEBUG
DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
Host IP address: %s
DEBUG
radEapRecvTask: “
ERROR
Adding Packet for existing cookie:%p
DEBUG
failed to initialize UMI
ERROR
Adding Packet and cookie:%p
DEBUG
umiRegister failed. errno=%d
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ERROR: incomplete DB update
information.
old values result does not contain 2
rows
radEapRecvTask: Packet length
mismatch %d, %d
No attributes received in AccessChallenge message
No State Attribute in Access-Challenge
message
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
251
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Releasing Packet and cookie:%p
DEBUG
Invalid arguments to ioctl handler
ERROR
Releasing Packet with cookie:%p
DEBUG
radEapSendRtn: Invalid Arguments
ERROR
Received EAP-Identity from Pnac: %s
DEBUG
radEapSendRtn: failed to allocate
bufer
ERROR
Filling User-Name: %s
DEBUG
umiIoctl failed
ERROR
Filling State:
DEBUG
failed to initialize EAP message queue
ERROR
Filling EAP-Message:
DEBUG
Unable to set debug for radEap.
ERROR
Filling Service-Type: %d
DEBUG
Unable to set debug level for radEap.
ERROR
Filling Framed-MTU: %d
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
Received Access-Challenge from Server
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
Sending Reply EAP Packet to Pnac
DEBUG
could not initialize MGMT framework
ERROR
Error sending packet to Pnac
DEBUG
Unable to initialize RADIUS
ERROR
RADIUS Authentication Failed; “
DEBUG
Unable to set debug for radEap.
ERROR
RADIUS Authentication Successful; “
DEBUG
Unable to set debug level for radEap.
ERROR
Got Packet with cookie:%p
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
Next DNS Retry after 1 min
DEBUG
Unable to initialize RADIUS
ERROR
Next Synchronization after”
DEBUG
Invalid username or password
ERROR
Next Synchronization after”
DEBUG
Unable to set debug for radAuth.
ERROR
Next Synchronization after %d \
DEBUG
Unable to set debug level for radAuth.
ERROR
Primary is not available, “
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
Secondary is not available, “
DEBUG
Unable to initialize RADIUS
ERROR
Invalid value for use default servers, “
DEBUG
Invalid username, challenge or
response
ERROR
No server is conigured, “
DEBUG
Unable to set debug for radAuth.
ERROR
Backing of for %d seconds
DEBUG
Unable to set debug level for radAuth.
ERROR
Requesting time from %s
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
Synchronized time with %s
DEBUG
Unable to initialize RADIUS
ERROR
Received KOD packet from %s
DEBUG
Invalid username or password
ERROR
No suitable server found %s
DEBUG
usage : %s 
ERROR
Received Invalid Length packet from %s
DEBUG
ntpd : umi initialization failed
ERROR
Received Invalid Version packet from %s
DEBUG
ntpd : ntpInit failed
ERROR
Received Invalid Mode packet from %s
DEBUG
ntpd : ntpMgmtInit failed
ERROR
Request Timed out from %s
DEBUG
There was an error while getting the
timeZoneChangeScript.”
ERROR
Looking Up %s
DEBUG
unexpected reply from %d cmd=%d !
ERROR
Timezone diference :%d
DEBUG
cmd %d not supported. caller %d
ERROR
Could not open ile: %s
DEBUG
default reached
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
252
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Could not read data from ile
DEBUG
Unable to initialize ntpControl
ERROR
ntpTblHandler
DEBUG
ntpMgmt : Couldn’t open database %s
ERROR
status: %d
DEBUG
ERROR : incomplete DB update
information
ERROR
tz: %d
DEBUG
empty update. nRows=%d nCols=%d
ERROR
DayLightsaving: %d
DEBUG
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
DEBUG
requestNtpTime: Invalid addr
ERROR
DEBUG
failed to take lock for compId: %d
ERROR
DS: %d
DEBUG
failed to convert ioctl args to bufer for”
ERROR
pPriServ %s
DEBUG
request timeout dst(%d) <-- src(%d)
ERROR
pSecServ %s
DEBUG
failed to take lock for compId: %d
ERROR
Making request from %d --> %d
DEBUG
sent request dst(%d) <-- src(%d) using
option %d
DEBUG
received request too small!(%d bytes)
DEBUG
adpMalloc failed
ERROR
Received a UMI request from %d
DEBUG
context with ID: %d already registered
ERROR
sent a reply src(%d) ---> dst(%d)
DEBUG
umiRegister (%x,%x,%x,%x)
DEBUG
srcId=%d(%s) --> destId=%d(%s) cmd=%d
inLen=%d outLen=%d
DEBUG
waiting for reply...Giving Up
DEBUG
No request in the list after semTake
DEBUG
Invalid arguments to umiIoctl
ERROR
reply timeout
DEBUG
could not ind the destination context
ERROR
timeout after semTake
DEBUG
memPartAlloc for %d size failed
ERROR
srcId=%d(%s) <-- destId=%d(%s) cmd=%d
DEBUG
memPartAlloc for %d size failed
ERROR
Un-registerting component with Id %d
DEBUG
No Handler registered for this UMI
context
ERROR
failed to send ioctl request: dst(%d) <--src(%d)
DEBUG
Couldn’t ind component with ID (%d),”
ERROR
processed a reply dst(%d) <-- src(%d)
DEBUG
id=%d handler=%x
ERROR
request with no result option dst(%d) <-src(%d)
DEBUG
cmd = %s
DEBUG
cmdstring is %s %s:%d
DEBUG
call to printConig failed
ERROR
Calling printerConig binary ...
DEBUG
Failed to Disable Network Storage”
ERROR
Calling unmount for USB ...
DEBUG
Calling mount for USB ...
DEBUG
usbdevice is %d %s:%d
DEBUG
pNtpControl->ServerNames[PRIMARY_
SERVER]: %s
pNtpControl->ServerNames[SECONDARY_
SERVER]: %s
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
umiIoctlArgsToBuf: failed to allocate
memory
umiRecvFrom: could not allocate
memory
Failed to allocate memory for creating
UMI context
Failed to create recvSem for UMI
context
Failed to create mutex locks for UMI
context
Failed to create mutex recvQLock for
UMI context
Received NULL bufer in
umiBufToIoctlArgs()
usbMgmtInit: unable to open the
database ile %s
Some error occurred while removing
device
Some error occurred while removing
device
Sqlite update failed
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
253
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Query string: %s
DEBUG
Failed to enable printer properly
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
DEBUG
Failed to mount device on system
ERROR
%s: 1. usb is already disconnected for old
usb type. “
DEBUG
Failed to enable network storage
device”
ERROR
%s: 2.call disable for new usb type !
DEBUG
Failed to mount device on system
ERROR
%s: 3. usb is already disconnected for old
usb type. “
DEBUG
Sqlite update failed
ERROR
%s: 4. Disabled old usb type . Now “
DEBUG
USB1 Touch failed
ERROR
usbdevice is %d %s:%d
DEBUG
USB2 Touch failed
ERROR
USB: failed to begin transaction: %s
DEBUG
Sqlite update failed
ERROR
USB: SQL error: %s pSetString = %s
DEBUG
Failed query: %s
ERROR
USB: failed to commit transaction: %s
DEBUG
USB: updated table: %s
DEBUG
USB: returning with status: %s
DEBUG
Illegal invocation of snmpConig (%s)
ERROR
%s:DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
Invalid Community Access Type
ERROR
executing %s status =%d
DEBUG
Invalid User Access Type
ERROR
executing %s
DEBUG
Invalid Security Level
ERROR
%s returned status=%d
DEBUG
Invalid Authentication Algorithm
ERROR
%s returned status=%d
DEBUG
Invalid Privacy Algorithm
ERROR
snmpd.conf not found
DEBUG
Invalid Argument
ERROR
[SNMP_DEBUG] : Fwrite Successful
DEBUG
Failed to allocate memory for engineID
ERROR
[SNMP_DEBUG] : Fwrite failed
DEBUG
[SNMP_DEBUG]: Failed to get host
address
ERROR
radPairGen: received unknown attribute
%d of length %d
WARN
[SNMP_DEBUG] : FOPEN failed
ERROR
radPairGen: %s has unknown type
WARN
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
radPairLocate: unknown attribute %ld of
length %d
WARN
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
radPairLocate: %s has unknown type
WARN
Invalid Security Level
ERROR
Illegal invocation of cpuMemUsage (%s)
ERROR
Invalid Authentication Algorithm
ERROR
cpuMemUsageDBUpdateHandler: SQL
error: %s
ERROR
Invalid Privacy Algorithm
ERROR
unable to open the DB ile %s
ERROR
Failed to Get Host Address
ERROR
umiInit failed
ERROR
Invalid version
ERROR
unable to register to UMI
ERROR
snmp v3 Trap Coniguration Failed
ERROR
Error Reading from the Database.
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed query:%s
ERROR
short DB update event request!
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
Failed to Open Snmp Coniguration File
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Failed to execute usb database update
handler
Usage:%s  
 
ERROR
ERROR
254
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
adpListNodeRemove : Returned with an
error
ERROR
Failed to write access control entries
ERROR
command too long. Try increasing “
ERROR
Failed to write snmpv3 users entries
ERROR
failed to allocate memory for CRON_NODE
ERROR
Failed to write snmp trap entries
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
Failed to write system entries.
ERROR
There was an error while reading the
schedules.
ERROR
Failed to restart snmp
ERROR
unable to register to UMI
ERROR
%s failed with status
ERROR
short DB update event request!
ERROR
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
malloc(DB_UPDATE_NODE) failed
ERROR
%s: Unable to open ile: %s
ERROR
short ifDev event request!
ERROR
RADVD start failed
ERROR
sqlite3_mprintf failed
ERROR
RADVD stop failed
ERROR
no component id matching %s
ERROR
failed to create/open RADVD
coniguration ile %s
ERROR
umiIoctl (%s, UMI_CMD_DB_UPDATE(%d))
failed.
ERROR
Restoring old coniguration..
ERROR
sqlite3_mprintf failed
ERROR
failed to write/update RADVD
coniguration ile
ERROR
sqlite3_mprintf failed
ERROR
upnpDisableFunc failed
ERROR
no component id matching %s
ERROR
upnpEnableFunc failed
ERROR
umiIoctl (%s, UMI_CMD_IFDEV_
EVENT(%d)) failed.
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
klogctl(9) failed
ERROR
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
malloc failed for %d bytes
ERROR
unable to open the DB ile %s
ERROR
klogctl(4) failed
ERROR
umiInit failed
ERROR
emailLogs: Invalid Number of Arguments!!
Exiting.
ERROR
unable to register to UMI
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
short DB update event request!
ERROR
Could not execute the smtpClient.
ERROR
short ifDev event request!
ERROR
Error while cleaning the database.Exiting.
%s
ERROR
sqlite3_mprintf failed
ERROR
%s failed. status=%d
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
255
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Facility: System (Firewall)
Log Message
Severity
Log Message
Severity
Enabling rule for protocol binding.
DEBUG
Disable all NAT rules.
DEBUG
Disabling rule for protocol binding.
DEBUG
Enable all NAT rules.
DEBUG
Enabling Remote SNMP on WAN.
DEBUG
Enabling NAT URL ilter rules.
DEBUG
Disabling Remote SNMP on WAN
DEBUG
Restarting all NAT rules.
DEBUG
wan traic counters are restared
DEBUG
Deleting schedule based irewall rules.
DEBUG
Traic limit has been reached
DEBUG
Deleting schedule based irewall rules
from DB.
DEBUG
Traic meter monthly limit has been
changed to %d.
DEBUG
Update schedule based irewall rules in
DB.
DEBUG
Enabling traic meter for only dowload.
DEBUG
Restart schedule based irewall rules.
DEBUG
Enabling traic meter for both directions.
DEBUG
inter vlan routing enabled
DEBUG
Enabling traic meter with no limit.
DEBUG
inter vlan routing disabled
DEBUG
Email alert in traic meter disabled.
DEBUG
Disabling Content Filter for %d
DEBUG
Email alert in traic meter enabled.
DEBUG
Enabling Content Filter for %d
DEBUG
Traic Meter:Monthly limit %d MB has
been “
DEBUG
Traic Metering: Adding rule to drop all
traic
DEBUG
Traic Metering: %sabling Email traic
DEBUG
Enabling Source MAC Filtering
DEBUG
Disabling attack checks for IPv6 rules.
DEBUG
Disabling Source MAC Filtering
DEBUG
Enabling attack checks for IPv6 rules.
DEBUG
Adding MAC Filter Policy for Block &
Permit Rest
DEBUG
Coniguring one to one NAT settings with
%s private start IP “
DEBUG
Adding MAC Filter Policy for Permit &
Block Rest
DEBUG
Deleting forward one to one NAT having
setting %s private start”
DEBUG
Restarting Source MAC Address Policy
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for Block ping to
WAN interface.
DEBUG
Disabling Firewall Rule for DHCP Relay
Protocol
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for Stealth mode
for tcp
DEBUG
Enabling Firewall Rule for DHCP Relay
Protocol
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for Stealth mode
for udp
DEBUG
prerouting Firewall Rule add for Relay
failed
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
./src/irewall/linux/user/
irewalld.c:59:#undef ADP_DEBUG2
./src/irewall/linux/user/
irewalld.c:61:#deine ADP_DEBUG2
printf
DEBUG
DEBUG
256
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
prerouting Firewall Rule add for Relay
failed
Deleting MAC Filter Policy for Address
%s
Disabling attack check for TCP Flood.
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for UDP Flood.
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for IPsec.
DEBUG
Adding MAC Filter Policy for Address %s
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for PPTP.
DEBUG
Disabling Firewall Rules for DMZ host
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for L2TP.
DEBUG
Enabling Firewall Rules for DMZ host
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for UDP Flood.
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for IPsec.
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for PPTP.
DEBUG
Disabling attack check for L2TP.
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for Block ping to
WAN “
Enabling attack check for Stealth Mode
for tcp.
Enabling attack check for Stealth Mode
for udp.
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
Disabling Firewall Rules for Spill Over
Load Balancing
Disabling Firewall Rules for Load
Balancing
Enabling Firewall Rules for Load
Balancing
Enabling Firewall Rules for Spill Over
Load Balancing
Enabling Firewall Rules for Auto Failover
Enabling Firewall Rules for Load
Balancing .
Enabling Firewall Rules for Spill Over
Load Balancing .
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for TCP Flood.
DEBUG
Enabling Firewall Rules for Auto Failover
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for UDP Flood.
DEBUG
Deleting BlockSites Keyword \
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for IPsec.
DEBUG
Enabling BlockSites Keyword \
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for PPTP.
DEBUG
Disabling BlockSites Keyword \
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for L2TP.
DEBUG
Updating BlockSites Keyword from \
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for UDP Flood.
DEBUG
Inserting BlockSites Keyword \
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for IPsec.
DEBUG
Deleting Trusted Domain \
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for PPTP.
DEBUG
Adding Trusted Domain \
DEBUG
Enabling attack check for L2TP.
DEBUG
Restarting Schedule Based Firewall Rules
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Remote SNMP
DEBUG
DEBUG
Disabling Remote SNMP
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Remote SNMP
DEBUG
DEBUG
Disabling DOS Attacks
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling DOS Attacks
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling DOS Attacks
DEBUG
DEBUG
Restarting Firewall [%d]:[%d] For %s
DEBUG
DEBUG
restartStatus = %d for LogicalIfName =
%s
DEBUG
Enabling DoS attack check with %d
SyncFlood detect rate, “
Disabling DoS attack check having %d
SyncFlood detect rate,”
Enabling ICSA Notiication Item for ICMP
notiication.
Enabling ICSA Notiication Item for
Fragmented Packets.
Enabling ICSA Notiication Item for Multi
cast Packets.
Disabling ICSA Notiication Item for ICMP
notiication.
Disabling ICSA Notiication Item for
Fragmented Packets.
Disabling ICSA Notiication Item for Multi
cast Packets.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
257
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Adding IP/MAC binding rule for %s MAC
address “
Deleting IP/MAC binding rule for %s MAC
“
./src/irewall/linux/user/
irewalld.c:60:#undef ADP_DEBUG
./src/irewall/linux/user/
irewalld.c:62:#deine ADP_DEBUG printf
Restarting traic meter with %d mins, %d
hours, “
Updating traic meter with %d mins, %d
hours, “
DEBUG
Deleting Lan Group %s
DEBUG
DEBUG
Adding Lan Group %s
DEBUG
DEBUG
Deleting lan host %s from group %s
DEBUG
DEBUG
Adding lan host %s from group %s
DEBUG
DEBUG
Disabling Firewall Rule for IGMP Protocol
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Firewall Rule for IGMP Protocol
DEBUG
Deleting IP/MAC Bind Rule for MAC
address %s and IP “
Adding IP/MAC Bind Rule for MAC
address %s and IP
Deleting Protocol Bind Rule for Service
%s
Deleting Protocol Bind Rule for Service
%s
Deleting Protocol Bind Rule for Service
%s
Deleting traic meter.
DEBUG
Disabling block traic for traic meter.
DEBUG
Enabling traic meter.
DEBUG
Adding lan group %s.
DEBUG
Deleting lan group %s.
DEBUG
Renaming lan group from %s to %s.
DEBUG
Adding Protocol Bind Rule for Service %s
DEBUG
Deleting host %s from %s group.
DEBUG
%s Session Settings
DEBUG
Adding host %s to %s group.
DEBUG
Restarting IPv6 Firewall Rules...
DEBUG
Enabling Keyword blocking for %s
keyword.
Disabling keyword Blocking for %s
keyword .
Deleting trusted domain with keyword
%s.
Adding %s keyword to trusted domain.
Enabling Management Access from
Internet on port %d
Enabling remote access management for
IP address range”
Enabling remote access management to
only this PC.
Disabling Management Access from
Internet on port %d
Disabling remote access management for
IP address range”
Disabling remote access management
only to this PC.
MAC Filtering %sabled for BLOCK and
PERMIT REST.
MAC Filtering %sabled for PERMIT and
BLOCK REST.
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
Deleting Port Trigger Rule for
%d:%d:%d:%d:%d
Deleting Port Trigger Rule for
%d:%d:%d:%d:%d
Enabling Port Trigger Rule for
%d:%d:%d:%d:%d
Disabling Port Trigger Rule for
%d:%d:%d:%d:%d
Enabling Port Trigger Rule for
%d:%d:%d:%d:%d
Disabling Port Trigger Rule for
%d:%d:%d:%d:%d
Adding Port Trigger Rule for
%d:%d:%d:%d:%d
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Content Filter
DEBUG
DEBUG
Disabling Content Filter
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Content Filter
DEBUG
DEBUG
Setting NAT mode for pLogicalIfName
= %s
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling DROP for INPUT
DEBUG
Enabling Content Filtering.
DEBUG
Enabling DROP for FORWARD
DEBUG
Disabling Content Filtering.
DEBUG
Enabling NAT based Firewall Rules
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
258
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Deleting rule, port triggering for protocol
TCP.
Deleting rule, port triggering for protocol
UDP.
Deleting rule, port triggering for protocol
TCP.
Deleting rule, port triggering for protocol
UDP.
Enabling rule, port triggering for protocol
TCP.
Enabling rule, port triggering for protocol
UDP.
Enabling rule, port triggering for protocol
TCP.
Enabling rule, port triggering for protocol
UDP.
DEBUG
Setting transparent mode for
pLogicalIfName \
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Accept for INPUT
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Accept for FORWARD
DEBUG
DEBUG
Setting Routing mode for
pLogicalIfName \
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling DROP for INPUT
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling DROP for FORWARD
DEBUG
DEBUG
Disabling NAT based Firewall Rules
DEBUG
DEBUG
Enabling Firewall Rules for URL Filtering
&“
DEBUG
Enabling DNS proxy.
DEBUG
Adding Firewall Rule for RIP Protocol
DEBUG
Restarting DNS proxy.
DEBUG
Restarting Schedule Based Firewall Rules
DEBUG
checking DNS proxy for Secure zone.
DEBUG
checking DNS proxy for Public zone.
DEBUG
Enabling Block traic from %s zone.
DEBUG
Stopping IPS...%s
DEBUG
Coniguring irewall session settings for “
DEBUG
IPS started.
DEBUG
Disabling DMZ
DEBUG
Route already exists
DEBUG
Disabling WAN-DMZ rules .
DEBUG
Route addition failed: Network
Unreachable
DEBUG
Enabling WAN DMZ rules .
DEBUG
Route addition failed: Network is down
DEBUG
Restarting DMZ rule having %s address
with %s address.
DEBUG
Route addition failed
DEBUG
Enabling LAN DHCP relay.
DEBUG
Failed to add rule in iptables
DEBUG
OneToOneNat conigured successfully
DEBUG
Failed to delete rule from iptables
DEBUG
OneToOneNat coniguration failed
DEBUG
Deleting scheduled IPv6 rules.
DEBUG
delete from FirewallRules6 where
ScheduleName = ‘%s’.
Update FirewallRules6 where
ScheduleName = ‘%s’ to New “
DEBUG
DEBUG
enabling IPS checks between %s and %s
zones.
disabling IPS checks between %s and
%s zones.
fwLBSpillOverConigure: Something
going wrong here
fwLBSpillOverConigure: unable to get
interfaceName
fwLBSpillOverConigure: Could not set
PREROUTING rules
fwLBSpillOverConigure: Could not set
POSTROUTING rules
fwLBSpillOverConigure: Something
going wrong Here
fwL2TPGenericRules.c: unable to open
the database ile “
DEBUG
DEBUG
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
Dns proxy Restart failed
DEBUG
deleting interface to ifgroup failed
DEBUG
adding interface to ifgroup failed
DEBUG
fwL2TPGenericRules.c: inet_aton failed
ERROR
DEBUG
fwPPTPGenericRules.c: unable to open
the database ile “
ERROR
DEBUG
fwPPTPGenericRules.c: inet_aton failed
ERROR
Deleting IP address %s.
DEBUG
DNS proxy irewall rule add failed for %s
ERROR
Adding new IP address %s.
DEBUG
deleting interface %s from ifgroup %d
failed
ERROR
Updating old IP address %s to new IP
address %s.
DEBUG
adding interface %s to ifgroup %d failed
ERROR
deleting interface pVirtIface %s from
ifgroup %d”
adding interface pVirtIface %s to ifgroup
%d failed
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ERROR
ERROR
259
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Restarting Firewall For %s Address
Update from %s:%s
Disabling Firewall Rule for MSS packet
marking
Enabling Firewall Rule for MSS packet
marking
Enabling packet marking rule for %s IDLE
timer
Deleted irewall rule %s for service %s
with action %s
%s irewall rule %s for service %s with
action %s
Added irewall rule %s for service %s with
action %s
DEBUG
nimfBridgeTblHandler: unable to get
interfaceName
ERROR
DEBUG
nimfBridgeTblHandler: \
ERROR
DEBUG
nimfBridgeTblHandler: unable to get \
ERROR
DEBUG
Failed to %s traic from %s to %s to IPS.
ERROR
DEBUG
Failed to %s traic from %s to %s to IPS.
ERROR
DEBUG
failed to start IPS service.
ERROR
DEBUG
Timeout in waiting for IPS service to
start.
Usage:%s  
  “
ERROR
Deleting inbound(WAN-LAN) irewall rule.
DEBUG
Deleting inbound(WAN-DMZ) irewall
rule.
DEBUG
xlr8NatConig: illegal invocation of (%s)
ERROR
RIPng disabled.
DEBUG
Illegal invocation of [%s]
ERROR
RIPng enabled.
DEBUG
xlr8NatMgmtTblHandler: failed query:
%s
ERROR
Disable IPv6 irewall rule.
DEBUG
Could not open ile: %s
ERROR
Enable IPv6 irewall rule.
DEBUG
Rip Error Command Too Long
ERROR
Deleting IGMP proxy rule.
DEBUG
No authentication for Ripv1
ERROR
Enable IGMP proxy rule.
DEBUG
Invalid Rip Direction
ERROR
Restarting IGMP rule.
DEBUG
Invalid Rip Version
ERROR
Traic meter enabled with no limit type.
DEBUG
Invalid Password for 1st Key
ERROR
Traic meter enabled for only download.
DEBUG
Invalid Time for 1st Key
ERROR
Traic meter enabled for both directions.
DEBUG
Invalid Password for 2nd Key
ERROR
DEBUG
Invalid Time for 2nd Key
ERROR
DEBUG
Invalid First KeyId
ERROR
DEBUG
Invalid Second KeyId
ERROR
Enabling Inter VLAN routing.
DEBUG
Invalid Authentication Type
ERROR
Updating inter VLAN routing status.
DEBUG
ripDisable failed
ERROR
Deleting inter VLAN routing.
DEBUG
ripEnable failed
ERROR
Deleted irewall rule %s for service %s
with action %s
%s irewall rule %s for service %s with
action %s
Added irewall rule %s for service %s with
action %s
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ERROR
260
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Facility: Local0 (Wireless)
Log Message
Severity
Log Message
Severity
(node=%s) setting %s to val = %d
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
Custom wireless event: ‘%s’
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
Wireless event: cmd=0x%x len=%d
DEBUG
VAP(%s) set beacon interval failed
ERROR
DEBUG
VAP(%s) set DTIM interval failed
ERROR
DEBUG
VAP(%s) set RTS Threshold failed
ERROR
ran query %s
DEBUG
VAP(%s) set Fragmentation Threshold
failed
ERROR
DBUpdate event: Table: %s opCode:%d
rowId:%d
DEBUG
VAP(%s) set Protection Mode failed
ERROR
%sing VAPs using proile %s
DEBUG
VAP(%s) set Tx Power failed
ERROR
%sing VAP %s
DEBUG
WDS Proile %s not found
ERROR
ran query %s
DEBUG
Failed to initalize WPS on %s
ERROR
%sing VAP instance %s
DEBUG
failed to get proile %s
ERROR
VAP(%s) set Short Preamble failed
DEBUG
could not initialize MGMT framework
ERROR
VAP(%s) set Short Retry failed
DEBUG
could not initialize MGMT framework
ERROR
VAP(%s) set Long Retry failed
DEBUG
dot11VapBssidUpdt SQL error: %s
ERROR
Decrypting context with key %s
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Unknown IAPP command %d received.
DEBUG
KDOT11_GET_PARAM(IEEE80211_IOC_
CHANNEL) failed
ERROR
unexpected reply from %d cmd=%d !
DEBUG
Failed to get the channel setting for %s
ERROR
unexpected reply from %d cmd=%d !
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
Recvied DOT11_EAPOL_KEYMSG
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
shutting down AP:%s
DEBUG
proile %s not found
ERROR
APCtx Found
DEBUG
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
APCtx Not-Found
DEBUG
Interface name and policy must be
speciied
ERROR
New Rogue AP
(%02x:%02x:%02x:%02x:%02x:%02x)
detected
WPS session in progress, ignoring enrolle
assoc request
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
261
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
node not found *:*:*:%x:%x:%x
DEBUG
Interface name and policy must be
speciied
ERROR
error installing unicast key for %s
DEBUG
invalid ACL type %d
ERROR
cmd =%d i_type =%d i_val=%d
DEBUG
interface name not speciied
ERROR
join event for new node %s
DEBUG
interface name not speciied
ERROR
wpa/rsn IE id %d/%d not supported
DEBUG
Invalid interface - %s speciied
ERROR
wpa IE id %d not supported
DEBUG
bufer length not speciied
ERROR
leave event for node %s
DEBUG
Invalid length(%d) speciied
ERROR
NodeFree request for node : %s
DEBUG
failed created iappdLock
ERROR
installing key to index %d
DEBUG
failed to create cipher contexts.
ERROR
iReq.i_val : %d
DEBUG
unable to register to UMI
ERROR
pIfName : %s
DEBUG
iappSockInit() failed
ERROR
iReq.i_val : %d
DEBUG
setting mode: %d
DEBUG
Global counter wrapped, re-generating...
DEBUG
Got PNAC_EVENT_PREAUTH_SUCCESS
event for : %s
DEBUG
UDP failed, received Length is %d
ERROR
event for non-existent node %s
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_KDOT11,
ERROR
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_UDOT11,%d,%d) \
ERROR
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_KDOT11,%d,%d) \
ERROR
DEBUG
No IAPP Node found for req id %d
ERROR
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_UDOT11,%d,%d) \
ERROR
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_KDOT11,%d,%d) \
ERROR
unsupported event %d from PNAC
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_UDOT11,%d,%d)
failed
ERROR
event for non-existent node %s. Create
new node.
DEBUG
UDP socket is not created
ERROR
Add new node to DOT11 Node list
DEBUG
UDP send failed
ERROR
Update dot11STA database
DEBUG
IAPP: socket (SOCK_STREAM) failed.
ERROR
Add PMKSA to the list
DEBUG
IAPP: TCP connect failed to %s.
ERROR
eapolRecvAuthKeyMsg: received key
message
DEBUG
cmd %d not supported.sender=%d
ERROR
node not found
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_KDOT11,%d,%d)
failed
ERROR
PNAC_EVENT_EAPOL_START event
received
PNAC_EVENT_EAPOL_LOGOFF event
received
PNAC_EVENT_REAUTH event received
PNAC_EVENT_AUTH_SUCCESS event
received
PNAC_EVENT_PORT_STATUS_CHANGED
event received
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
iappInit got error, unregistering it with
UMI
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_UDOT11,%d,%d)
failed
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_KDOT11,%d,%d)
failed
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
262
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
eapolRecvKeyMsg: replay counter not
incremented
DEBUG
IAPP-CACHE-NOTIFY-REQUEST send to
ERROR
eapolRecvKeyMsg: replay counter is not
same
DEBUG
./src/dot11/iapp/iappLib.c:1314:
ADP_ERROR (
ERROR
processing pairwise key message 2
DEBUG
BSSID value passed is NULL
ERROR
RSN IE matching: OK
DEBUG
reserved requestId is passed
ERROR
processing pairwise key message 4
DEBUG
interface name is NULL
ERROR
processing group key message 2
DEBUG
IP address value passed is NULL
ERROR
processing key request message from
client
DEBUG
opening receive UDP socket failed
ERROR
WPA version %2x %2x not supported
DEBUG
enabling broadcast for UDP socket
failed
ERROR
(%s) group cipher %2x doesn’t match
DEBUG
opening receive TCP socket for new AP
failed
ERROR
(%s)Pairwise cipher %s not supported
DEBUG
./src/dot11/iapp/iappLib.c:1784:
ADP_ERROR(
ERROR
(%s) authentication method %d not
supported
DEBUG
./src/dot11/iapp/iappLib.c:1794:
ADP_ERROR(
ERROR
%s:Auth method=%s pairwise cipher=%s
IE size=%d
DEBUG
./src/dot11/iapp/iappLib.c:1803:
ADP_ERROR(
ERROR
WPA version %2x %2x not supported
DEBUG
failed created dot11dLock.
ERROR
Unable to obtain IE of type %d
DEBUG
failed initialize proile library.
ERROR
PTK state changed from %s to %s
DEBUG
failed to create cipher contexts.
ERROR
using PMKSA from cache
DEBUG
unable to register to UMI
ERROR
PTK GK state changed from %s to %s
DEBUG
could not create MIB tree
ERROR
GK state changed from %s to %s
DEBUG
unable to register to PNAC
ERROR
Sending PTK Msg1
DEBUG
Max registration attempts by DOT11 to
PNAC exceeded
ERROR
Sending PTK Msg3
DEBUG
Creation of EAP WPS Proile Failed
ERROR
Sending GTK Msg1
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_IAPP,%d ) failed
ERROR
sending EAPOL pdu to PNAC...
DEBUG
DOT11_RX_EAPOL_KEYMSG: unknown
ifname %s
ERROR
creating pnac authenticator with values
%d %d - %s
DEBUG
cmd %d not supported.sender=%d
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
DEBUG
inteface name passed is NULL
ERROR
IAPP initialized.
DEBUG
BSSID passed is NULL
ERROR
Encrypting context key=%s for
DEBUG
inteface name passed is NULL
ERROR
could not ind access point context for %s
DEBUG
unable to allocate memory for DOT11_
CTX
ERROR
join event for existing node %s
DEBUG
unable to install wme mapping on %s
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
263
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
failed to send PNAC_FORCE_AUTHORIZED
“
DEBUG
unable to get %s mac address
ERROR
failed to send PNAC_AUTHORIZED “
DEBUG
Failed to set %s SSID
ERROR
DEBUG
Failed to set SSID broadcast status
ERROR
DEBUG
Failed to set PreAuth mode
ERROR
DEBUG
unable to install key
ERROR
failed to send PNAC_VAR_KEY_AVAILABLE
(TRUE) “
failed to send PNAC_VAR_KEY_TX_EN
(TRUE) “
failed to send PNAC_VAR_KEY_TX_EN
(FALSE) “
failed to send PNAC_FORCE_AUTHORIZED
“
DEBUG
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
AUTHMODE failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
PRIVACY failed
ERROR
failed to send PNAC_AUTHORIZED “
DEBUG
mic veriication: OK
DEBUG
wpaInit failed
ERROR
pnacIfConig: Invalid supplicant”
DEBUG
dot11InstallProile: unable to get
interface index
ERROR
Failed to process user request
DEBUG
adpHmacInit(%s) failed
ERROR
Failed to process user request - %s(%d)
DEBUG
interface %s not found
ERROR
pnacIfConigUmiIoctl: umiIoctl failed
DEBUG
AP not found on %s
ERROR
DEBUG
keyLen > PNAC_KEY_MAX_SIZE
ERROR
DEBUG
Invalid proile name passed
ERROR
DEBUG
Creation of WPS EAP Proile failed
ERROR
DEBUG
unsupported command %d
ERROR
DEBUG
device %s not found
ERROR
DEBUG
unsupported command %d
ERROR
DEBUG
dot11NodeAlloc failed
ERROR
DEBUG
Getting WPA IE failed for %s
ERROR
DEBUG
Getting WPS IE failed for %s
ERROR
pnacIfConigUmiIoctl: usrPnac returned
%d
pnacIfConigUmiIoctl: usrPnac returned
%d
pnacIfConigUmiIoctl: usrPnac returned
%d
pnacKernNotiier: invalid PAE
coniguration “
From pnacEapDemoAuthRecv:
unsupported response “
From pnacEapDemoAuthRecv: invalid
codes received
From pnacRadXlateDemoRecv: received
unknown “
From pnacRadXlateDemoRecv: invalid
codes received
Error from pnacRadXlateDemoRecv:
malloc failed
From pnacRadXlateRadPktHandle:
received a non-supported”
Only md5 authentication scheme
currently supported. “
Message from authenticator:
DEBUG
DEBUG
Failed initialize authenticator for node
%s
Failed to get the system up time while
adding node %s
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
DEBUG
error creating PNAC port for node %s
ERROR
DEBUG
dot11NodeAlloc failed
ERROR
DEBUG
Invalid arguments.
ERROR
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_IAPP,%d) failed
ERROR
sending unicast key
DEBUG
Invalid IE.
ERROR
sending broadcast key
DEBUG
from pnacPDUXmit: bufsize = %d, pktType
= %d,”
pnacPDUXmit: sending eap packet. code
= %d, “
pnacRecvRtn: no corresponding pnac port
pae found
from pnacAuthPAEDisconnected: calling
pnacTxCannedFail
from pnacAuthPAEForceUnauth: calling
pnacTxCannedFail
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
DEBUG
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_KDOT11_VAP,%d
) failed
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_KDOT11,%d ,%d)
failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
WME_CWMIN failed
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
264
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
state changed from %s to %s
DEBUG
PNAC user comp id not set. dropping
event %d
DEBUG
sending event %d to %d
DEBUG
requesting keys informantion from %d
DEBUG
pnacUmiPortPaeParamSet: error in getting
port pae
pnacUmiPortPaeParamSet: invalid param
- %d
pnacRecvASInfoMessage: Skey of length
%d set
pnacRecvASInfoMessage: reAuthPeriod
set to: %d
pnacRecvASInfoMessage: suppTimeout
set to: %d
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
PORT SUCCESSFULLY DESTROYED
DEBUG
creating physical port for %s
DEBUG
pnacAuthInit: using defualt
pnacAuthParams
pnacSuppInit: using defualt
pnacSuppParams
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
Error from
pnacCombinedStMachTriggerFunc: “
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
WME_CWMAX failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
WME_AIFS failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:80211_IOC_
WME_TXOPLIMIT failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
WME_ACM failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
WME failed
invalid group cipher %d
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
MCASTCIPHER failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
MCASTKEYLEN failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
UCASTCIPHERS failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
KEYMGTALGS failed
KDOT11_SET_PARAM:IEEE80211_IOC_
WPA failed
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
DEBUG
unknow cipher type = %d
ERROR
DEBUG
umiIoctl(UMI_COMP_IAPP,%d) failed
ERROR
DEBUG
invalid media value=%d
ERROR
DEBUG
invalid mediaOpt value=%d
ERROR
DEBUG
invalid mode value=%d
ERROR
DEBUG
dot11PnacIfCreate failed
ERROR
DEBUG
wpaPRF failed
ERROR
DEBUG
Error generating global key counter
ERROR
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
wpaCalcMic: unsupported key
descriptor version
integrity failed. need to stop all stations
“
couldn’t ind AP context for %s
interface
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
received a pdu on %s
DEBUG
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
pnacRecvMapi: protoType: %04x
pPhyPort->authToASSendRtn:%p
DEBUG
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
port not found
DEBUG
from pnacRecvMapi: pkt body len = %d,
pktType = %d
from pnacPDUProcess: received PNAC_
EAP_PACKET
from pnacPDUProcess: currentId = %d
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
eapolRecvKeyMsg: unknown descType
=%d
eapolRecvKeyMsg: invalid descriptor
version
eapolRecvKeyMsg: incorrect descriptor
version
eapolRecvKeyMsg: Ack must not be set
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
265
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
from pnacPDUProcess: code = %d,
identiier = %d, “
DEBUG
from pnacPDUProcess: setting rxResp true
DEBUG
from pnacPDUProcess: code = %d,
identiier = %d, “
DEBUG
from pnacPDUProcess: received “
DEBUG
from pnacPDUProcess: received “
DEBUG
from pnacPDUProcess: received PNAC_
EAPOL_KEY_PACKET
DEBUG
doing pnacTxCannedFail
DEBUG
doing pnacTxCannedSuccess
DEBUG
doing pnacTxReqId
DEBUG
doing pnacTxReq
DEBUG
doing pnacTxStart
DEBUG
doing pnacTxLogof
DEBUG
doing pnacTxRspId: 1st cond
DEBUG
doing pnacTxRspId: entering 2nd cond
DEBUG
wpaAuthRecvKeyReq: mic check failed
ERROR
from pnacTxRspId: code = %d, identiier =
%d, length = %d, “
DEBUG
invalid OUI %x %x %x
ERROR
doing pnacTxRspId: 2nd cond
DEBUG
(%s) invalid OUI %x %x %x
ERROR
doing pnacTxRspAuth: 1st cond
DEBUG
[%s:%d] Cipher in WPA IE : %x
ERROR
doing pnacTxRspAuth: 2nd cond
DEBUG
(%s) invalid OUI %x %x %x
ERROR
message for unknown port PAE
DEBUG
short WPA IE (length = %d) received
ERROR
DEBUG
PTK state machine in unknown state.
ERROR
DEBUG
dot11InstallKeys failed
ERROR
DEBUG
group state machine entered into WPA_
AUTH_GTK_INIT
ERROR
DEBUG
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
DEBUG
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
unknown EAP-code %d
DEBUG
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
Authenticator[%d]:
DEBUG
aesWrap failed
ERROR
Auth PAE state = %s
DEBUG
unknown key descriptor version %d
ERROR
Auth Reauth state = %s
DEBUG
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
Back auth state = %s
DEBUG
could not initialize AES128ECB
ERROR
from pnacACToSuppRecvRtn: calling
pnacEapPktRecord
from pnacEapPktRecord: code = %d,
identiier = %d, “
from pnacEapPktRecord: received success
pkt
from pnacEapPktRecord: received failure
pkt
from pnacEapPktRecord: received request
pkt
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
eapolRecvKeyMsg: MIC bit must be set
wpaAuthRecvPTKMsg2: unexpected
packet received
wpaAuthRecvPTKMsg2: mic check
failed
wpaAuthRecvPTKMsg2: rsn ie mismatch
wpaAuthRecvPTKMsg4: unexpected
packet received
wpaAuthRecvPTKMsg4: keyDataLength
not zero
wpaAuthRecvPTKMsg4: mic check
failed
wpaAuthRecvGTKMsg2: unexpected
packet received
secureBit not set in GTK Msg2
wpaAuthRecvGTKMsg2: keyDataLength
not zero
wpaAuthRecvGTKMsg2: mic check
failed
wpaAuthRecvKeyReq: unexpected
packet received
wpaAuthRecvKeyReq: keyDataLength
not zero
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
266
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Supplicant[%d]:
DEBUG
could not initialize AES-128-ECB
ERROR
Supp Pae state = %s
DEBUG
MD5 initialization failed
ERROR
from pnacBackAuthFail: calling
pnacTxCannedFail
DEBUG
RC4 framework initialization failed
ERROR
%s returned ERROR
DEBUG
PNAC framework initialization failed
ERROR
pnacUmiIoctlHandler: cmd: %s(%d)
DEBUG
ERROR: option value not speciied
ERROR
%s not conigured for 802.1x
DEBUG
ERROR: -u can be used only with -s
ERROR
could not process PDU received from the
wire
DEBUG
ERROR: user-name not speciied
ERROR
pnacPDUForward: failed to foward the
received PDU
DEBUG
failed to enable debug
ERROR
Creating PHY port with AUTH backend :
%s SendRtn: %p RecvRtn:%p
DEBUG
[%s]: failed to convert string to MAC “
ERROR
pnacUmiAuthConig: %s not conigured
for 802.1x
DEBUG
failed to initialize UMI
ERROR
pnacSuppRegisterUserInfo: not a valid AC
DEBUG
pnacPhyPortParamSet:invalid
arguments
ERROR
pnacIfConig: autoAuth Enabled
DEBUG
pnacPhyPortParamSet:Failed to create
socket
ERROR
pnacSendRtn: no pnac port pae found
for “
DEBUG
Error from pnacPhyPortParamSet:%sdevice invalid
ERROR
sending portStatus: %s[%d] to dot11
DEBUG
Error from pnacPhyPortParamSet:%sGetting MAC address “
ERROR
pnacRecvASInfoMessage: Rkey of length
%d set
DEBUG
pnacPhyPortParamSet:Failed to add
802.1X multicast “
ERROR
ASSendRtn: %p ASToAuthRecv: %p
DEBUG
pnacIsInterfaceUp: failed to create a
raw socket
ERROR
adpRand failed:unable to generate
random unicast key
WARN
pnacIsInterfaceUp: failed to get
interface lags
ERROR
using group key as unicast key
WARN
failed to allocate bufer
ERROR
Integrity check failed more than once in
last 60 secs.
WARN
UMI initialization failed
ERROR
MIC failed twice in last 60 secs, taking
countermeasures
WARN
UMI initialization failed
ERROR
Failed to set dot11 port status
WARN
Error from pnacEapDemoAuthLibInit:
malloc failed
ERROR
PTK state machine in NO_STATE.
WARN
Error from pnacEapDemoAuthRecv:
received null EAP pkt
ERROR
PTK state machine in NO_STATE!!
WARN
Error from pnacEapDemoAuthRecv:
send “
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
267
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
PMKSA refcount not 1
WARN
Error from pnacRadXlateASAdd: cannot
open socket
ERROR
IV veriication failednknown subtype>
WARN
Error from pnacRadXlateDemoRecv:
received null EAP pkt
ERROR
pnacIfConig: overwriting previous
interface “
WARN
From pnacRadXlateDemoRecv: send “
ERROR
pnacIfConig: overwriting previous “
WARN
Error from pnacRadXlateDemoRecv:
RADIUS “
ERROR
pnacIfConig: overwriting previous
username”
WARN
pnacIfConig: overwriting previous
password”
WARN
%s: Failed to set port status
WARN
%s: Failed to notify event to dot11
WARN
pnacLibDeinit: Failed to destroy the
phyPort:%s
WARN
pnacPortPaeDeconig:kpnacPortPaeDeco
nig failed
WARN
pnacPortPaeDeconig:kpnacPortPaeDeco
nig failed
WARN
pnacBackAuthSuccess: failed to notify the
destination “
WARN
could not initialize MGMT framework
ERROR
umiInit failed
ERROR
iappInit failed
ERROR
could not initialize IAPP MGMT.
ERROR
Error from pnacEapDemoSuppRecv:
send ptr to pnac supplicant”
ERROR
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
From pnacEapDemoSuppRecv: user
info not entered yet
ERROR
bufer length not speciied
ERROR
Error from pnacEapDemoSuppRecv:
couldn’t “
ERROR
Invalid length(%d) speciied
ERROR
MDString: adpDigestInit for md5 failed
ERROR
Failed to get information about
authorized AP list.
ERROR
pnacUmiInit: UMI initialization failed
ERROR
Recd IE data for non-existent AP %s
ERROR
could not start PNAC task
ERROR
Recd IE data for wrong AP %s
ERROR
invalid aruments
ERROR
Received Invalid IE data from WSC
ERROR
pnacIfNameToIndex failed
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Error from pnacRadXlateDemoRecv:
RADIUS “
Error from
pnacRadXlateRadIdRespSend: send to
failed
Error from
pnacRadXlateRadNonIdRespSend: send
to failed
Error from pnacRadXlateRadRecvProc:
recvfrom failed
From pnacRadXlateRadPktIntegrityChk:
no corresponding “
Error from
pnacRadXlateRadPktIntegrityChk: no
message “
Error from
pnacRadXlateRadPktIntegrityChk: “
From pnacRadXlateRadChalPktHandle:
no encapsulated eap “
Error from
pnacRadXlateRadChalPktHandle:
malloc for eap “
Error from
pnacEapDemoSuppUserInfoRegister:
invalid “
Error from pnacEapDemoSuppRecv:
received null EAP pkt
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
268
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
pnacPhyPortParamSet: device invalid
%s%d
pnacPhyPortParamSet: EIOCGADDR
ioctl failed
pnacPhyPortParamSet: multicast addr
add ioctl failed
pnacPhyPortParamUnset: multicast
addr del ioctl failed
Recd IE data for non-existent AP %s
ERROR
Recd WSC Start command without
interface name
ERROR
Recd WSC start for non-existent AP %s
ERROR
Recd WSC start for wrong AP %s
ERROR
Unable to send WSC_WLAN_CMD_PORT
to WSC
ERROR
pnacPDUXmit: Invalid arguments
ERROR
Failed to get the ap context for %s
ERROR
pnacPDUXmit: failed to get M_BLK_ID
ERROR
WPS can only be applied to WPA/WPA2
security proiles
ERROR
wpsEnable: running wsccmd failed
ERROR
Failed to get the ap context for %s
ERROR
pnacSendRtn: Invalid arguments
ERROR
ERROR
pnacSendRtn: no physical port
corresponding to”
ERROR
ERROR
pnacSendRtn: dropping packet as port”
ERROR
WPS conf. under non WPA/WPA2 security
setting
Failed to reset the Beacon Frame IE in the
driver
Failed to reset the Beacon Frame IE in the
driver
WPS method cannot be NULL
PIN value length should be a multiple of
4 !!
Failed to initiate PIN based association,
PIN = %s
Failed to initiate PBC based enrolle
association
Invalid association mode. (Allowed modes
: PIN/PBC)
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
from pnacIsInterfaceUp: device %s%d
invalid
pnacRecvRtn: dropping received packet
as port is”
pnacAuthBuildRC4KeyDesc:
adpEncryptInit(RC4) failed
pnacAuthBuildRC4KeyDesc:
adpCipherContextCtrl”
pnacDot11UserSet: incorrect bufer
length
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
PNAC user component id not set.
ERROR
ERROR
pnacKeyInfoGet:failed to allocate bufer
ERROR
ERROR
PNAC user comp id not set. dropping
EAPOL key pkt
pnacUmiPortPaeParamSet: invalid
bufer received
ERROR
wpsEnable: running wsccmd failed
ERROR
Failed to send QUIT command to WSC
from DOT11
ERROR
Error from pnacRecvASInfoMessage: “
ERROR
Failed to clear of the WPS process
ERROR
pnacRecvASInfoMessage: “
ERROR
missing proile name
ERROR
pnacRecvASInfoMessage: Bad info
length
ERROR
A proile exists with the same name
ERROR
Error from pnacLibInit: malloc failed
ERROR
Error in allocating memory for proile
ERROR
could not create phy ports lock
ERROR
missing proile name
ERROR
could not create nodes ports lock
ERROR
missing proile name
ERROR
port exists for iface - %s
ERROR
Proile name and interface name must be
speciied
ERROR
pnacPhyPortCreate failed
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
kpnacPhyPortCreate failed
ERROR
Could not set proile %s on the interface
%s
ERROR
invalid argument
ERROR
missing proile name
ERROR
pnacAuthConig: maxAuth limit
reached
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
pnacAuthConig: malloc failed
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
SSID should not be longer than %d
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Error from pnacAuthConig: pAsArg
cannot be NULL
Error from pnacAuthConig: receive
routine hook “
pnacAuthConig: pnacAuthInit failed
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
269
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
kpnacPortPaeConig failed
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Invalid arguments
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
SSID not set. SSID is needed to generate
password hash
ERROR
Password string too big
ERROR
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Hex string should only have %d hex chars
ERROR
dot11Malloc failed
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
invalid key index %d. key index should be
0-3.
ERROR
wepKey length incorrect
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Invalid Cipher type %d
ERROR
Proile supports WEP stas,Group cipher
must be WEP
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
invalid pairwise cipher type %d
ERROR
Cipher %s is already in the list.
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Invalid Cipher type %d
ERROR
Cipher %s not found in the list.
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Auth method %s is already in the list
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Auth method %s not found in the list.
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Error from pnacSuppConig: malloc
failed
Error from pnacSuppConig: receive
routine hook “
Error from pnacSuppConig:
pnacSuppInit failed
kpnacPortPaeConig failed
pnacAuthDeconig failed: pPortPae
NULL
Error from pnacPhyPortDestroy: port
not conigured
pnacPhyPortDestroy: Failed to
deconigure port
pnacPhyPortParamUnset FAILED
Error from pnacPhyPortCreate: malloc
failed
Error from pnacPhyPortCreate:
pnacPhyPortParamSet”
error from pnacPhyPortCreate: malloc
failed
Error from pnacAuthInit:
pnacPortTimersInit failed
Error from pnacAuthInit:
pnacAuthPAEInit failed
Error from pnacAuthInit:
pnacAuthKeyTxInit failed
Error from pnacAuthInit:
pnacReauthTimerInit failed
Error from pnacAuthInit:
pnacBackAuthInit failed
Error from pnacAuthInit: pnacCtrlDirInit
failed
Error from pnacAuthInit:
pnacKeyRecvInit failed
Error from pnacSuppInit: malloc failed
Error from pnacSuppInit:
pnacPortTimersInit failed
Error from pnacSuppInit:
pnacKeyRecvInit failed
Error from pnacSuppInit:
pnacSuppKeyTxInit failed
Error from pnacSuppInit:
pnacSuppPAEInit failed
Error from pnacRecvRtn: invalid
arguments
Error from pnacRecvMapi: unsupported
PDU received
suppToACSendRtn returned not OK!
Error from pnacBasicPktCreate: malloc
failed
Error from pnacEAPPktCreate: basic pkt
create failed
Error from pnacTxCannedFail: eap pkt
create failed
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
270
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Error from pnacTxCannedSuccess: eap
pkt create failed
Error from pnacTxReqId: eap pkt create
failed
Error from pnacTxReq: eap pkt create
failed
Error from pnacSendRespToServer:
malloc failed
Error from pnacSendRespToServer: no
AS conigured
Error from pnacTxStart: basic pkt create
failed
Error from pnacTxStart: basic pkt create
failed
Error from pnacTxRspId: eap pkt create
failed
Error from pnacTxRspAuth: eap pkt
create failed
Error from pnacEapPktRecord: EAP
packet too”
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
invalid type value %d. supported values
are 1,2,3,4
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
invalid type value %d. supported values
are 1,2,3,4
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
invalid type value %d. supported values
are 1,2,3,4
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
invalid type value %d. supported values
are 1,2,3,4
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
invalid type value %d. supported values
are 1,2,3,4
ERROR
Proile %s does not exist
ERROR
ERROR: incomplete DB update
information.
ERROR
old values result does not contain 2 rows
ERROR
hmac_md5:adpHmacInit failed
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
pnacUmiIoctlHandler: invalid cmd: %d
ERROR
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
ERROR: incomplete DB update
information.
ERROR
pnacXmit : umiIoctl failed[%d]
ERROR
old values result does not contain 2 rows
ERROR
pnacPDUForward: Invalid input
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
Error in executing DB update handler
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed.Query:%s
ERROR
startStopVap failed to stop %s
ERROR
Invalid SQLITE operation code - %d
ERROR
./src/dot11/mgmt/dot11Mgmt.c:1177:
ADP_ERROR (
only delete event expected on
dot11RogueAP.
ERROR
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
unhandled database operation %d
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Error from pnacEapPktRecord: “
from pnacBackAuthTimeout: calling
pnacTxCannedFail
hmac_md5: adpHmacContextCreate
failed
pnacEapRadAuthSend: Invalid
arguments
pnacEapRadAuthSend: failed to allocate
inbufer
pnacPDUForward: error in getting port
pae information
pnacPDUForward: error allocating
memory
pnacUmiIfMacAddrChange: %s not
conigured for 802.1x
pnacUmiIfMacAddrChange: could not
process PDU received”
pnacUmiPhyPortConig: Invalid conig
data
pnacUmiPhyPortConig: Invalid
backend name speciied
pnacUmiPhyPortConig: could not
create PNAC physical”
pnacUmiAuthConig: Invalid conig
data
pnacUmiAuthConig: Invalid backend
name speciied
unable to create new EAP context.
unable to apply %s proile on the EAP
context.
pnacUmiAuthConig: could not
conigure PNAC PAE “
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
271
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
pnacUmiSuppConig: Invalid conig
data
pnacUmiSuppConig: Invalid backend
name speciied
pnacUmiSuppConig: %s not
conigured for 802.1x
pnacUmiSuppConig: could not PNAC
port Access”
pnacUmiSuppConig: Failed to register
user information
pnacPortByMacDeconig: port not
found
pnacPortByMacDeconig: port not
found
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
failed to conigure WPS on %s
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
no VAP rows returned. expected one
ERROR
pnacUmiIfDown: Invalid conig data
ERROR
multiple VAP rows returned. expected one
ERROR
pnacUmiIfDown: Invalid conig data
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
invalid query result. ncols=%d nrows=%d
ERROR
%s:VAP(%s) create failed
ERROR
sqlite3QueryResGet failed
ERROR
invalid query result. ncols=%d nrows=%d
ERROR
Error from pnacPortDeconig: port not
conigured
pnacUmiIfDown: could not deconigure port
pnacUmiPhyPortDestroy: Invalid conig
data
pnacUmiPhyPortDestroy: Invalid conig
data
pnacUmiPhyPortDestroy: Failed to
destroy the port
Invalid conig data
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
Facility: Kernel
Log Message
Severity
Log Message
Severity
DNAT: multiple ranges no longer supported
DEBUG
%s: %s%s:%d -> %s:%d %s,
DEBUG
DNAT: Target size %u wrong for %u ranges,
DEBUG
%s: %s%s:%d %s,
DEBUG
DNAT: wrong table %s, tablename
DEBUG
%s: Failed to add WDS MAC: %s, dev>name,
DEBUG
DNAT: hook mask 0x%x bad, hook_mask
DEBUG
%s: Device already has WDS mac
address attached,
DEBUG
%s%d: resetting MPPC/MPPE compressor,
DEBUG
%s: Added WDS MAC: %s, dev->name,
DEBUG
%s%d: wrong ofset value: %d,
DEBUG
%s: WDS MAC address %s is not
known by this interface,
DEBUG
%s%d: wrong length of match value: %d,
DEBUG
[madwii] %s() : Not enough space.,
__FUNCTION__
DEBUG
%s%d: too big ofset value: %d,
DEBUG
Returning to chan %d, ieeeChan
DEBUG
%s%d: cannot decode ofset value,
DEBUG
WEP
DEBUG
%s%d: wrong length code: 0x%X,
DEBUG
AES
DEBUG
%s%d: short packet (len=%d), __FUNCTION__,
DEBUG
AES_CCM
DEBUG
%s%d: bad sequence number: %d, expected: %d,
DEBUG
CKIP
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
272
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
%s%d: bad sequence number: %d, expected: %d,
DEBUG
TKIP
DEBUG
PPPIOCDETACH ile->f_count=%d,
DEBUG
%s: cannot map channel to mode; freq
%u lags 0x%x,
DEBUG
PPP: outbound frame not passed
DEBUG
%s: %s, vap->iv_dev->name, buf
DEBUG
PPP: VJ decompression error
DEBUG
%s: [%s] %s, vap->iv_dev->name,
DEBUG
PPP: inbound frame not passed
DEBUG
PPP: reconstructed packet
DEBUG
PPP: no memory for
DEBUG
missed pkts %u..%u,
DEBUG
%s: [%s] %s, vap->iv_dev->name,
ether_sprintf(mac), buf
[%s:%s] discard %s frame, %s, vap>iv_dev->name,
[%s:%s] discard frame, %s, vap->iv_
dev->name,
[%s:%s] discard %s information
element, %s,
[%s:%s] discard information element,
%s,
[%s:%s] discard %s frame, %s, vap>iv_dev->name,
[%s:%s] discard frame, %s, vap->iv_
dev->name,
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s%d: resetting MPPC/MPPE compressor,
DEBUG
%s%d: wrong ofset value: %d,
DEBUG
%s%d: wrong length of match value: %d,
DEBUG
%s%d: too big ofset value: %d,
DEBUG
ifmedia_add: null ifm
DEBUG
%s%d: cannot decode ofset value,
DEBUG
Adding entry for
DEBUG
%s%d: wrong length code: 0x%X,
DEBUG
ifmedia_set: no match for 0x%x/0x%x,
DEBUG
%s%d: short packet (len=%d), __FUNCTION__,
DEBUG
ifmedia_set: target
DEBUG
%s%d: bad sequence number: %d, expected: %d,
DEBUG
ifmedia_set: setting to
DEBUG
%s%d: bad sequence number: %d, expected: %d,
DEBUG
PPPIOCDETACH ile->f_count=%d,
DEBUG
PPP: outbound frame not passed
DEBUG
ifmedia_match: multiple match for
DEBUG
PPP: VJ decompression error
DEBUG

DEBUG
PPP: inbound frame not passed
DEBUG
desc->ifmt_string
DEBUG
PPP: reconstructed packet
DEBUG
mode %s, desc->ifmt_string
DEBUG
PPP: no memory for
DEBUG

DEBUG
DEBUG
%s, desc->ifmt_string
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s%s, seen_option++ ? , : ,
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s%s, seen_option++ ? , : ,
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP %s: _fmt,
DEBUG
%s, seen_option ? > :
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP: --> %s, __FUNCTION__)
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev->name, buf
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP: <-- %s, __FUNCTION__)
DEBUG
%s: recv: , tunnel->name
DEBUG
%s: xmit:, session->name
DEBUG
missed pkts %u..%u,
%s: INC_USE_COUNT, now %d, __FUNCTION__,
mod_use_count \
%s: DEC_USE_COUNT, now %d, __FUNCTION__,
mod_use_count \
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ifmedia_ioctl: no media found for
0x%x,
ifmedia_ioctl: switching %s to , dev>name
%s: no memory for sysctl table!,
__func__
%s: no memory for VAP name!,
__func__
%s: failed to register sysctls!, vap>iv_dev->name
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
273
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
DEBUG
%s: no memory for new proc entry
(%s)!, __func__,
%s: 0x%p len %u, tag, p, len
DEBUG
DEBUG
%03d:, i
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP: --> %s, __FUNCTION__)
DEBUG
%02x, ((u_int8_t *)p)[i]
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP: <-- %s, __FUNCTION__)
DEBUG
irst diference at byte %u, i
DEBUG
%s: recv: , tunnel->name
DEBUG
%s: , t->name
DEBUG
%s: xmit:, session->name
DEBUG
FAIL: ieee80211_crypto_newkey failed
DEBUG
%s: xmit:, session->name
DEBUG
FAIL: ieee80211_crypto_setkey failed
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP %s: _fmt,
DEBUG
FAIL: unable to allocate skbuf
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP: --> %s, __FUNCTION__)
DEBUG
FAIL: wep decap failed
DEBUG
PPPOL2TP: <-- %s, __FUNCTION__)
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s: recv: , tunnel->name
DEBUG
%s: xmit:, session->name
DEBUG
FAIL: decap botch; length mismatch
FAIL: decap botch; data does not
compare
FAIL: wep encap failed
%s: xmit:, session->name
DEBUG
FAIL: encap data length mismatch
DEBUG
IRQ 31 is triggered
DEBUG
FAIL: encrypt data does not compare
DEBUG
[%s:%d] , __func__, __LINE__\
DEBUG
PASS
DEBUG
\t[R%s %#0x %#0x 0x%08x%08x], (status ==
ERROR ? # : ), page, addr, (uint32_t)(*pValue >>
32), (uint32_t)(*pValue & 0xffff )
DEBUG
%u of %u 802.11i WEP test vectors
passed, pass, total
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s: 0x%p len %u, tag, p, len
DEBUG
DEBUG
%03d:, i
DEBUG
DEBUG
%02x, ((u_int8_t *)p)[i]
DEBUG
DEBUG
irst diference at byte %u, i
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s: , t->name
DEBUG
DEBUG
FAIL: ieee80211_crypto_newkey failed
DEBUG
DEBUG
FAIL: ieee80211_crypto_setkey failed
DEBUG
DEBUG
FAIL: unable to allocate skbuf
DEBUG
DEBUG
FAIL: ccmp encap failed
DEBUG
%s: xmit:, session->name
%s: module use_count is %d, __FUNCTION__,
mod_use_count
PPPOL2TP %s: _fmt,
DEBUG
\t[W%s %#0x %#0x 0x%08x%08x], (status ==
ERROR ? # : ), page, addr, (uint32_t)(value >> 32),
(uint32_t)(value & 0xffff )
%s: mac_add
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X, dev>name, addr[0], addr[1], addr[2], addr[3], addr[4],
addr[5]
%s: mac_del
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X, dev>name, addr[0], addr[1], addr[2], addr[3], addr[4],
addr[5]
%s: mac_kick
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X, dev>name, addr[0], addr[1], addr[2], addr[3], addr[4],
addr[5]
%s: mac_undeined
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X, dev>name, addr[0], addr[1], addr[2], addr[3], addr[4],
addr[5]
%s: addr_add
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X, dev>name, addr[0], addr[1], addr[2], addr[3], addr[4],
addr[5]
%s: addr_del
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X, dev>name, addr[0], addr[1], addr[2], addr[3], addr[4],
addr[5]
%s: mac_undeined
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X, dev>name, addr[0], addr[1], addr[2], addr[3], addr[4],
addr[5]
%s: set_loat %d;%d,
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
274
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
IRQ 32 is triggered
DEBUG
FAIL: encap data length mismatch
DEBUG
ip_inish_output2: No header cache and no
neighbour!
DEBUG
FAIL: encrypt data does not compare
DEBUG
a guy asks for address mask. Who is it?
DEBUG
FAIL: ccmp decap failed
DEBUG
icmp v4 hw csum failure)
DEBUG
FAIL: decap botch; length mismatch
DEBUG
expire>> %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
FAIL: decap botch; data does not
compare
DEBUG
expire++ %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
PASS
DEBUG
rt_cache @%02x: %u.%u.%u.%u, hash,
DEBUG
%u of %u 802.11i AES-CCMP test
vectors passed, pass, total
DEBUG
rt_bind_peer(0) @%p, NET_CALLER(iph)
DEBUG
%s: 0x%p len %u, tag, p, len
DEBUG
ip_rt_advice: redirect to
DEBUG
%03d:, i
DEBUG
ip_rt_bug: %u.%u.%u.%u -> %u.%u.%u.%u, %s,
DEBUG
%02x, ((u_int8_t *)p)[i]
DEBUG
udp cork app bug 2)
DEBUG
irst diference at byte %u, i
DEBUG
udp cork app bug 3)
DEBUG
ieee80211_crypto_newkey failed
DEBUG
udp v4 hw csum failure.)
DEBUG
ieee80211_crypto_setkey failed
DEBUG
DEBUG
unable to allocate skbuf
DEBUG
DEBUG
tkip enmic failed
DEBUG
%s: lookup policy [list] found=%s,
DEBUG
enmic botch; length mismatch
DEBUG
%s: called: [output START], __FUNCTION__
DEBUG
enmic botch
DEBUG
DEBUG
tkip encap failed
DEBUG
DEBUG
encrypt phase1 botch
DEBUG
DEBUG
encrypt data length mismatch
DEBUG
DEBUG
encrypt data does not compare
DEBUG
a guy asks for address mask. Who is it?
DEBUG
tkip decap failed
DEBUG
icmp v4 hw csum failure)
DEBUG
decrypt phase1 botch
DEBUG
expire>> %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
decrypt data does not compare
DEBUG
expire++ %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
decap botch; length mismatch
DEBUG
rt_cache @%02x: %u.%u.%u.%u, hash,
DEBUG
decap botch; data does not compare
DEBUG
rt_bind_peer(0) @%p, NET_CALLER(iph)
DEBUG
tkip demic failed
DEBUG
ip_rt_advice: redirect to
DEBUG
802.11i TKIP test vectors passed
DEBUG
ip_rt_bug: %u.%u.%u.%u -> %u.%u.%u.%u, %s,
DEBUG
%s, buf
DEBUG
UDP: short packet: From %u.%u.%u.%u:%u
%d/%d to %u.%u.%u.%u:%u,
DEBUG
Atheros HAL assertion failure: %s: line
%u: %s,
DEBUG
UDP: short packet: From %u.%u.%u.%u:%u
%d/%d to %u.%u.%u.%u:%u,
UDP: bad checksum. From %d.%d.%d.%d:%d to
%d.%d.%d.%d:%d ulen %d,
%s: low dst=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l4_dst, family)
%s: low src=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l4_src, family)
%s: low dst=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l6_dst, family)
%s: low src=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l6_src, family)
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
275
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
UDP: bad checksum. From %d.%d.%d.%d:%d to
%d.%d.%d.%d:%d ulen %d,
DEBUG
ath_hal: logging to %s %s, ath_hal_
logile,
DEBUG
a guy asks for address mask. Who is it?
DEBUG
ath_hal: logging disabled
DEBUG
ib_add_ifaddr: bug: prim == NULL
DEBUG
%s%s, sep, ath_hal_buildopts[i]
DEBUG
ib_del_ifaddr: bug: prim == NULL
DEBUG
ath_pci: No devices found, driver not
installed.
DEBUG
expire>> %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
_fmt, __VA_ARGS__
DEBUG
expire++ %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
%s: Warning, using only %u entries in
%u key cache,
DEBUG
rt_cache @%02x: %u.%u.%u.%u, hash,
DEBUG
%s: TX99 support enabled, dev>name
DEBUG
rt_bind_peer(0) @%p,
DEBUG
%s:grppoll Buf allocation failed
,__func__
DEBUG
ip_rt_advice: redirect to
DEBUG
%s: %s: unable to start recv logic,
DEBUG
ip_rt_bug: %u.%u.%u.%u -> %u.%u.%u.%u, %s,
DEBUG
%s: %s: unable to start recv logic,
DEBUG
%s: lookup policy [list] found=%s,
DEBUG
%s: no skbuf, __func__
DEBUG
%s: called: [output START], __FUNCTION__
DEBUG
%s: hardware error; resetting, dev>name
DEBUG
%s: low dst=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l4_dst, family)
DEBUG
%s: rx FIFO overrun; resetting, dev>name
DEBUG
%s: low src=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l4_src, family)
DEBUG
%s: unable to reset hardware: ‘%s’
(HAL status %u)
DEBUG
%s: low dst=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l6_dst, family)
DEBUG
%s: unable to start recv logic, dev>name
DEBUG
%s: low src=%s, __FUNCTION__,
XFRMSTRADDR(l->l6_src, family)
DEBUG
%s: %s: unable to reset hardware: ‘%s’
(HAL status %u),
DEBUG
a guy asks for address mask. Who is it?
DEBUG
%s: %s: unable to start recv logic,
DEBUG
icmp v4 hw csum failure)
DEBUG
ath_mgtstart: discard, no xmit buf
DEBUG
expire>> %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
%s: [%02u] %-7s , tag, ix, ciphers[hk>kv_type]
DEBUG
expire++ %u %d %d %d, expire,
DEBUG
%02x, hk->kv_val[i]
DEBUG
rt_cache @%02x: %u.%u.%u.%u, hash,
DEBUG
mac %s, ether_sprintf(mac)
DEBUG
rt_bind_peer(0) @%p, NET_CALLER(iph)
DEBUG
%s , sc->sc_splitmic ? mic : rxmic
DEBUG
ip_rt_advice: redirect to
DEBUG
%02x, hk->kv_mic[i]
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
276
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
ip_rt_bug: %u.%u.%u.%u -> %u.%u.%u.%u, %s,
DEBUG
txmic
DEBUG
UDP: short packet: From %u.%u.%u.%u:%u
%d/%d to %u.%u.%u.%u:%u,
DEBUG
%02x, hk->kv_txmic[i]
DEBUG
UDP: bad checksum. From %d.%d.%d.%d:%d to
%d.%d.%d.%d:%d ulen %d,
DEBUG
%s: unable to update h/w beacon
queue parameters,
DEBUG
REJECT: ECHOREPLY no longer supported.
DEBUG
%s: stuck beacon; resetting (bmiss
count %u),
DEBUG
ipt_rpc: only valid for PRE_ROUTING, FORWARD,
POST_ROUTING, LOCAL_IN and/or LOCAL_OUT
targets.
DEBUG
move data from NORMAL to XR
DEBUG
ip_nat_init: can’t setup rules.
DEBUG
moved %d bufers from NORMAL to
XR, index
DEBUG
ip_nat_init: can’t register in hook.
DEBUG
move bufers from XR to NORMAL
DEBUG
ip_nat_init: can’t register out hook.
DEBUG
moved %d bufers from XR to
NORMAL, count
DEBUG
ip_nat_init: can’t register adjust in hook.
DEBUG
%s:%d %s, __FILE__, __LINE__,
__func__
DEBUG
ip_nat_init: can’t register adjust out hook.
DEBUG
%s:%d %s, __FILE__, __LINE__,
__func__
DEBUG
ip_nat_init: can’t register local out hook.
DEBUG
%s: no bufer (%s), dev->name,
__func__
DEBUG
ip_nat_init: can’t register local in hook.
DEBUG
%s: no skbuf (%s), dev->name,
__func__
DEBUG
ipt_hook: happy cracking.
DEBUG
%s: HAL qnum %u out of range, max
%u!,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register pre-routing defrag
hook.
DEBUG
grppoll_start: grppoll Buf allocation
failed
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register local_out defrag
hook.
DEBUG
%s: HAL qnum %u out of range, max
%u!,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register pre-routing hook.
DEBUG
%s: AC %u out of range, max %u!,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register local out hook.
DEBUG
%s: unable to update hardware queue
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register local in helper hook.
DEBUG
%s: bogus frame type 0x%x (%s), dev>name,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register postrouting helper
hook.
DEBUG
ath_stoprecv: rx queue 0x%x, link %p,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register post-routing hook.
DEBUG
%s: %s: unable to reset channel %u
(%u MHz)
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register local in hook.
DEBUG
%s: %s: unable to restart recv logic,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack: can’t register to sysctl.
DEBUG
%s: unable to allocate channel table,
dev->name
DEBUG
ip_conntrack_rtsp v IP_NF_RTSP_VERSION
loading
DEBUG
%s: unable to allocate channel table,
dev->name
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
277
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
ip_conntrack_rtsp: max_outstanding must be a
positive integer
DEBUG
%s: unable to collect channel list from
HAL;
DEBUG
ip_conntrack_rtsp: setup_timeout must be a
positive integer
DEBUG
R (%p %llx) %08x %08x %08x %08x
%08x %08x %c,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack_rtsp: ERROR registering port %d,
ports[i]
DEBUG
T (%p %llx) %08x %08x %08x %08x
%08x %08x %08x %08x %c,
DEBUG
ip_nat_rtsp v IP_NF_RTSP_VERSION loading
DEBUG
%s: no memory for sysctl table!,
__func__
DEBUG
%s: Sorry! Cannot ind this match option., __
FILE__
DEBUG
%s: no memory for device name
storage!, __func__
DEBUG
ipt_time loading
DEBUG
%s: failed to register sysctls!, sc->sc_
dev->name
DEBUG
ipt_time unloaded
DEBUG
%s: mac %d.%d phy %d.%d, dev>name,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack_irc: max_dcc_channels must be a
positive integer
DEBUG
5 GHz radio %d.%d 2 GHz radio
%d.%d,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack_irc: ERROR registering port %d,
DEBUG
radio %d.%d, ah->ah_analog5GhzRev
>> 4,
DEBUG
ip_nat_h323: ip_nat_mangle_tcp_packet
DEBUG
radio %d.%d, ah->ah_analog5GhzRev
>> 4,
DEBUG
ip_nat_h323: ip_nat_mangle_udp_packet
DEBUG
%s: Use hw queue %u for %s traic,
DEBUG
ip_nat_h323: out of expectations
DEBUG
%s: Use hw queue %u for CAB traic,
dev->name,
DEBUG
ip_nat_h323: out of RTP ports
DEBUG
%s: Use hw queue %u for beacons,
dev->name,
DEBUG
ip_nat_h323: out of TCP ports
DEBUG
Could not ind Board Coniguration
Data
DEBUG
ip_nat_q931: out of TCP ports
DEBUG
Could not ind Radio Coniguration
data
DEBUG
ip_nat_ras: out of TCP ports
DEBUG
ath_ahb: No devices found, driver not
installed.
DEBUG
ip_nat_q931: out of TCP ports
DEBUG
_fmt, __VA_ARGS__
DEBUG
ip_conntrack_core: Frag of proto %u.,
DEBUG
_fmt, __VA_ARGS__
DEBUG
Broadcast packet!
DEBUG
xlr8NatIpFinishOutput: Err.. skb2 ==
NULL !
DEBUG
Should bcast: %u.%u.%u.%u->%u.%u.%u.%u
(sk=%p, ptype=%u),
DEBUG
ip_conntrack version %s (%u buckets, %d max)
DEBUG
ERROR registering port %d,
DEBUG
icmpExceptionHandler: Exception!
DEBUG
netilter PSD loaded - (c) astaro AG
DEBUG
fragExceptionHandler: Exception!
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
xlr8NatSoftCtxEnqueue: Calling
xlr8NatIpFinishOutput () .., status
xlr8NatSoftCtxEnqueue:
xlr8NatIpFinishOutput () returned
[%d], status
DEBUG
DEBUG
278
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
netilter PSD unloaded - (c) astaro AG
DEBUG
algExceptionHandler: Exception!
DEBUG
%s , SELF
DEBUG
dnsExceptionHandler: Exception!
DEBUG
%s , LAN
DEBUG
IPsecExceptionHandler: Exception!
DEBUG
%s , WAN
DEBUG
ESP Packet Src:%x Dest:%x Sport:%d
dport:%d secure:%d spi:%d isr:%p,
DEBUG
TRUNCATED
DEBUG
xlr8NatConntrackPreHook: We found
the valid context,
DEBUG
SRC=%u.%u.%u.%u DST=%u.%u.%u.%u ,
DEBUG
xlr8NatConntrackPreHook: Not a
secured packet.
DEBUG
LEN=%u TOS=0x%02X PREC=0x%02X TTL=%u
ID=%u ,
DEBUG
xlr8NatConntrackPreHook: isr=[%p],
pIsr
DEBUG
FRAG:%u , ntohs(ih->frag_of ) & IP_OFFSET
DEBUG
xlr8NatConntrackPreHook:
secure=[%d], secure
DEBUG
TRUNCATED
DEBUG
Context found for ESP %p,pFlowEntry>post.pIsr[0]
DEBUG
PROTO=TCP
DEBUG
xlr8NatConntrackPreHook: New
connection.
DEBUG
INCOMPLETE [%u bytes] ,
DEBUG
xlr8NatConntrackPostHook:
postSecure=[%d] postIsr=[%p %p],
DEBUG
SPT=%u DPT=%u ,
DEBUG
proto %d spi %d <-------> proto %d spi
%d,pPktInfo->proto,pPktInfo->spi,
DEBUG
SEQ=%u ACK=%u ,
DEBUG
IPSEC_INF Clock skew detected
DEBUG
WINDOW=%u , ntohs(th->window)
DEBUG
IPSEC_ERR [%s:%d]: Max (%d) No of
SA Limit reached,
DEBUG
RES=0x%02x , (u8)(ntohl(tcp_lag_word(th) &
TCP_RESERVED_BITS) >> 22)
DEBUG
IPSEC_ERR [%s:%d]: Max (%d) No of
SA Limit reached,
DEBUG
URGP=%u , ntohs(th->urg_ptr)
DEBUG
IPSEC_ERR [%s:%d]: time(secs): %u
DEBUG
TRUNCATED
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
%02X, op[i]
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
PROTO=UDP
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
INCOMPLETE [%u bytes] ,
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
SPT=%u DPT=%u LEN=%u ,
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
SPT=%u DPT=%u LEN=%u ,
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
PROTO=ICMP
DEBUG
unknown oid ‘%s’, varName
DEBUG
INCOMPLETE [%u bytes] ,
DEBUG
could not ind oid pointer for ‘%s’,
varName
DEBUG
TYPE=%u CODE=%u , ich->type, ich->code
DEBUG
unRegistering IPsecMib .....
DEBUG
INCOMPLETE [%u bytes] ,
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
ID=%u SEQ=%u ,
DEBUG
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
279
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
PARAMETER=%u ,
DEBUG
GATEWAY=%u.%u.%u.%u ,
DEBUG
MTU=%u , ntohs(ich->un.frag.mtu)
DEBUG
PROTO=AH
DEBUG
INCOMPLETE [%u bytes] ,
DEBUG
SPI=0x%x , ntohl(ah->spi)
DEBUG
PROTO=ESP
INCOMPLETE [%u bytes] ,
SPI=0x%x , ntohl(eh->spi)
PROTO=%u , ih->protocol
UID=%u , skb->sk->sk_socket->ile->f_uid
<%d>%sIN=%s OUT=%s , loginfo->u.log.level,
level_string
%sIN=%s OUT=%s ,
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s , preix == NULL ? loginfo->preix : preix
DEBUG
IN=
DEBUG
OUT=
PHYSIN=%s , physindev->name
DEBUG
DEBUG
PHYSOUT=%s , physoutdev->name
DEBUG
MAC=
DEBUG
%02x%c, *p,
DEBUG
NAT: no longer support implicit source local NAT
DEBUG
NAT: packet src %u.%u.%u.%u -> dst
%u.%u.%u.%u,
DEBUG
SNAT: multiple ranges no longer supported
DEBUG
format,##args)
DEBUG
version
DEBUG
ofset_before=%d, ofset_after=%d, correction_
pos=%u, x->ofset_before, x->ofset_after,
x->correction_pos
DEBUG
ip_ct_h323:
DEBUG
ip_ct_h323: incomplete TPKT (fragmented?)
DEBUG
ip_ct_h245: decoding error: %s,
DEBUG
ip_ct_h245: packet dropped
DEBUG
ip_ct_q931: decoding error: %s,
DEBUG
ip_ct_q931: packet dropped
DEBUG
ip_ct_ras: decoding error: %s,
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
ERROR: Failed to add entry to IPsec sa
table
unknown oid ‘%s’, varName
could not ind oid pointer for ‘%s’,
varName
unRegistering IPsecMib .....
. %u.%u.%u.%u, NIPQUAD(trt->rt_dst)
%02x, *p
. %u.%u.%u.%u, NIPQUAD(trt->rt_dst)
%02x, *p
. %u.%u.%u.%u, NIPQUAD(trt->rt_dst)
%02x, *p
. %u.%u.%u.%u, NIPQUAD(trt->rt_dst)
%02x, *p
unable to register vIPsec kernel comp
to UMI
unregistering VIPSECK from UMI ....
in vIPsecKIoctlHandler cmd - %d, cmd
%s: Error. DST Refcount value less than
1 (%d),
for %s DEVICE refcnt: %d ,pDst->dev>name,
%s: Got Null m:%p *m:%p sa:%p
*sa:%p,__func__,ppBufMgr,
%s Got Deleted SA:%p state:%d,__
func__,pIPsecInfo,pIPsecInfo->state
%s: %s: fmt, __FILE__, __FUNCTION__
, ## args)
%s: %s: fmt, __FILE__, __FUNCTION__
, ## args)
ipt_TIME: format, ## args)
IPT_ACCOUNT_NAME : checkentry()
wrong parameters (not equals existing
table parameters).
IPT_ACCOUNT_NAME : checkentry()
too big netmask.
IPT_ACCOUNT_NAME : checkentry()
failed to allocate %zu for new table
%s., sizeof(struct t_ipt_account_table),
info->name
IPT_ACCOUNT_NAME : checkentry()
wrong network/netmask.
account: Wrong netmask given by
netmask parameter (%i). Valid is 32 to
0., netmask
IPT_ACCOUNT_NAME : checkentry()
failed to create procfs entry.
IPT_ACCOUNT_NAME : checkentry()
failed to register match.
failed to create procfs entry .
MPPE/MPPC encryption/compression
module registered
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
280
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
DEBUG
DEBUG
MPPE/MPPC encryption/compression
module unregistered
PPP generic driver version PPP_
VERSION
MPPE/MPPC encryption/compression
module registered
MPPE/MPPC encryption/compression
module unregistered
PPP generic driver version PPP_
VERSION
PPPoL2TP kernel driver, %s,
PPPoL2TP kernel driver, %s,
INFO
INFO
DEBUG
PPPoL2TP kernel driver, %s,
INFO
DEBUG
DEBUG
failed to create procfs entry .
proc dir not created ..
INFO
INFO
DEBUG
Initialzing Product Data modules
INFO
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
De initializing by \
kernel UMI module loaded
kernel UMI module unloaded
INFO
INFO
INFO
DEBUG
Loading bridge module
INFO
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
Unloading bridge module
unsupported command %d, cmd
Loading ifDev module
INFO
INFO
INFO
DEBUG
Unloading ifDev module
ERROR#%d in alloc_chrdev_region,
result
ERROR#%d in cdev_add, result
using bcm switch %s, bcmswitch
privlegedID %d wanporttNo: %d,
privlegedID,wanportNo
INFO
ip_ct_ras: packet dropped
DEBUG
ERROR registering port %d,
DEBUG
ERROR registering port %d,
DEBUG
ipt_connlimit [%d]: src=%u.%u.%u.%u:%d
dst=%u.%u.%u.%u:%d %s,
ipt_connlimit [%d]: src=%u.%u.%u.%u:%d
dst=%u.%u.%u.%u:%d new,
ipt_connlimit: Oops: invalid ct state ?
ipt_connlimit: Hmm, kmalloc failed :-(
ipt_connlimit: src=%u.%u.%u.%u
mask=%u.%u.%u.%u
_lvl PPPOL2TP: _fmt, ##args
%02X, ptr[length]
%02X, ((unsigned char *) m->msg_iov[i].iov_
base)[j]
%02X, skb->data[i]
_lvl PPPOL2TP: _fmt, ##args
%02X, ptr[length]
%02X, ((unsigned char *) m->msg_iov[i].iov_
base)[j]
%02X, skb->data[i]
_lvl PPPOL2TP: _fmt, ##args
%02X, ptr[length]
%02X, ((unsigned char *) m->msg_iov[i].iov_
base)[j]
%02X, skb->data[i]
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
KERN_EMERG THE value read is %d,value*/
KERN_EMERG Factory Reset button is pressed
DEBUG
DEBUG
KERN_EMERG Returing error in INTR registration
DEBUG
KERN_EMERG Initialzing Factory defaults
modules
Failed to allocate memory for pSipListNode
SIPALG: Memeory allocation failed for
pSipNodeEntryTbl
pkt-err %s, pktInfo.error
pkt-err %s, pktInfo.error
DEBUG
pkt-err %s, pktInfo.error
DEBUG
%s Len=%d, msg, len
DEBUG
%02x , ((uint8_t *) ptr)[i]
DEBUG
End
CVM_MOD_EXP_BASE MISMATCH cmd=%x
base=%x, cmd,
op->sizeofptr = %ld, op->sizeofptr
opcode cmd = %x, cmd
modexp opcode received
Memory Allocation failed
modexpcrt opcode received
kmalloc failed
kmalloc failed
kmalloc failed
DEBUG
kmalloc failed
kmalloc Failed
DEBUG
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
DEBUG
Loading mii
INFO
DEBUG
Unloading mii
INFO
DEBUG
%s: Version 0.1
INFO
DEBUG
INFO
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
wlan: %s backend registered, be>iab_name
wlan: %s backend unregistered,
wlan: %s acl policy registered, iac>iac_name
wlan: %s acl policy unregistered, iac>iac_name
%s, tmpbuf
DEBUG
VLAN2
INFO
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
VLAN3
VLAN4 <%d %d>,
%s: %s, dev_info, version
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
%s, buf
%s: %s (, dev_info, ath_hal_version
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
%s: %s: mem=0x%lx, irq=%d hw_
base=0x%p,
%s: %s, dev_info, version
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
281
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
kmalloc failed
DEBUG
%s: %s: mem=0x%lx, irq=%d,
INFO
unknown cyrpto ioctl cmd received %x, cmd
DEBUG
%s: %s: mem=0x%lx, irq=%d,
INFO
register_chrdev returned ZERO
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev_info, version
INFO
const char *descr, krb5_keyblock *k) {
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
F password, &pdata
DEBUG
%s, buf
INFO
test key, key
DEBUG
%s: %s (, dev_info, ath_hal_version
INFO
pre-hashed key, key
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
const char *descr, krb5_keyblock *k) {
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
AES 128-bit key, &key
DEBUG
%s: Version 2.0.0
INFO
const char *descr, krb5_keyblock *k) {
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
test key, key
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
pre-hashed key, key
DEBUG
wlan: %s backend registered, be>iab_name
INFO
const char *descr, krb5_keyblock *k) {
DEBUG
wlan: %s backend unregistered,
INFO
128-bit AES key,&dk
DEBUG
wlan: %s acl policy registered, iac>iac_name
INFO
256-bit AES key, &dk
DEBUG
wlan: %s acl policy unregistered, iac>iac_name
INFO
WARNING:
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev_info, version
INFO
bwMonMultipathNxtHopSelect:: checking rates
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
hop :%d dev:%s usableBwLimit = %d
currBwShare = %d lastHopSelected = %d
weightedHopPrefer = %d ,
DEBUG
%s: %s (, dev_info, ath_hal_version
INFO
1. selecting hop: %d lastHopSelected = %d ,
selHop, lastHopSelected
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
4. hop :%d dev:%s usableBwLimit = %d
currBwShare = %d lastHopSelected = %d
weightedHopPrefer = %d ,
DEBUG
%s: %s: mem=0x%lx, irq=%d,
INFO
2. selecting hop: %d lastHopSelected = %d ,
selHop, lastHopSelected
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev_info, version
INFO
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
282
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
3. selecting hop: %d lastHopSelected = %d ,
selHop, lastHopSelected
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
bwMonitor multipath selection enabled
DEBUG
ath_pci: switching rfkill capability %s,
INFO
bwMonitor multipath selection disabled
DEBUG
Unknown autocreate mode: %s,
INFO
weightedHopPrefer set to %d
,weightedHopPrefer
DEBUG
%s: %s: mem=0x%lx, irq=%d,
INFO
bwMonitor sysctl registration failed
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev_info, version
INFO
bwMonitor sysctl registered
DEBUG
%s: driver unloaded, dev_info
INFO
bwMonitor sysctl not registered
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev_info, version
INFO
Unregistered bwMonitor sysctl
DEBUG
%s: unloaded, dev_info
INFO
CONFIG_SYSCTL enabled ...
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev_info, version
INFO
Initialized bandwidth monitor ...
DEBUG
%s: unloaded, dev_info
INFO
Removed bandwidth monitor ...
DEBUG
%s: %s, dev_info, version
INFO
Oops.. AES_GCM_encrypt failed (keylen:%u),key>cvm_keylen
DEBUG
%s: unloaded, dev_info
INFO
Oops.. AES_GCM_decrypt failed (keylen:%u),key>cvm_keylen
DEBUG
failed to create procfs entry .
INFO
%s, msg
DEBUG
ICMP: %u.%u.%u.%u:
INFO
%02x%s, data[i],
DEBUG
ICMP: %u.%u.%u.%u: Source
INFO
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
Wrong address mask %u.%u.%u.%u
from
INFO
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
Redirect from %u.%u.%u.%u on %s
about
INFO
AES %s Encrypt Test Duration: %d:%d, hard ?
Hard : Soft,
DEBUG
IP: routing cache hash table of %u
buckets, %ldKbytes,
INFO
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
source route option %u.%u.%u.%u ->
%u.%u.%u.%u,
INFO
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
ICMP: %u.%u.%u.%u:
INFO
DEBUG
ICMP: %u.%u.%u.%u: Source
Wrong address mask %u.%u.%u.%u
from
Redirect from %u.%u.%u.%u on %s
about
IP: routing cache hash table of %u
buckets, %ldKbytes,
source route option %u.%u.%u.%u ->
%u.%u.%u.%u,
INFO
AES %s Decrypt Test Duration: %d:%d, hard ?
Hard : Soft,
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
Failed to set AES encrypt key
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
283
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Failed to set DES encrypt key[%d], i
DEBUG
Wrong address mask %u.%u.%u.%u
from
Redirect from %u.%u.%u.%u on %s
about
source route option
ICMP: %u.%u.%u.%u:
ICMP: %u.%u.%u.%u: Source
Wrong address mask %u.%u.%u.%u
from
Redirect from %u.%u.%u.%u on %s
about
IP: routing cache hash table of %u
buckets, %ldKbytes,
source route option %u.%u.%u.%u ->
%u.%u.%u.%u,
IPsec: device unregistering: %s, dev>name
INFO
Failed to set DES decrypt key[%d], i
DEBUG
Failed to set DES encrypt key[%d], i
Failed to set DES decrypt key[%d], i
Failed to set DES encrypt key
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
Failed to set DES decrypt key
DEBUG
Failed to set DES encrypt key
DEBUG
Failed to set DES decrypt key
DEBUG
AES Software Test:
DEBUG
AES Software Test %s, aesSoftTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
AES Hardware Test:
DEBUG
IPsec: device down: %s, dev->name
INFO
AES Hardware Test %s, aesHardTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
mark: only supports 32bit mark
WARNING
3DES Software Test:
DEBUG
ipt_time: invalid argument
WARNING
3DES Software Test %s, des3SoftTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
ipt_time: IPT_DAY didn’t matched
WARNING
3DES Hardware Test:
DEBUG
./Logs_kernel.txt:45:KERN_WARNING
WARNING
3DES Hardware Test %s, des3HardTest(0) ? Failed
: Passed
DEBUG
./Logs_kernel.txt:59:KERN_WARNING
WARNING
DES Software Test:
DEBUG
DES Software Test %s, desSoftTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
DES Hardware Test:
DEBUG
DES Hardware Test %s, desHardTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
SHA Software Test:
DEBUG
SHA Software Test %s, shaSoftTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
SHA Hardware Test:
DEBUG
SHA Hardware Test %s, shaHardTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
MD5 Software Test:
DEBUG
MD5 Software Test %s, md5SoftTest(0) ? Failed :
Passed
DEBUG
MD5 Hardware Test:
DEBUG
MD5 Hardware Test %s, md5HardTest(0) ? Failed
: Passed
AES Software Test: %d iterations, iter
AES Software Test Duration: %d:%d,
AES Hardware Test: %d iterations, iter
AES Hardware Test Duration: %d:%d,
3DES Software Test: %d iterations, iter
3DES Software Test Duration: %d:%d,
3DES Hardware Test: %d iterations, iter
3DES Hardware Test Duration: %d:%d,
DES Software Test: %d iterations, iter
DES Software Test Duration: %d:%d,
DES Hardware Test: %d iterations, iter
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
ipt_LOG: not logging via system
console
%s: wrong options length: %u, fname,
opt_len
%s: options rejected: o[0]=%02x,
o[1]=%02x,
%s: wrong options length: %u,
%s: options rejected: o[0]=%02x,
o[1]=%02x,
%s: don’t know what to do:
o[5]=%02x,
%s: wrong options length: %u, fname,
opt_len
%s: options rejected: o[0]=%02x,
o[1]=%02x,
%s: wrong options length: %u,
%s: options rejected: o[0]=%02x,
o[1]=%02x,
%s: don’t know what to do:
o[5]=%02x,
*** New port %d ***, ntohs(expinfo>natport)
** skb len %d, dlen %d,(*pskb)->len,
********** Non linear skb
End of sdp %p, nexthdr
%s: unknown pairwise cipher %d,
%s: unknown group cipher %d,
%s: unknown SIOCSIWAUTH lag %d,
%s: unknown SIOCGIWAUTH lag %d,
%s: unknown algorithm %d,
%s: key size %d is too large,
try_module_get failed \
%s: request_irq failed, dev->name
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
284
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
DES Hardware Test Duration: %d:%d,
SHA Software Test: %d iterations, iter
SHA Software Test Duration: %d:%d,
SHA Hardware Test: %d iterations, iter
SHA Hardware Test Duration: %d:%d,
MD5 Software Test: %d iterations, iter
MD5 Software Test Duration: %d:%d,
MD5 Hardware Test: %d iterations, iter
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
try_module_get failed
try_module_get failed \
%s: unknown pairwise cipher %d,
%s: unknown group cipher %d,
%s: unknown SIOCSIWAUTH lag %d,
%s: unknown SIOCGIWAUTH lag %d,
%s: unknown algorithm %d,
%s: key size %d is too large,
unable to load %s, scan_
modnames[mode]
Failed to mkdir /proc/net/madwii
MD5 Hardware Test Duration: %d:%d,
./pnac/src/pnac/linux/kernel/
xcalibur.c:209:#deine DEBUG_PRINTK printk
bcmDeviceInit: registration failed
DEBUG
bcmDeviceInit: pCdev Add failed
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
DEBUG
try_module_get failed
WARNING
DEBUG
WARNING
WARNING
REG Size == 8 Bit
DEBUG
Value = %x ::: At Page = %x : Addr = %x
DEBUG
REG Size == 16 Bit
DEBUG
Value = %x ::: At Page = %x : Addr = %x
DEBUG
REG Size == 32 Bit
DEBUG
Value = %x ::: At Page = %x : Addr = %x
DEBUG
REG Size == 64 Bit
DEBUG
%s: request_irq failed, dev->name
too many virtual ap’s (already got %d),
sc->sc_nvaps
%s: request_irq failed, dev->name
rix %u (%u) bad ratekbps %u mode
%u,
cix %u (%u) bad ratekbps %u mode
%u,
%s: no rates for %s?,
no rates yet! mode %u, sc->sc_
curmode
%u.%u.%u.%u sent an invalid ICMP
REG Size is not in 8/16/32/64
DEBUG
dst cache overlow
WARNING
Written Value = %x ::: At Page = %x : Addr = %x
DEBUG
Neighbour table overlow.
WARNING
bcm_ioctl :Unknown Ioctl Case :
DEBUG
host %u.%u.%u.%u/if%d ignores
WARNING
=========Register Dump for Port Number #
%d=========,port
DEBUG
martian destination %u.%u.%u.%u
from
WARNING
%s : Read Status=%s data=%#x,regName[j],
DEBUG
martian source %u.%u.%u.%u from
WARNING
%s : Read Status=%s data=%#x,regName[j],
DEBUG
ll header:
WARNING
powerDeviceInit: device registration failed
DEBUG
%u.%u.%u.%u sent an invalid ICMP
WARNING
powerDeviceInit: adding device failed
DEBUG
dst cache overlow
WARNING
%s: Error: Big jump in pn number. TID=%d, from
%x %x to %x %x.
DEBUG
Neighbour table overlow.
WARNING
%s: The MIC is corrupted. Drop this frame.,
__func__
DEBUG
host %u.%u.%u.%u/if%d ignores
WARNING
%s: The MIC is OK. Still use this frame and update
PN., __func__
DEBUG
martian destination %u.%u.%u.%u
from
WARNING
ADDBA send failed: recipient is not a 11n node
DEBUG
martian source %u.%u.%u.%u from
WARNING
Cannot Set Rate: %x, value
DEBUG
ll header:
WARNING
Getting Rate Series: %x,vap->iv_ixed_rate.series
DEBUG
%u.%u.%u.%u sent an invalid ICMP
WARNING
Getting Retry Series: %x,vap->iv_ixed_rate.
retries
DEBUG
dst cache overlow
WARNING
IC Name: %s,ic->ic_dev->name
DEBUG
Neighbour table overlow.
WARNING
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
285
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
usage: rtparams rt_idx <0|1> per <0..100>
probe_intval <0..100>
DEBUG
host %u.%u.%u.%u/if%d ignores
WARNING
usage: acparams ac <0|3> RTS <0|1> aggr scaling
<0..4> min mbps <0..250>
DEBUG
martian source %u.%u.%u.%u from
WARNING
usage: hbrparams ac <2> enable <0|1> per_low
<0..50>
DEBUG
ll header:
WARNING
%s(): ADDBA mode is AUTO, __func__
DEBUG
martian destination %u.%u.%u.%u
from
WARNING
%s(): Invalid TID value, __func__
DEBUG
%u.%u.%u.%u sent an invalid ICMP
WARNING
%s(): ADDBA mode is AUTO, __func__
DEBUG
dst cache overlow
WARNING
%s(): Invalid TID value, __func__
DEBUG
Neighbour table overlow.
WARNING
%s(): Invalid TID value, __func__
DEBUG
host %u.%u.%u.%u/if%d ignores
WARNING
Addba status IDLE
DEBUG
martian destination %u.%u.%u.%u
from
WARNING
%s(): ADDBA mode is AUTO, __func__
DEBUG
martian source %u.%u.%u.%u from
WARNING
%s(): Invalid TID value, __func__
DEBUG
ll header:
WARNING
Error in ADD- no node available
DEBUG
Unable to create ip_set_list
ERROR
%s(): Channel capabilities do not match, chan
lags 0x%x,
DEBUG
Unable to create ip_set_hash
ERROR
%s: cannot map channel to mode; freq %u lags
0x%x,
DEBUG
ip_conntrack_in: Frag of proto %u
(hook=%u),
ERROR
ic_get_currentCountry not initialized yet
DEBUG
Unable to register netilter socket
option
ERROR
Country ie is %c%c%c,
DEBUG
Unable to create ip_conntrack_hash
ERROR
%s: wrong state transition from %d to %d,
DEBUG
Unable to create ip_conntrack slab
cache
ERROR
%s: wrong state transition from %d to %d,
DEBUG
Unable to create ip_expect slab cache
ERROR
%s: wrong state transition from %d to %d,
DEBUG
Unable to create ip_set_iptreeb slab
cache
ERROR
%s: wrong state transition from %d to %d,
DEBUG
Unable to create ip_set_iptreed slab
cache
ERROR
%s: wrong state transition from %d to %d,
DEBUG
%s: cannot allocate space for
%scompressor, fname,
ERROR
%s: wrong state transition from %d to %d,
DEBUG
%s: cannot allocate space for MPPC
history,
ERROR
ieee80211_deliver_l2uf: no buf available
DEBUG
%s: cannot allocate space for MPPC
history,
ERROR
%s: %s, vap->iv_dev->name, buf /* NB: no */
DEBUG
%s: cannot load ARC4 module, fname
ERROR
%s: [%s] %s, vap->iv_dev->name,
DEBUG
%s: cannot load SHA1 module, fname
ERROR
%s: [%s] %s, vap->iv_dev->name, ether_
sprintf(mac), buf
DEBUG
%s: CryptoAPI SHA1 digest size too
small, fname
ERROR
[%s:%s] discard %s frame, %s, vap->iv_dev>name,
DEBUG
%s: cannot allocate space for SHA1
digest, fname
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
286
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
[%s:%s] discard frame, %s, vap->iv_dev->name,
DEBUG
%s%d: trying to write outside history
ERROR
[%s:%s] discard %s information element, %s,
DEBUG
%s%d: trying to write outside history
ERROR
[%s:%s] discard information element, %s,
DEBUG
%s%d: trying to write outside history
ERROR
[%s:%s] discard %s frame, %s, vap->iv_dev>name,
DEBUG
[%s:%s] discard frame, %s, vap->iv_dev->name,
DEBUG
HBR list dumpNode\tAddress\t\t\tState\tTrigger\
tBlock
Nodes informationAddress\t\t\tBlock\t\tDroped
VI frames
%d\t %2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x\t%s\
t%s\t%s,
%2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x:%2.2x\t%s\t\
t%d,
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s%d: too big uncompressed packet:
%d,
%s%d: encryption negotiated but not
an
%s%d: error - not an MPPC or MPPE
frame
Kernel doesn’t provide ARC4 and/or
SHA1 algorithms
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
DEBUG
PPP: not interface or channel??
ERROR
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (VJ compressor)
ERROR
[%d]\tFunction\t%s, j, ni->node_trace[i].funcp
DEBUG
failed to register PPP device (%d), err
ERROR
[%d]\tMacAddr\t%s, j,
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (VJ comp pkt)
ERROR
[%d]\tDescp\t\t%s, j, ni->node_trace[i].descp
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (comp pkt)
ERROR
[%d]\tValue\t\t%llu(0x%llx), j, ni->node_trace[i].
value,
DEBUG
ppp: compressor dropped pkt
ERROR
ifmedia_add: null ifm
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (fragment)
ERROR
Adding entry for
DEBUG
PPP: VJ uncompressed error
ERROR
ifmedia_set: no match for 0x%x/0x%x,
DEBUG
ppp_decompress_frame: no memory
ERROR
ifmedia_set: target
DEBUG
ppp_mp_reconstruct bad seq %u <
%u,
ERROR
ifmedia_set: setting to
DEBUG
PPP: couldn’t register device %s (%d),
ERROR
ifmedia_ioctl: switching %s to , dev->name
DEBUG
ppp: destroying ppp struct %p but
dead=%d
ERROR
ifmedia_match: multiple match for
DEBUG
ppp: destroying undead channel %p !,
ERROR

DEBUG
PPP: removing module but units
remain!
ERROR
desc->ifmt_string
DEBUG
PPP: failed to unregister PPP device
ERROR
mode %s, desc->ifmt_string
DEBUG

DEBUG
%s, desc->ifmt_string
DEBUG
%s%s, seen_option++ ? , : ,
DEBUG
%s: cannot load ARC4 module, fname
ERROR
%s%s, seen_option++ ? , : ,
DEBUG
%s: cannot load SHA1 module, fname
ERROR
%s, seen_option ? > :
DEBUG
%s: CryptoAPI SHA1 digest size too
small, fname
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
%s: cannot allocate space for
%scompressor, fname,
%s: cannot allocate space for MPPC
history,
%s: cannot allocate space for MPPC
history,
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
287
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
%s: %s, dev->name, buf
DEBUG
%s: cannot allocate space for SHA1
digest, fname
ERROR
%s: no memory for sysctl table!, __func__
DEBUG
%s%d: trying to write outside history
ERROR
%s: failed to register sysctls!, vap->iv_dev->name
DEBUG
%s%d: trying to write outside history
ERROR
Atheros HAL assertion failure: %s: line %u: %s,
DEBUG
%s%d: trying to write outside history
ERROR
ath_hal: logging to %s %s, ath_hal_logile,
DEBUG
%s%d: too big uncompressed packet:
%d,
ERROR
ath_hal: logging disabled
DEBUG
%s%d: encryption negotiated but not
an
ERROR
%s%s, sep, ath_hal_buildopts[i]
DEBUG
%s%d: error - not an MPPC or MPPE
frame
ERROR
ath_pci: No devices found, driver not installed.
DEBUG
Kernel doesn’t provide ARC4 and/or
SHA1 algorithms
ERROR
---:%d pri:%d qd:%u ad:%u sd:%u tot:%u amp:%d
%02x:%02x:%02x,
DEBUG
PPP: not interface or channel??
ERROR
SC Pushbutton Notify on %s::%s,dev->name,vap>iv_dev->name
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (VJ compressor)
ERROR
Could not ind Board Coniguration Data
DEBUG
failed to register PPP device (%d), err
ERROR
Could not ind Radio Coniguration data
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (comp pkt)
ERROR
%s: No device, __func__
DEBUG
ppp: compressor dropped pkt
ERROR
ath_ahb: No devices found, driver not installed.
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (VJ comp pkt)
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s:proc_dointvec failed, __
FUNCTION__
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (comp pkt)
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s:proc_dointvec failed, __
FUNCTION__
DEBUG
PPP: no memory (fragment)
ERROR
%s: failed to register sysctls!, proc_name
DEBUG
PPP: VJ uncompressed error
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s: proc_mkdir failed, __
FUNCTION__
DEBUG
ppp_decompress_frame: no memory
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s: pktlog_attach failed for %s,
DEBUG
ppp_mp_reconstruct bad seq %u <
%u,
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s:allocation failed for pl_info,
__FUNCTION__
DEBUG
PPP: couldn’t register device %s (%d),
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s:allocation failed for pl_info,
__FUNCTION__
DEBUG
ppp: destroying ppp struct %p but
dead=%d
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s: create_proc_entry failed for %s,
DEBUG
ppp: destroying undead channel %p !,
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s: sysctl register failed for %s,
DEBUG
PPP: removing module but units
remain!
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s: page fault out of range, __
FUNCTION__
DEBUG
PPP: failed to unregister PPP device
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s: page fault out of range, __
FUNCTION__
DEBUG
JBD: bad block at ofset %u,
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG %s: Log bufer unavailable, __
FUNCTION__
DEBUG
JBD: corrupted journal superblock
ERROR
PKTLOG_TAG
DEBUG
JBD: bad block at ofset %u,
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
288
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Logging should be disabled before changing
bufer size
DEBUG
JBD: Failed to read block at ofset %u,
ERROR
%s:allocation failed for pl_info, __func__
DEBUG
JBD: error %d scanning journal, err
ERROR
%s: Unable to allocate bufer, __func__
DEBUG
JBD: IO error %d recovering block
ERROR
%s:allocation failed for pl_info, __func__
DEBUG
./Logs_kernel.txt:303:KERN_ERR
ERROR
%s: Unable to allocate bufer, __func__
DEBUG
./Logs_kernel.txt:304:KERN_ERR
ERROR
Atheros HAL assertion failure: %s: line %u: %s,
DEBUG
JBD: recovery pass %d ended at
ERROR
ath_hal: logging to %s %s, ath_hal_logile,
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD SESSION MAGIC \
ERROR
ath_hal: logging disabled
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC \
ERROR
%s%s, sep, ath_hal_buildopts[i]
DEBUG
msg->msg_namelen wrong, %d, msg>msg_namelen
ERROR
failed to allocate rx descriptors: %d, error
DEBUG
addr family wrong: %d, usin->sin_
family
ERROR
ath_stoprecv: rx queue %p, link %p,
DEBUG
udp addr=%x/%hu, usin->sin_addr.s_
addr, usin->sin_port
ERROR
no mpdu (%s), __func__
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
Reset rx chain mask. Do internal reset. (%s),
__func__
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
OS_CANCEL_TIMER failed!!
DEBUG
socki_lookup: socket ile changed!
ERROR
%s: unable to allocate channel table, __func__
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
%s: unable to collect channel list from hal;
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD SESSION MAGIC \
ERROR
%s: cannot map channel to mode; freq %u lags
0x%x,
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC \
ERROR
%s: unable to reset channel %u (%uMhz)
DEBUG
msg->msg_namelen wrong, %d, msg>msg_namelen
ERROR
%s: unable to restart recv logic,
DEBUG
addr family wrong: %d, usin->sin_
family
ERROR
%s: start DFS WAIT period on channel %d, __
func__,sc->sc_curchan.channel
DEBUG
udp addr=%x/%hu, usin->sin_addr.s_
addr, usin->sin_port
ERROR
%s: cancel DFS WAIT period on channel %d,
__func__, sc->sc_curchan.channel
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
Non-DFS channel, cancelling previous DFS wait
timer channel %d, sc->sc_curchan.channel
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
%s: unable to reset hardware; hal status %u
DEBUG
socki_lookup: socket ile changed!
ERROR
%s: unable to start recv logic, __func__
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
%s: unable to start recv logic, __func__
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD SESSION MAGIC \
ERROR
%s: unable to reset hardware; hal status %u,
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC \
ERROR
hardware error; reseting
DEBUG
msg->msg_namelen wrong, %d, msg>msg_namelen
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
289
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
rx FIFO overrun; reseting
DEBUG
addr family wrong: %d, usin->sin_
family
ERROR
%s: During Wow Sleep and got BMISS, __func__
DEBUG
udp addr=%x/%hu, usin->sin_addr.s_
addr, usin->sin_port
ERROR
AC\tRTS \tAggr Scaling\tMin Rate(Kbps)\tHBR \
tPER LOW THRESHOLD
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
BE\t%s\t\t%d\t%6d\t\t%s\t%d,
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
BK\t%s\t\t%d\t%6d\t\t%s\t%d,
DEBUG
socki_lookup: socket ile changed!
ERROR
VI\t%s\t\t%d\t%6d\t\t%s\t%d,
DEBUG
%s: %s:%d: BAD TUNNEL MAGIC
ERROR
VO\t%s\t\t%d\t%6d\t\t%s\t%d,
DEBUG
rebootHook: null function pointer
ERROR
--%d,%p,%lu:0x%x 0x%x 0x%p 0x%x 0x%x 0x%x
0x%x,
DEBUG
Bad ioctl command
ERROR
bb state: 0x%08x 0x%08x, bbstate(sc, 4ul),
bbstate(sc, 5ul)
DEBUG
fResetMod: Failed to conigure gpio
pin
ERROR
%08x %08x %08x %08x %08x %08x %08x
%08x%08x %08x %08x %08x,
DEBUG
fResetMod: Failed to register interrupt
handler
ERROR
noise loor: (%d, %d) (%d, %d) (%d, %d),
DEBUG
registering char device failed
ERROR
%p: %08x %08x %08x %08x %08x %08x %08x
%08x %08x %08x %08x %08x,
DEBUG
unregistering char device failed
ERROR
--%d,%p,%lu:0x%x 0x%x 0x%p 0x%x 0x%x 0x%x
0x%x,
DEBUG
proc entry delete failed
ERROR
%08x %08x %08x %08x %08x %08x %08x
%08x%08x %08x %08x %08x,
DEBUG
proc entry initialization failed
ERROR
%s: unable to allocate device object., __func__
DEBUG
testCompHandler: received %s from
%d, (char *)pInBuf,
ERROR
%s: unable to attach hardware; HAL status %u,
DEBUG
UMI proto registration failed %d,ret
ERROR
%s: HAL ABI msmatch;
DEBUG
AF_UMI registration failed %d,ret
ERROR
%s: Warning, using only %u entries in %u key
cache,
DEBUG
umi initialization failed %d,ret
ERROR
unable to setup a beacon xmit queue!
DEBUG
kernel UMI registration failed!
ERROR
unable to setup CAB xmit queue!
DEBUG
./Logs_kernel.txt:447:KERN_ERR
ERROR
unable to setup xmit queue for BE traic!
DEBUG
ERROR msm not found properly %d,
len %d, msm,
ERROR
%s DFS attach failed, __func__
DEBUG
ModExp returned Error
ERROR
%s: Invalid interface id = %u, __func__, if_id
DEBUG
ModExp returned Error
ERROR
%s:grppoll Buf allocation failed ,__func__
DEBUG
%s: 0x%p len %u, tag, p, (unsigned
int)len
ERROR
%s: unable to start recv logic,
DEBUG
%03d:, i
ERROR
%s: Invalid interface id = %u, __func__, if_id
DEBUG
%02x, ((unsigned char *)p)[i]
ERROR
%s: unable to allocate channel table, __func__
DEBUG
mic check failed
ERROR
%s: Tx Antenna Switch. Do internal reset., __
func__
DEBUG
%s: 0x%p len %u, tag, p, (unsigned
int)len
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
290
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Radar found on channel %d (%d MHz),
DEBUG
%03d:, i
ERROR
End of DFS wait period
DEBUG
%02x, ((unsigned char *)p)[i]
ERROR
%s error allocating beacon, __func__
DEBUG
mic check failed
ERROR
failed to allocate UAPSD QoS NULL tx descriptors:
%d, error
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
failed to allocate UAPSD QoS NULL wbuf
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong Key length, __func__
ERROR
%s: unable to allocate channel table, __func__
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
%s: unable to update h/w beacon queue
parameters,
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong Key length, __func__
ERROR
ALREADY ACTIVATED
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
%s: missed %u consecutive beacons,
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong Key length, __func__
ERROR
%s: busy times: rx_clear=%d, rx_frame=%d, tx_
frame=%d, __func__, rx_clear, rx_frame, tx_frame
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
%s: unable to obtain busy times, __func__
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong Key length, __func__
ERROR
%s: beacon is oicially stuck,
DEBUG
[%s]: Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
Busy environment detected
DEBUG
Inteference detected
DEBUG
rx_clear=%d, rx_frame=%d, tx_frame=%d,
DEBUG
%s: resume beacon xmit after %u misses,
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
%s: stuck beacon; resetting (bmiss count %u),
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong Key Length, __func__
ERROR
EMPTY QUEUE
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
SWRInfo: seqno %d isswRetry %d retryCnt %d,wh
? (*(u_int16_t *)&wh->i_seq[0]) >> 4 : 0, bf->bf_
isswretry,bf->bf_swretries
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong Key Length, __func__
ERROR
Bufer #%08X --> Next#%08X Prev#%08X
Last#%08X,bf, TAILQ_NEXT(bf,bf_list),
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
Stas#%08X lag#%08X Node#%08X,
bf->bf_status, bf->bf_lags, bf->bf_node
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
Descr #%08X --> Next#%08X Data#%08X
Ctl0#%08X Ctl1#%08X, bf->bf_daddr, ds->ds_
link, ds->ds_data, ds->ds_ctl0, ds->ds_ctl1
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
Ctl2#%08X Ctl3#%08X Sta0#%08X
Sta1#%08X,ds->ds_hw[0], ds->ds_hw[1], lastds>ds_hw[2], lastds->ds_hw[3]
DEBUG
[%s] Wrong parameters, __func__
ERROR
Error entering wow mode
DEBUG
device name=%s not found, pReq>ifName
ERROR
Wakingup due to wow signal
DEBUG
unable to register KIFDEV to UMI
ERROR
%s, wowStatus = 0x%x, __func__, wowStatus
DEBUG
ERROR: %s: Timeout at page %#0x
addr %#0x
ERROR
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
[%s] Wrong Key Length %d, __func__,
des_key_len
[%s] Wrong parameters %d, __func__,
des_key_len
[%s] Wrong Key Length %d, __func__,
des_key_len
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
291
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
Pattern added already
DEBUG
ERROR: %s: Timeout at page %#0x
addr %#0x
ERROR
Error : All the %d pattern are in use. Cannot add a
new pattern , MAX_NUM_PATTERN
DEBUG
Invalid IOCTL %#08x, cmd
ERROR
Pattern added to entry %d ,i
DEBUG
Remove wake up pattern
DEBUG
mask = %p pat = %p ,maskBytes,patternBytes
DEBUG
mask = %x pat = %x ,(u_int32_t)maskBytes,
(u_int32_t)patternBytes
DEBUG
Pattern Removed from entry %d ,i
DEBUG
Error : Pattern not found
DEBUG
PPM STATE ILLEGAL %x %x, forcePpmStateCur,
afp->forceState
DEBUG
ath_dev_probe: no memory for device
state
ERROR
FORCE_PPM %4d %6.6x %8.8x %8.8x %8.8x
%3.3x %4.4x,
DEBUG
%s: no memory for device state,
__func__
ERROR
failed to allocate tx descriptors: %d, error
failed to allocate beacon descripotrs: %d, error
failed to allocate UAPSD descripotrs: %d, error
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
hal qnum %u out of range, max %u!,
DEBUG
HAL AC %u out of range, max %zu!,
HAL AC %u out of range, max %zu!,
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s: unable to update hardware queue %u!,
DEBUG
Multicast Q:
DEBUG
%p , buf
DEBUG
buf lags - 0x%08x --------- , buf->bf_lags
DEBUG
buf status - 0x%08x, buf->bf_status
DEBUG
# frames in aggr - %d, length of aggregate - %d,
length of frame - %d, sequence number - %d,
tidno - %d,
DEBUG
Unable to load needed module: %s;
no support for \
ERROR
isdata: %d isaggr: %d isampdu: %d ht: %d
isretried: %d isxretried: %d shpreamble: %d isbar:
%d ispspoll: %d aggrburst: %d calcairtime: %d
qosnulleosp: %d,
DEBUG
Module \%s\ is not known, buf
ERROR
%p: 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x
0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x,
DEBUG
Error loading module \%s\, buf
ERROR
0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x
0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x,
DEBUG
Module \%s\ failed to initialize, buf
ERROR
0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x 0x%08x,
DEBUG
ath_pci: 32-bit DMA not available
ERROR
sc_txq[%d] : , i
DEBUG
tid %p pause %d : , tid, tid->paused
DEBUG
%d: %p , j, tid->tx_buf[j]
DEBUG
%p , buf
DEBUG
axq_q:
DEBUG
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
%s: unable to register device, dev>name
ath_pci: 32-bit DMA not available
ath_pci: cannot reserve PCI memory
region
ath_pci: cannot remap PCI memory
region) ;
ath_pci: no memory for device state
%s: unable to register device, dev>name
kernel MIBCTL registration failed!
Bad ioctl command
WpsMod: Failed to conigure gpio pin
WpsMod: Failed to register interrupt
handler
registering char device failed
unregistering char device failed
%s:%d - ERROR: non-NULL node
pointer in %p, %p<%s>!
%s:%d - ERROR: non-NULL node
pointer in %p, %p<%s>!
can’t alloc name %s, name
%s: unable to register device, dev>name
failed to automatically load module:
%s; \
ath_pci: cannot reserve PCI memory
region
ath_pci: cannot remap PCI memory
region) ;
ath_pci: no memory for device state
%s: unable to attach hardware: ‘%s’
(HAL status %u),
%s: HAL ABI mismatch;
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
292
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
%s: unable to reset hardware; hal status %u,
__func__, status
DEBUG
****ASSERTION HIT****
DEBUG
MacAddr=%s,
DEBUG
TxBufIdx=%d, i
DEBUG
Tid=%d, tidno
DEBUG
AthBuf=%p, tid->tx_buf[i]
DEBUG
%s: unable to reset hardware; hal status %u,
DEBUG
%s: unable to reset hardware; hal status %u,
DEBUG
%s: unable to start recv logic,
DEBUG
_fmt, __VA_ARGS__ \
DEBUG
sample_pri=%d is a multiple of refpri=%d,
sample_pri, refpri
DEBUG
===========ft->ft_
numilters=%u===========, ft->ft_numilters
DEBUG
%s: SKB does not exist., __
FUNCTION__
ERROR
ilter[%d] ilterID = %d rf_numpulses=%u;
rf->rf_minpri=%u; rf->rf_maxpri=%u; rf>rf_threshold=%u; rf->rf_ilterlen=%u; rf->rf_
mindur=%u; rf->rf_maxdur=%u,j, rf->rf_pulseid,
DEBUG
%s: recvd invalid skb
ERROR
DEBUG
unable to register KIFDEV to UMI
The system is going to factory
defaults........!!!
%s, msg
%02x, *(data + i)
Inside crypt_open in driver ######
Inside crypt_release in driver ######
ERROR
NOL
WARNING!!! 10 minute CAC period as channel is a
weather radar channel
%s disable detects, __func__
%s enable detects, __func__
%s disable FFT val=0x%x , __func__, val
%s enable FFT val=0x%x , __func__, val
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
DEBUG
%s: failed to allocate descriptors: %d,
%s: unable to setup a beacon xmit
queue!,
%s: unable to setup CAB xmit queue!,
%s: unable to setup xmit queue for %s
traic!,
%s: unable to register device, dev>name
%s: autocreation of VAP failed: %d,
ath_dev_probe: no memory for device
state
kdot11RogueAPEnable called with
NULL argument.
kdot11RogueAPEnable: can not add
more interfaces
kdot11RogueAPGetState called with
NULL argument.
kdot11RogueAPDisable called with
NULL argument.
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
CRITICAL
CRITICAL
CRITICAL
CRITICAL
CRITICAL
%s debug level now = 0x%x , __func__, dfs_
debug_level
DEBUG
Inside crypt_init module in driver
@@@@@@@@
CRITICAL
RateTable:%d, maxvalidrate:%d, ratemax:%d,
pRc->rateTableSize,k,pRc->rateMaxPhy
DEBUG
Inside crypt_cleanup module in driver
@@@@@@@@
CRITICAL
%s: txRate value of 0x%x is bad., __FUNCTION__,
txRate
DEBUG
SKB is null : %p ,skb
CRITICAL
DEBUG
DST is null : %p ,dst
CRITICAL
DEBUG
DEV is null %p %p ,dev,dst
CRITICAL
DEBUG
Packet is Fragmented %d,pBufMgr>len
CRITICAL
Can’t allocate memory for ath_vap.
DEBUG
Marked the packet proto:%d
sip:%x dip:%x sport:%d dport:%d
spi:%d,isr:%p:%p %p
CRITICAL
Unable to add an interface for ath_dev.
DEBUG
SAV CHECK FAILED IN DECRYPTION
CRITICAL
%s: [%02u] %-7s , tag, ix, ciphers[hk->kv_type]
%02x, hk->kv_val[i]
DEBUG
DEBUG
CRITICAL
CRITICAL
mac %02x-%02x-%02x-%02x-%02x-%02x,
mac[0], mac[1], mac[2], mac[3], mac[4], mac[5]
DEBUG
FAST PATH Breaks on BUF CHECK
FAST PATH Breaks on DST CHECK
FAST PATH Breaks on MTU %d %d
%d,bufMgrLen(pBufMgr),mtu,dst_
mtu(pDst->path)
Valid Rate Table:Index:%d, value:%d, code:%x, rate:%d, lag:%x, i,
(int)validRateIndex[i],
RateTable:%d, maxvalidrate:%d, ratemax:%d,
pRc->rateTableSize,k,pRc->rateMaxPhy
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
CRITICAL
293
Appendix D - Log Output Reference
mac 00-00-00-00-00-00
DEBUG
FAST PATH Breaks on MAX PACKET %d
%d,bufMgrLen(pBufMgr),IP_MAX_
PACKET
CRITICAL
%02x, hk->kv_mic[i]
DEBUG
SAV CHECK FAILED IN ENCRYPTION
CRITICAL
txmic
DEBUG
Match Found proto %d spi
%d,pPktInfo->proto,pFlowEntry->pre.
spi
CRITICAL
%02x, hk->kv_txmic[i]
DEBUG
PRE: proto: %u srcip:%u.%u.%u.%u
sport :%u dstip: %u.%u.%u.%u dport:
%u,
CRITICAL
Cannot support setting tx and rx keys individually
DEBUG
POST: proto: %u srcip:%u.%u.%u.%u
sport :%u dstip: %u.%u.%u.%u dport:
%u,
CRITICAL
bogus frame type 0x%x (%s),
DEBUG
Clearing the ISR %p,p
CRITICAL
ERROR: ieee80211_encap ret NULL
DEBUG
PROTO:%d %u.%u.%u.%u-->%u.%u.%u.%u,
CRITICAL
ERROR: ath_amsdu_attach not called
DEBUG
ESP-DONE: %p %p,sav,m
CRITICAL
%s: no memory for cwm attach, __func__
DEBUG
ESP-BAD: %p %p,sav,m
CRITICAL
%s: error - acw NULL. Possible attach failure,
__func__
DEBUG
Bug in ip_route_input_slow().
CRITICAL
%s: unable to abort tx dma, __func__
DEBUG
Bug in ip_route_input_slow().
CRITICAL
%s: no memory for f attach, __func__
DEBUG
Bug in ip_route_input \
CRITICAL
Failed to initiate PBC based enrolle association
DEBUG
Bug in ip_route_input_slow().
CRITICAL
KERN_EMERG Returing error in INTR registration
DEBUG
AH: Assigning the secure lags for sav
:%p,sav
CRITICAL
KERN_EMERG Initialzing Wps module
DEBUG
ESP: Assigning the secure lags for sav
:%p skb:%p src:%x dst:%x,sav,skb,ip>ip_src.s_addr,ip->ip_dst.s_addr
CRITICAL
DEBUG
%s Bufer %d mtu %d path mtu %d
header %d trailer %d,__func__,bufM
grLen(pBufMgr),mtu,dst_mtu(pDst>path),pDst->header_len,pDst>trailer_len
CRITICAL
%s:%d %s, __FILE__, __LINE__, __func__
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
294
Appendix E - RJ-45 Pin-outs
Appendix E - RJ-45 Pin-outs
Signal
CTS
DTR
TxD
GND
GND
RxD
DSR
RTS
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
RJ-45 Cable
RJ-45 PIN
NC
NC
NC
NC
Adapter
DB-9 PIN
NC
NC
NC
NC
Signal
NC
NC
RxD
GND
GND
TxD
NC
NC
295
Appendix F - New Wi Fi Frequency table ( New appendix section )
Appendix F - New Wi Fi Frequency table
( New appendix section )
Channel supported in20
Mhz
Country
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
Australia
Russia
Iceland
Singapore
Sweden
Taiwan
Finland
Slovenia
Ireland
United states
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
Channel supported in 40
Mhz
Upper side
band
Lower side
band
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
40, 48, 153, 161
36, 44, 149, 157
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
40, 48, 153, 161
36, 44, 149, 157
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9,
10, 11
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7
5 Ghz
56, 60, 64, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
64, 153, 161
60, 149, 157
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9,
10, 11
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
40, 48, 153, 161
36, 44, 149, 157
296
Appendix F - New Wi Fi Frequency table ( New appendix section )
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
23)
Latin America
Denmark
Germany
Netherlands
Norway
Poland
Luxembourg
South Africa
United
Kingdom
Ireland
France
Israel
Korea
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
40, 48, 153,
161
36, 44, 149, 157
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36, 44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
40, 48, 153, 161
36, 44, 149, 157
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48
40, 48
36,44
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56,
60, 64
40, 48, 56, 64
36, 44, 52, 60
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11,12,13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11,12,13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7,8,9
2.4Ghz
5 Ghz
24)
25)
26)
Japan
Egypt
Brazil
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
2.4Ghz
297
Appendix F - New Wi Fi Frequency table ( New appendix section )
27)
28)
Canada
China
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
40, 48, 153, 161
36, 44, 149, 157
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9,
10, 11
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
40, 48, 153,
161
36, 44, 149,
157
2.4Ghz
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10,
11, 12, 13
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9
5 Ghz
36, 40, 44, 48, 149, 153,
157, 161, 165
40, 48, 153,
161
36, 44, 149, 157
298
Appendix G - Product Statement
Appendix G - Product Statement
1. DSR-1000N
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Compliance Notice: Radio Frequency Notice
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant
to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency
energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference
to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment of and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference
by one or more of the following measures:
x Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
x Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
x Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit diferent from that to which the receiver is
connected.
x Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
FCC Radiation Exposure Statement
This equipment complies with FCC RF radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed and operated with a minimum distance of 20 centimeters between the
radiator and your body.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
The antennas used for this transmitter must be installed to provide a spectrum distance of at least 20cm
from all persons and must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or
transmitter.
This transmitter is restricted to indoor use in the 5150MHz to 5250MHz frequency range.
Non-modiication Statement
Use only the integral antenna supplied by the manufacturer when operating this device. Unauthorized
antennas, modiications, or attachments could damage the TI Navigator access point and violate FCC
regulations. Any changes or modiications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance
could void the user’s authority to operate this equipment.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
299
Appendix G - Product Statement
Canadian Department of Communications Industry Canada (IC) Notice
CAN ICES-3(B)/NMB-3(B)
Industry Canada Statement
This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
(1) this device may not cause interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation
of the device.
Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR d’Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de
licence. L’exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes :
(1) l’appareil ne doit pas produire de brouillage, et
(2) l’utilisateur de l’appareil doit accepter tout brouillage radioélectrique subi, même si le brouillage est
susceptible d’en compromettre le fonctionnement.
IMPORTANT NOTE: Radiation Exposure Statement
This equipment complies with IC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.
End users must follow the speciic operating instructions for satisfying RF exposure compliance. To
maintain compliance with IC RF exposure compliance requirements, please follow operation instruction as
documented in this manual.
This transmitter is restricted to indoor use in the 5150MHz to 5250MHz frequency range.
Europe – EU Declaration of Conformity
This device complies with the essential requirements of the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC. The following
test methods have been applied in order to prove presumption of conformity with the essential
requirements
of the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC:
- EN 60950-1: 2006+A11:2009
Safety of information technology equipment
- EN 300 328 V1.7.1 (2006-10)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); Wideband transmission systems; Data
transmission equipment operating in the 2,4 GHz ISM band and using wide band modulation techniques;
Harmonized EN covering essential requirements under article 3.2 of the R&TTE Directive
- EN 301 893-1 V1.5.1 (2008-12)
Broadband Radio Access Networks (BRAN); 5 GHz high performance RLAN; Harmonized EN covering
essential requirements of article 3.2 of the R&TTE Directive
- EN 301 489-17 V1.3.2 (2008-04) and EN 301 489-1 V1.8.1 (2008-04)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); Electro Magnetic Compatibility (EMC)
standard for radio equipment and services; Part 17: Speciic conditions for 2,4 GHz wideband transmission
systems and 5 GHz high performance RLAN equipment
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
300
Appendix G - Product Statement
This device is a 2.4 GHz wideband transmission system (transceiver), intended for use in all EU member
states and EFTA countries under the following conditions and/or with the following restrictions:
- In Italy the end-user should apply for a license at the national spectrum authorities in order to obtain
authorization to use the device for setting up outdoor radio links and/or for supplying public access to
telecommunications and/or network services.
- This device may not be used for setting up outdoor radio links in France and in some areas the RF output
power may be limited to 10 mW EIRP in the frequency range of 2454 – 2483.5 MHz. For detailed information
the enduser should contact the national spectrum authority in France.
This device is a 5 GHz wideband transmission system (transceiver), intended for use in all EU member
states and EFTA countries under the following conditions and/or with the following restrictions:
- This device may only be used indoors in the frequency bands 5150 – 5250 MHz.
- In France and Luxembourg a limited implementation of the frequency bands 5150 – 5250 MHz and 5250 –
5350 MHz. In Luxermbourg it is not allowed to make use of the frequency band 5470 – 5725 MHz. End-users
are encouraged to contact the national spectrum authorities in France and Luxembourg in order to obtain
the latest information about any restrictions in the 5 GHz frequency band(s).
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
301
Appendix G - Product Statement
Česky
[Czech]
[D-Link Corporation] tímto prohlašuje, že tento [DSR-1000N] je ve shodě se základními
požadavky a dalšími příslušnými ustanoveními směrnice 1999/5/ES.
Dansk
[Danish]
Undertegnede [D-Link Corporation] erklÌrer herved, at følgende udstyr [DSR-1000N]
overholder de vÌsentlige krav og øvrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.
Deutsch
[German]
Hiermit erklärt [D-Link Corporation], dass sich das Gerät [DSR-1000N] in Übereinstimmung
mit den grundlegenden Anforderungen und den ßbrigen einschlägigen Bestimmungen der
Richtlinie 1999/5/EG beindet.
Eesti
[Estonian]
Käesolevaga kinnitab [D-Link Corporation] seadme [DSR-1000N] vastavust direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ
pþhinþuetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele teistele asjakohastele sätetele.
English
Hereby, [D-Link Corporation], declares that this [DSR-1000N] is in compliance with the essential
requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
EspaĂąol
[Spanish]
Por medio de la presente [D-Link Corporation] declara que el [DSR-1000N] cumple con los
requisitos esenciales y cualesquiera otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva
1999/5/CE.
Ελληνική
[Greek]
ΜΕ ΤΗΝ ΠΑΡΟΥΣΑ [D-Link Corporation] ΔΗΛΩΝΕΙ ΟΤΙ [DSR-1000N] ΣΥΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕΤΑΙ ΠΡΟΣ ΤΙΣ
ΟΥΣΙΩΔΕΙΣ ΑΠΑΙΤΗΣΕΙΣ ΚΑΙ ΤΙΣ ΛΟΙΠΕΣ ΣΧΕΤΙΚΕΣ ΔΙΑΤΑΞΕΙΣ ΤΗΣ ΟΔΗΓΙΑΣ 1999/5/ΕΚ.
Français
[French]
Par la présente [D-Link Corporation] déclare que l’appareil [DSR-1000N] est conforme aux
exigences essentielles et aux autres dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999/5/CE.
Italiano
[Italian]
Con la presente [D-Link Corporation] dichiara che questo [DSR-1000N] è conforme ai requisiti
essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999/5/CE.
Latviski
[Latvian]
Ar šo [D-Link Corporation] deklarē, ka [DSR-1000N] atbilst Direktīvas 1999/5/EK būtiskajām
prasčbām un citiem ar to saistčtajiem noteikumiem.
LietuviĹł
[Lithuanian]
Ĺ iuo [D-Link Corporation] deklaruoja, kad ĹĄis [DSR-1000N] atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas
1999/5/EB Direktyvos nuostatas.
Nederlands
[Dutch]
Hierbij verklaart [D-Link Corporation] dat het toestel [DSR-1000N] in overeenstemming is met
de essentiĂŤle eisen en de andere relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG.
Malti
[Maltese]
Hawnhekk, [D-Link Corporation], jiddikjara li dan [DSR-1000N] jikkonforma mal-ħtiĥijiet
essenzjali u ma provvedimenti oħrajn relevanti li hemm id-Dirrettiva 1999/5/EC.
Magyar
[Hungarian]
AlulĂ­rott, [D-Link Corporation] nyilatkozom, hogy a [DSR-1000N] megfelel a vonatkozĂł alapvetĂľ
kÜvetelmÊnyeknek Ês az 1999/5/EC irånyelv egyÊb elþíråsainak.
Polski
[Polish]
Niniejszym [D-Link Corporation] oświadcza, że [DSR-1000N] jest zgodny z zasadniczymi
wymogami oraz pozostałymi stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
302
Appendix G - Product Statement
PortuguĂŞs
[Portuguese]
[D-Link Corporation] declara que este [DSR-1000N]estĂĄ conforme com os requisitos essenciais e
outras disposiçþes da Directiva 1999/5/CE.
Slovensko
[Slovenian]
[D-Link Corporation] izjavlja, da je ta [DSR-1000N] v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi
relevantnimi določili direktive 1999/5/ES.
Slovensky
[Slovak]
[D-Link Corporation] týmto vyhlasuje, Şe [DSR-1000N] spĺňa zåkladnÊ poŞiadavky a vťetky
prĂ­sluĹĄnĂŠ ustanovenia Smernice 1999/5/ES.
Suomi
[Finnish]
[D-Link Corporation] vakuuttaa täten että [DSR-1000N] tyyppinen laite on direktiivin 1999/5/EY
oleellisten vaatimusten ja sitä koskevien direktiivin muiden ehtojen mukainen.
Svenska
[Swedish]
Härmed intygar [D-Link Corporation] att denna [DSR-1000N] stür I Üverensstämmelse med de
väsentliga egenskapskrav och Üvriga relevanta bestämmelser som framgür av direktiv 1999/5/
EG.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
303
Appendix G - Product Statement
2.DSR-500N
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Compliance Notice: Radio Frequency Notice
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant
to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency
energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference
to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment of and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference
by one or more of the following measures:
x Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
x Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
x Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit diferent from that to which the receiver is
connected.
x Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
FCC Radiation Exposure Statement
This equipment complies with FCC RF radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed and operated with a minimum distance of 20 centimeters between the
radiator and your body.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
The antennas used for this transmitter must be installed to provide a spectrum distance of at least 20cm
from all persons and must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or
transmitter.
This transmitter is restricted to indoor use in the 5150MHz to 5250MHz frequency range.
Non-modiication Statement
Use only the integral antenna supplied by the manufacturer when operating this device. Unauthorized
antennas, modiications, or attachments could damage the TI Navigator access point and violate FCC
regulations. Any changes or modiications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance
could void the user’s authority to operate this equipment.
Canadian Department of Communications Industry Canada (IC) Notice
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003 and RSS-210. Cet appareil numĂŠrique de la
classe B est conforme Ă  la norme NMB-003 et CNR-210 du Canada.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
304
Appendix G - Product Statement
Industry Canada Statement
This device complies with RSS-210 of the Industry Canada Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
IMPORTANT NOTE: Radiation Exposure Statement
This equipment complies with IC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.
End users must follow the speciic operating instructions for satisfying RF exposure compliance.
To maintain compliance with IC RF exposure compliance requirements, please follow operation instruction
as documented in this manual.
Europe – EU Declaration of Conformity
This device complies with the essential requirements of the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC. The following
test methods have been applied in order to prove presumption of conformity with the essential
requirements
of the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC:
- EN 60950-1: 2006+A11:2009
Safety of information technology equipment
- EN 300 328 V1.7.1 (2006-10)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); Wideband transmission systems; Data
transmission equipment operating in the 2,4 GHz ISM band and using wide band modulation techniques;
Harmonized EN covering essential requirements under article 3.2 of the R&TTE Directive
- EN 301 489-17 V1.3.2 (2008-04) and EN 301 489-1 V1.8.1 (2008-04)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); Electro Magnetic Compatibility (EMC)
standard for radio equipment and services; Part 17: Speciic conditions for 2,4 GHz wideband transmission
systems and 5 GHz high performance RLAN equipment
This device is a 2.4 GHz wideband transmission system (transceiver), intended for use in all EU member
states and EFTA countries under the following conditions and/or with the following restrictions:
- In Italy the end-user should apply for a license at the national spectrum authorities in order to obtain
authorization to use the device for setting up outdoor radio links and/or for supplying public access to
telecommunications and/or network services.
- This device may not be used for setting up outdoor radio links in France and in some areas the RF output
power may be limited to 10 mW EIRP in the frequency range of 2454 – 2483.5 MHz. For detailed
information the enduser should contact the national spectrum authority in France.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
305
Appendix G - Product Statement
ýHVN\
>&]HFK@
>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@WtPWRSURKODãXMHåHWHQWR>'651@MHYHVKRGČVH]iNODGQtPL
SRåDGDYN\DGDOãtPLSĜtVOXãQêPLXVWDQRYHQtPLVPČUQLFH(6
'DQVN
>'DQLVK@
8QGHUWHJQHGH>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@HUNO UHUKHUYHGDWIÂĄOJHQGHXGVW\U>'651@
RYHUKROGHUGHY VHQWOLJHNUDYRJÂĄYULJHUHOHYDQWHNUDYLGLUHNWLY()
'HXWVFK
>*HUPDQ@
+LHUPLWHUNOlUW>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GDVVVLFKGDV*HUlW>'651@LQhEHUHLQVWLPPXQJ
PLWGHQJUXQGOHJHQGHQ$QIRUGHUXQJHQXQGGHQEULJHQHLQVFKOlJLJHQ%HVWLPPXQJHQGHU
5LFKWOLQLH(*EHÂżQGHW
(HVWL
>(VWRQLDQ@
.lHVROHYDJDNLQQLWDE>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@VHDGPH>'651@YDVWDYXVWGLUHNWLLYL
(hS}KLQ}XHWHOHMDQLPHWDWXGGLUHNWLLYLVWWXOHQHYDWHOHWHLVWHOHDVMDNRKDVWHOH
VlWHWHOH
(QJOLVK
(VSDxRO
>6SDQLVK@
+HUHE\>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GHFODUHVWKDWWKLV>'651@LVLQFRPSOLDQFHZLWKWKH
HVVHQWLDOUHTXLUHPHQWVDQGRWKHUUHOHYDQWSURYLVLRQVRI'LUHFWLYH(&
3RUPHGLRGHODSUHVHQWH>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GHFODUDTXHHO>'651@FXPSOHFRQ
ORVUHTXLVLWRVHVHQFLDOHV\FXDOHVTXLHUDRWUDVGLVSRVLFLRQHVDSOLFDEOHVRH[LJLEOHVGHOD
'LUHFWLYD&(
ǼȜȜȘȞȚțȒ ȂǼȉǾȃȆǹȇȅȊȈǹ>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@ǻǾȁȍȃǼǿȅȉǿ>'651@ȈȊȂȂȅȇĭȍȃǼȉǹǿ
ȆȇȅȈȉǿȈȅȊȈǿȍǻǼǿȈǹȆǹǿȉǾȈǼǿȈȀǹǿȉǿȈȁȅǿȆǼȈȈȋǼȉǿȀǼȈǻǿǹȉǹȄǼǿȈȉǾȈ
>*UHHN@
ȅǻǾīǿǹȈǼȀ
)UDQoDLV
>)UHQFK@
3DUODSUpVHQWH>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GpFODUHTXHOÂśDSSDUHLO>'651@HVWFRQIRUPHDX[
H[LJHQFHVHVVHQWLHOOHVHWDX[DXWUHVGLVSRVLWLRQVSHUWLQHQWHVGHODGLUHFWLYH&(
,WDOLDQR
>,WDOLDQ@
&RQODSUHVHQWH>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GLFKLDUDFKHTXHVWR>'651@qFRQIRUPHDL
UHTXLVLWLHVVHQ]LDOLHGDOOHDOWUHGLVSRVL]LRQLSHUWLQHQWLVWDELOLWHGDOODGLUHWWLYD&(
/DWYLVNL
>/DWYLDQ@
$UãR>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GHNODUƝND>'651@DWELOVW'LUHNWƯYDV(.EnjWLVNDMƗP
SUDVƯEƗPXQFLWLHPDUWRVDLVWƯWDMLHPQRWHLNXPLHP
/LHWXYLǐ
>/LWKXDQLDQ@
âLXR>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GHNODUXRMDNDGãLV>'651@DWLWLQNDHVPLQLXVUHLNDODYLPXVLU
NLWDV(%'LUHNW\YRVQXRVWDWDV
1HGHUODQGV
>'XWFK@
+LHUELMYHUNODDUW>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GDWKHWWRHVWHO>'651@LQRYHUHHQVWHPPLQJLV
PHWGHHVVHQWLsOHHLVHQHQGHDQGHUHUHOHYDQWHEHSDOLQJHQYDQULFKWOLMQ(*
0DOWL
>0DOWHVH@
+DZQKHNN>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@MLGGLNMDUDOLGDQ>'651@MLNNRQIRUPDPDOĆŤWLĆĽLMLHW
HVVHQ]MDOLXPDSURYYHGLPHQWLRĆŤUDMQUHOHYDQWLOLKHPPÂżG'LUUHWWLYD(&
0DJ\DU
>+XQJDULDQ@
$OXOtURWW>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@Q\LODWNR]RPKRJ\D>'651@PHJIHOHODYRQDWNR]y
DODSYHW}N|YHWHOPpQ\HNQHNpVD](&LUiQ\HOYHJ\pEHO}tUiVDLQDN
3ROVNL
>3ROLVK@
1LQLHMV]\P>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@RĞZLDGF]DĪH>'651@MHVW]JRGQ\]]DVDGQLF]\PL
Z\PRJDPLRUD]SR]RVWDĂĄ\PLVWRVRZQ\PLSRVWDQRZLHQLDPL'\UHNW\Z\(&
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
306
Appendix G - Product Statement
3RUWXJXrV
>3RUWXJXHVH@
6ORYHQVNR
>6ORYHQLDQ@
6ORYHQVN\
>6ORYDN@
>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@GHFODUDTXHHVWH>'651@HVWiFRQIRUPHFRPRVUHTXLVLWRV
HVVHQFLDLVHRXWUDVGLVSRVLo}HVGD'LUHFWLYD&(
>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@L]MDYOMDGDMHWD>'651@YVNODGX]ELVWYHQLPL]DKWHYDPLLQ
RVWDOLPLUHOHYDQWQLPLGRORĂžLOLGLUHNWLYH(6
>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@WêPWRY\KODVXMHåH>'651@VSĎĖD]iNODGQpSRåLDGDYN\D
YĂŁHWN\SUtVOXĂŁQpXVWDQRYHQLD6PHUQLFH(6
6XRPL
>)LQQLVK@
>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@YDNXXWWDDWlWHQHWWl>'651@W\\SSLQHQODLWHRQGLUHNWLLYLQ
(<ROHHOOLVWHQYDDWLPXVWHQMDVLWlNRVNHYLHQGLUHNWLLYLQPXLGHQHKWRMHQPXNDLQHQ
6YHQVND
>6ZHGLVK@
+lUPHGLQW\JDU>'/LQN&RUSRUDWLRQ@DWWGHQQD>'651@VWnU,|YHUHQVVWlPPHOVH
PHGGHYlVHQWOLJDHJHQVNDSVNUDYRFK|YULJDUHOHYDQWDEHVWlPPHOVHUVRPIUDPJnUDY
GLUHNWLY(*
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
307
Appendix G - Product Statement
3.DSR-250N
Federal Communication Commission Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant
to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency
energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference
to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment of and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference
by one of the following measures:
x Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
x Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
x Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit diferent from that to which the receiver is
connected.
x Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
FCC Caution:
Any changes or modiications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void
the user’s authority to operate this equipment.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1)
This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
RSS-GEN 7.1.4:
User Manual for Transmitters with Detachable Antennas
The user manual of transmitter devices equipped with detachable antennas shall contain the following
information in a conspicuous location:
This device has been designed to operate with the antennas listed below, and having a maximum gain of
[1.8] dB. Antennas not included in this list or having a gain greater than [1.8] dB are strictly prohibited for use
with this device. The required antenna impedance is [50] ohms.
RSS-GEN 7.1.5
To reduce potential radio interference to other users, the antenna type and its gain should be so chosen
that the equivalent isotropically radiated power (e.i.r.p.) is not more than that permitted for successful
communication.
Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR d’Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de
licence. L’exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes: (1) l’appareil ne doit pas produire de
brouillage, et (2) l’utilisateur de l’appareil doit accepter tout brouillage radioélectrique subi, même si le
brouillage est susceptible d’en comSpromettre le fonctionnement.
Is herewith conirmed to comply with the requirements set out in the Council Directive on the
Approximation of the Laws of the Member States relating to Electromagnetic Compatibility (2004/108/
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
308
Appendix G - Product Statement
EC), Low-voltage Directive (2006/95/EC), the procedures given in European Council Directive 99/5/EC and
2004/104/EC.
The equipment was passed. The test was performed according to the following European standards:
EN 300 328 V.1.7.1
EN 301 489-1 V.1. 8.1 / EN 301 489-17 V.2.1.1
EN 62311
EN 60950-1
Regulatory statement (R&TTE)
European standards dictate maximum radiated transmit power of 100mW EIRP and frequency range 2.4002.4835GHz; In France, the equipment must be restricted to the 2.4465-2.4835GHz frequency range and must
be restricted to indoor use.
Operation of this device is subjected to the following National regulations and may be prohibited to use if
certain restriction should be applied.
D=0.020m is the minimum safety distance between the EUT and human body when the E-Field strength is
61V/m.
NCC Warning Statement
Article 12
Without permission, any company, irm or user shall not alter the frequency, increase the power, or change
the characteristics and functions of the original design of the certiied lower power frequency electric
machinery.
Article 14
The application of low power frequency electric machineries shall not afect the navigation safety nor
interfere a legal communication, if an interference is found, the service will be suspended until improvement
is made and the interference no longer exists.
Canadian Department of Communications Industry Canada (IC) Notice
CAN ICES-3(B)/NMB-3(B)
Industry Canada Statement
This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
(1) this device may not cause interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation
of the device.
Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR d’Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de
licence. L’exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes :
(1) l’appareil ne doit pas produire de brouillage, et
(2) l’utilisateur de l’appareil doit accepter tout brouillage radioélectrique subi, même si le brouillage est
susceptible d’en compromettre le fonctionnement.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
309
Appendix G - Product Statement
Radiation Exposure Statement:
The device meets the exemption from the routine evaluation limits in section 2.5 of RSS 102 and compliance
with RSS-102 RF exposure, users can obtain Canadian information on RF exposure and compliance.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
This equipment should be installed and operated with a minimum distance of 20 centimeters between the
radiator and your body.
Déclaration d’exposition aux radiations:
Le dispositif rencontre l’exemption des limites courantes d’évaluation dans la section 2.5 de RSS 102 et la
conformité à l’exposition de RSS-102 rf, utilisateurs peut obtenir l’information canadienne sur l’exposition et
la conformitĂŠ de rf.
Cet émetteur ne doit pas être Co-placé ou ne fonctionnant en même temps qu’aucune autre antenne ou
Êmetteur. Cet Êquipement devrait être installÊ et actionnÊ avec une distance minimum de 20 centimètres
entre le radiateur et votre corps.
This radio transmitter (Model:DSR-250N) has been approved by Industry Canada to operate with the antenna
types listed below with the maximum permissible gain and required antenna impedance for each antenna type
indicated. Antenna types not included in this list, having a gain greater than the maximum gain indicated for that
type, are strictly prohibited for use with this device.
Le prĂŠsent ĂŠmetteur radio (Model:DSR-250N) a ĂŠtĂŠ approuvĂŠ par Industrie Canada pour fonctionner avec les
types d’antenne énumérés ci-dessous et ayant un gain admissible maximal et l’impédance requise pour chaque
type d’antenne. Les types d’antenne non inclus dans cette liste, ou dont le gain est supérieur au gain maximal
indiqué, sont strictement interdits pour l’exploitation de l’émetteur.
Ant.
Brand
Model Name
Antenna Type
Connector
Gain (dBi)
SSR-02521
Dipole
R-SMA
2.85
SSR-02521
Dipole
R-SMA
2.71
This device complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment and it also
complies with Part 15 of the FCC RF Rules. This equipment must be installed and operated in accordance with
provided instructions and the antenna(s) used for this transmitter must be installed to provide a separation
distance of at least 20 cm from all persons and must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other
antenna or transmitter. End-users and installers must be provided with antenna installation instructions and
consider removing the no-collocation statement.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
310
Appendix G - Product Statement
4. DSR-150N
Federal Communication Commission Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant
to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency
energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference
to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment of and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference
by one of the following measures:
x Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
x Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
x Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit diferent from that to which the receiver is
connected.
x Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
FCC Caution:
Any changes or modiications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void
the user’s authority to operate this equipment. This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation
is subject to the following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
IMPORTANT NOTE:
FCC Radiation Exposure Statement:
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. This
equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance 20cm between the radiator & your
body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
The availability of some speciic channels and/or operational frequency bands are country dependent and
are irmware programmed at the factory to match the intended destination. The irmware setting is not
accessible by the end user.
Note: The country code selection is for non-US model only and is not available to all US model. Per FCC
regulation, all WiFi product marketed in US must ixed to US operation channels only..
Europe – EU Declaration of Conformity
This device complies with the essential requirements of the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC. The following test
methods have been applied in order to prove presumption of conformity with the essential requirements of
the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC:
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
311
Appendix G - Product Statement
EN 60950-1:
Safety of Information Technology Equipment
EN50385 : (2002-08)
Product standard to demonstrate the compliance of radio base stations and ixed terminal stations for
wireless telecommunication systems with the basic restrictions or the reference levels related to human
exposure to radio frequency electromagnetic ields (110MHz - 40 GHz) - General public
EN 300 328 V1.7.1: (2006-10)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); Wideband Transmission systems; Data
transmission equipment operating in the 2,4 GHz ISM band and using spread spectrum modulation
techniques; Harmonized EN covering essential requirements under article 3.2 of the R&TTE Directive
EN 301 489-1 V1.8.1: (2008-04)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio Spectrum Matters (ERM); ElectroMagnetic Compatibility (EMC)
standard for radio equipment and services; Part 1: Common technical requirements
EN 301 489-17 V2.1.1 (2009-05)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); ElectroMagnetic Compatibility (EMC)
standard for radio equipment; Part 17: Speciic conditions for Broadband Data Transmission Systems
This device is a 2.4 GHz wideband transmission system (transceiver), intended for use in all EU member
states and EFTA countries, except in France and Italy where restrictive use applies.
In Italy the end-user should apply for a license at the national spectrum authorities in order to obtain
authorization to use the device for setting up outdoor radio links and/or for supplying public access to
telecommunications and/or network services.
This device may not be used for setting up outdoor radio links in France and in some areas the RF output
power may be limited to 10 mW EIRP in the frequency range of 2454 – 2483.5 MHz. For detailed information
the end-user should contact the national spectrum authority in France.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
312
Appendix G - Product Statement
Česky
[Czech]
Dansk
[Danish]
Deutsch
[German]
Eesti
[Estonian]
English
EspaĂąol
[Spanish]
Ελληνική
[Greek]
Français
[French]
Italiano
[Italian]
Latviski
[Latvian]
LietuviĹł
[Lithuanian]
Nederlands
[Dutch]
Malti
[Maltese]
Magyar
[Hungarian]
Polski
[Polish]
PortuguĂŞs
[Portuguese]
Slovensko
[Slovenian]
Slovensky
[Slovak]
Suomi
[Finnish]
Svenska
[Swedish]
[Jméno výrobce] tímto prohlašuje, že tento [typ zařízení] je ve shodě se základními požadavky a
dalšími příslušnými ustanoveními směrnice 1999/5/ES.
Undertegnede [fabrikantens navn] erklÌrer herved, at følgende udstyr [udstyrets
typebetegnelse] overholder de vÌsentlige krav og øvrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.
Hiermit erklärt [Name des Herstellers], dass sich das Gerät [Gerätetyp] in Übereinstimmung
mit den grundlegenden Anforderungen und den ßbrigen einschlägigen Bestimmungen der
Richtlinie 1999/5/EG beindet.
Käesolevaga kinnitab [tootja nimi = name of manufacturer] seadme [seadme tßßp = type of
equipment] vastavust direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ põhinõuetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele
teistele asjakohastele sätetele.
Hereby, [name of manufacturer], declares that this [type of equipment] is in compliance with the
essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
Por medio de la presente [nombre del fabricante] declara que el [clase de equipo] cumple con
los requisitos esenciales y cualesquiera otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva
1999/5/CE.
ΜΕ ΤΗΝ ΠΑΡΟΥΣΑ [name of manufacturer] ΔΗΛΩΝΕΙ ΟΤΙ [type of equipment] ΣΥΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕΤΑΙ
ΠΡΟΣ ΤΙΣ ΟΥΣΙΩΔΕΙΣ ΑΠΑΙΤΗΣΕΙΣ ΚΑΙ ΤΙΣ ΛΟΙΠΕΣ ΣΧΕΤΙΚΕΣ ΔΙΑΤΑΞΕΙΣ ΤΗΣ ΟΔΗΓΙΑΣ 1999/5/ΕΚ.
Par la présente [nom du fabricant] déclare que l’appareil [type d’appareil] est conforme aux
exigences essentielles et aux autres dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999/5/CE.
Con la presente [nome del costruttore] dichiara che questo [tipo di apparecchio] è conforme ai
requisiti essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999/5/CE.
Ar šo [name of manufacturer / izgatavotāja nosaukums] deklarē, ka [type of equipment / iekārtas
tips] atbilst Direktčvas 1999/5/EK bōtiskajām prasčbām un citiem ar to saistčtajiem noteikumiem.
Ĺ iuo [manufacturer name] deklaruoja, kad ĹĄis [equipment type] atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir
kitas 1999/5/EB Direktyvos nuostatas.
Hierbij verklaart [naam van de fabrikant] dat het toestel [type van toestel] in overeenstemming is
met de essentiĂŤle eisen en de andere relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG.
Hawnhekk, [isem tal-manifattur], jiddikjara li dan [il-mudel tal-prodott] jikkonforma mal-ħtiĥijiet
essenzjali u ma provvedimenti oħrajn relevanti li hemm id-Dirrettiva 1999/5/EC.
AlulĂ­rott, [gyĂĄrtĂł neve] nyilatkozom, hogy a [... tĂ­pus] megfelel a vonatkozĂł alapvetĂľ
kÜvetelmÊnyeknek Ês az 1999/5/EC irånyelv egyÊb elþíråsainak.
Niniejszym [nazwa producenta] oświadcza, że [nazwa wyrobu] jest zgodny z zasadniczymi
wymogami oraz pozostałymi stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC.
[Nome do fabricante] declara que este [tipo de equipamento] estĂĄ conforme com os requisitos
essenciais e outras disposiçþes da Directiva 1999/5/CE.
[Ime proizvajalca] izjavlja, da je ta [tip opreme] v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi
relevantnimi določili direktive 1999/5/ES.
[Meno výrobcu] týmto vyhlasuje, Şe [typ zariadenia] spĺňa zåkladnÊ poŞiadavky a vťetky prísluťnÊ
ustanovenia Smernice 1999/5/ES.
[Valmistaja = manufacturer] vakuuttaa täten että [type of equipment = laitteen tyyppimerkintä]
tyyppinen laite on direktiivin 1999/5/EY oleellisten vaatimusten ja sitä koskevien direktiivin
muiden ehtojen mukainen.
Härmed intygar [fÜretag] att denna [utrustningstyp] stür I Üverensstämmelse med de väsentliga
egenskapskrav och Üvriga relevanta bestämmelser som framgür av direktiv 1999/5/EG.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
313
Appendix G - Product Statement
Industry Canada statement:
This device complies with RSS-210 of the Industry Canada Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Ce dispositif est conforme à la norme CNR-210 d’Industrie Canada applicable aux appareils radio exempts
de licence. Son fonctionnement est sujet aux deux conditions suivantes: (1) le dispositif ne doit pas produire
de brouillage prÊjudiciable, et (2) ce dispositif doit accepter tout brouillage reçu, y compris un brouillage
susceptible de provoquer un fonctionnement indĂŠsirable.
Radiation Exposure Statement:
The device meets the exemption from the routine evaluation limits in section 2.5 of RSS 102 and compliance
with RSS-102 RF exposure, users can obtain Canadian information on RF exposure and compliance.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
This equipment should be installed and operated with a minimum distance of 20 centimeters between the
radiator and your body.
Déclaration d’exposition aux radiations:
Le dispositif rencontre l’exemption des limites courantes d’évaluation dans la section 2.5 de RSS 102 et la
conformité à l’exposition de RSS-102 rf, utilisateurs peut obtenir l’information canadienne sur l’exposition et
la conformitĂŠ de rf.
Cet émetteur ne doit pas être Co-placé ou ne fonctionnant en même temps qu’aucune autre antenne ou
Êmetteur. Cet Êquipement devrait être installÊ et actionnÊ avec une distance minimum de 20 centimètres
entre le radiateur et votre corps.
Wall-Mount Option
The Router has four wall-mount slots on its bottom panel.
Before you begin, make sure you have two screws that are size #4 - this indicates a diameter measurement of
0.112inches (2.845mm).
1. Determine where you want to mount the Router.
2. Drill two holes into the wall. Make sure adjacent holes are 2.36 inches (60mm) apart.
3. Insert a screw into each hole, and leave 0.2inches (5mm) of its head exposed.
4. Maneuver the Router so the wall-mount slots line up with the two screws.
5. Place the wall-mount slots over the screws and slide the Router down until the screws it snugly into the
wall-mount slots.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
314
Appendix G - Product Statement
5.DSR-500AC
Federal Communication Commission Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant
to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency
energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference
to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment of and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference
by one of the following measures:
x Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
x Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
x Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit diferent from that to which the receiver is
connected.
x Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
FCC Caution:
Any changes or modiications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void
the user’s authority to operate this equipment.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1)
This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Operation of this device is restricted to indoor use only
IMPORTANT NOTE:
Radiation Exposure Statement:
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. This
equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance 20cm between the radiator & your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
Country Code selection feature to be disabled for products marketed to the US/CANADA
Industry Canada statement:
This device complies with Industry Canada’s licence-exempt RSSs. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
(1) This device may not cause interference; and (2) This device must accept any interference, including
interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
Cet appareil est conforme aux CNR exemptes de licence d’Industrie Canada. Son fonctionnement est soumis
aux deux conditions suivantes:
(1) Ce dispositif ne peut causer d’interférences; et(2) Ce dispositif doit accepter toute interférence, y compris les
interférences qui peuvent causer un mauvais fonctionnement de l’appareil.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
315
Appendix G - Product Statement
Caution:
(i) the device for operation in the band 5150-5250 MHz is only for indoor use to reduce the potential for
harmful interference to co-channel mobile satellite systems;
Avertissement:
(i) les dispositifs fonctionnant dans la bande 5150-5250 MHz sont rĂŠservĂŠs uniquement pour une utilisation Ă 
l’intérieur ain de réduire les risques de brouillage préjudiciable aux systèmes de satellites mobiles utilisant les
mĂŞmes canaux;
Radiation Exposure Statement:
This equipment complies with IC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. This
equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance 20cm between the radiator & your body.
Déclaration d’exposition aux radiations:
Cet équipement est conforme aux limites d’exposition aux rayonnements IC établies pour un environnement
non contrĂ´lĂŠ. Cet ĂŠquipement doit ĂŞtre installĂŠ et utilisĂŠ avec un minimum de 20 cm de distance entre la
source de rayonnement et votre corps.
This radio transmitter (IC: 4216A-SR500ACA1) has been approved by Industry Canada to operate with the
antenna types listed below with the maximum permissible gain indicated. Antenna types not included in this
list, having a gain greater than the maximum gain indicated for that type, are strictly prohibited for use with
this device
Cet ĂŠmetteur radio (IC: 4216A-SR500ACA1) a ĂŠtĂŠ approuvĂŠ par Industrie Canada pour fonctionner avec les
types d’antenne énumérés ci-dessous avec le gain maximal admissible indiqué. Types d’antennes ne igurent
pas dans cette liste, ayant un gain supĂŠrieur au gain maximum indiquĂŠ pour ce type, sont strictement interdits
pour une utilisation avec cet appareil
Type
Manufacture
Gain
Connector
Dipole
WHA YU
2dBi
R-SMA
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
316
Appendix G - Product Statement
6.DSR-1000AC
Federal Communication Commission Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part
15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference
in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not
installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does
cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment
of and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one of the following measures:
x Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
x Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
x Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit diferent from that to which the receiver is
connected.
x Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
FCC Caution: Any changes or modiications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance
could void the user’s authority to operate this equipment.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This
device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
Operation of this device is restricted to indoor use only
IMPORTANT NOTE:
Radiation Exposure Statement:
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. This
equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance 20cm between the radiator & your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
Country Code selection feature to be disabled for products marketed to the US/CANADA
Industry Canada statement:
This device complies with Industry Canada’s licence-exempt RSSs. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
(1) This device may not cause interference; and (2) This device must accept any interference, including interference
that may cause undesired operation of the device.
Cet appareil est conforme aux CNR exemptes de licence d’Industrie Canada. Son fonctionnement est soumis aux
deux conditions suivantes:
(1) Ce dispositif ne peut causer d’interférences; et(2) Ce dispositif doit accepter toute interférence, y compris les
interférences qui peuvent causer un mauvais fonctionnement de l’appareil.
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
317
Appendix G - Product Statement
Caution:
(i) the device for operation in the band 5150-5250 MHz is only for indoor use to reduce the potential for harmful
interference to co-channel mobile satellite systems;
Avertissement:
(i) les dispositifs fonctionnant dans la bande 5150-5250 MHz sont rĂŠservĂŠs uniquement pour une utilisation Ă 
l’intérieur ain de réduire les risques de brouillage préjudiciable aux systèmes de satellites mobiles utilisant les
mĂŞmes canaux;
Radiation Exposure Statement:
This equipment complies with IC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. This
equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance 20cm between the radiator & your body.
Déclaration d’exposition aux radiations:
Cet équipement est conforme aux limites d’exposition aux rayonnements IC établies pour un environnement
non contrĂ´lĂŠ. Cet ĂŠquipement doit ĂŞtre installĂŠ et utilisĂŠ avec un minimum de 20 cm de distance entre la source
de rayonnement et votre corps.
This radio transmitter (IC: 4216A-SR1000ACA1) has been approved by Industry Canada to operate with the
antenna types listed below with the maximum permissible gain indicated. Antenna types not included in this
list, having a gain greater than the maximum gain indicated for that type, are strictly prohibited for use with this
device
Cet ĂŠmetteur radio (IC: 4216A-SR1000ACA1) a ĂŠtĂŠ approuvĂŠ par Industrie Canada pour fonctionner avec les
types d’antenne énumérés ci-dessous avec le gain maximal admissible indiqué. Types d’antennes ne igurent
pas dans cette liste, ayant un gain supĂŠrieur au gain maximum indiquĂŠ pour ce type, sont strictement interdits
pour une utilisation avec cet appareil
Type
Manufacture
Gain
Connector
Dipole
WHA YU
2dBi
R-SMA
D-Link DSR-Series User Manual
318

Source Exif Data:
File Type                       : PDF
File Type Extension             : pdf
MIME Type                       : application/pdf
PDF Version                     : 1.6
Linearized                      : Yes
Encryption                      : Standard V4.4 (128-bit)
User Access                     : Print, Extract
Create Date                     : 2015:05:18 14:30:41+08:00
Creator                         : Adobe InDesign CC 2014 (Windows)
Modify Date                     : 2015:05:18 14:31:51+08:00
XMP Toolkit                     : Adobe XMP Core 5.4-c005 78.147326, 2012/08/23-13:03:03
Metadata Date                   : 2015:05:18 14:31:51+08:00
Creator Tool                    : Adobe InDesign CC 2014 (Windows)
Instance ID                     : uuid:71fc3bdc-a52d-413f-a338-fc4429821642
Original Document ID            : xmp.did:45A146B31C21E41181B1A66CA5DD4B74
Document ID                     : xmp.id:64d34f44-727a-6340-9bc2-ba70b130b7fb
Rendition Class                 : proof:pdf
Derived From Instance ID        : xmp.iid:c8909c62-8198-c64f-8915-4387e62381c0
Derived From Document ID        : xmp.did:f6ebf3fa-09ee-1047-991a-938fe8364b5d
Derived From Original Document ID: xmp.did:45A146B31C21E41181B1A66CA5DD4B74
Derived From Rendition Class    : default
History Action                  : converted
History Parameters              : from application/x-indesign to application/pdf
History Software Agent          : Adobe InDesign CC 2014 (Windows)
History Changed                 : /
History When                    : 2015:05:14 16:51:56+08:00
Format                          : application/pdf
Title                           : untitled
Producer                        : Acrobat Distiller 11.0 (Windows)
Trapped                         : False
Page Count                      : 331
EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools
FCC ID Filing: KA2SR500ACA1

Navigation menu